0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
LM3S601

LM3S601

  • 厂商:

    ETC2

  • 封装:

  • 描述:

    LM3S601 - Microcontroller - List of Unclassifed Manufacturers

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
LM3S601 数据手册
P R E L IMI NAR Y LM3S601 Microcontroller D ATA SH E E T D S -LM3 S 6 01- 1 7 2 8 Copyr i ght © 2007 Lum i nar y M i c ro, Inc. Legal Disclaimers and Trademark Information INFORMATION IN THIS DOCUMENT IS PROVIDED IN CONNECTION WITH LUMINARY MICRO PRODUCTS. NO LICENSE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, BY ESTOPPEL OR OTHERWISE, TO ANY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS IS GRANTED BY THIS DOCUMENT. EXCEPT AS PROVIDED IN LUMINARY MICRO'S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE FOR SUCH PRODUCTS, LUMINARY MICRO ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER, AND LUMINARY MICRO DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY, RELATING TO SALE AND/OR USE OF LUMINARY MICRO'S PRODUCTS INCLUDING LIABILITY OR WARRANTIES RELATING TO FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, MERCHANTABILITY, OR INFRINGEMENT OF ANY PATENT, COPYRIGHT OR OTHER INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT. LUMINARY MICRO'S PRODUCTS ARE NOT INTENDED FOR USE IN MEDICAL, LIFE SAVING, OR LIFE-SUSTAINING APPLICATIONS. Luminary Micro may make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time, without notice. Contact your local Luminary Micro sales office or your distributor to obtain the latest specifications before placing your product order. Designers must not rely on the absence or characteristics of any features or instructions marked "reserved" or "undefined." Luminary Micro reserves these for future definition and shall have no responsibility whatsoever for conflicts or incompatibilities arising from future changes to them. Copyright © 2007 Luminary Micro, Inc. All rights reserved. Stellaris is a registered trademark and Luminary Micro and the Luminary Micro logo are trademarks of Luminary Micro, Inc. or its subsidiaries in the United States and other countries. ARM and Thumb are registered trademarks and Cortex is a trademark of ARM Limited. Other names and brands may be claimed as the property of others. Luminary Micro, Inc. 108 Wild Basin, Suite 350 Austin, TX 78746 Main: +1-512-279-8800 Fax: +1-512-279-8879 http://www.luminarymicro.com 2 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Table of Contents About This Document .................................................................................................................... 18 Audience .............................................................................................................................................. About This Manual ................................................................................................................................ Related Documents ............................................................................................................................... Documentation Conventions .................................................................................................................. 18 18 18 18 20 25 25 26 27 27 28 29 30 30 31 32 33 35 35 35 36 36 36 36 36 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.4.1 1.4.2 1.4.3 1.4.4 1.4.5 1.4.6 1.4.7 1.4.8 1.4.9 Architectural Overview ...................................................................................................... 20 Product Features ...................................................................................................................... Target Applications .................................................................................................................... High-Level Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... Functional Overview .................................................................................................................. ARM Cortex™-M3 ..................................................................................................................... Motor Control Peripherals .......................................................................................................... Analog Peripherals .................................................................................................................... Serial Communications Peripherals ............................................................................................ System Peripherals ................................................................................................................... Memory Peripherals .................................................................................................................. Additional Features ................................................................................................................... Hardware Details ...................................................................................................................... System Block Diagram .............................................................................................................. Block Diagram .......................................................................................................................... Functional Description ............................................................................................................... Serial Wire and JTAG Debug ..................................................................................................... Embedded Trace Macrocell (ETM) ............................................................................................. Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) ................................................................................................. ROM Table ............................................................................................................................... Memory Protection Unit (MPU) ................................................................................................... Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) ................................................................................ 2 2.1 2.2 2.2.1 2.2.2 2.2.3 2.2.4 2.2.5 2.2.6 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core ...................................................................................... 34 3 4 5 5.1 5.2 5.2.1 5.2.2 5.2.3 5.2.4 5.3 5.4 5.4.1 5.4.2 Memory Map ....................................................................................................................... 40 Interrupts ............................................................................................................................ 42 JTAG Interface .................................................................................................................... 44 Block Diagram .......................................................................................................................... Functional Description ............................................................................................................... JTAG Interface Pins .................................................................................................................. JTAG TAP Controller ................................................................................................................. Shift Registers .......................................................................................................................... Operational Considerations ........................................................................................................ Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................... Register Descriptions ................................................................................................................ Instruction Register (IR) ............................................................................................................. Data Registers .......................................................................................................................... 45 45 46 47 48 48 49 50 50 52 6 6.1 6.1.1 System Control ................................................................................................................... 54 Functional Description ............................................................................................................... 54 Device Identification .................................................................................................................. 54 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 3 Table of Contents 6.1.2 6.1.3 6.1.4 6.1.5 6.2 6.3 6.4 Reset Control ............................................................................................................................ Power Control ........................................................................................................................... Clock Control ............................................................................................................................ System Control ......................................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................... Register Map ............................................................................................................................ Register Descriptions ................................................................................................................ 54 57 57 60 60 61 62 7 7.1 7.2 7.2.1 7.2.2 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.4 7.5 7.6 Internal Memory ............................................................................................................... 113 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 113 Functional Description ............................................................................................................. 113 SRAM Memory ........................................................................................................................ 113 Flash Memory ......................................................................................................................... 114 Flash Memory Initialization and Configuration ........................................................................... 116 Changing Flash Protection Bits ................................................................................................ 116 Flash Programming ................................................................................................................. 117 Register Map .......................................................................................................................... 117 Flash Register Descriptions (Flash Control Offset) ..................................................................... 118 Flash Register Descriptions (System Control Offset) .................................................................. 125 8 8.1 8.2 8.2.1 8.2.2 8.2.3 8.2.4 8.2.5 8.3 8.4 8.5 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) ....................................................................... 129 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 130 Functional Description ............................................................................................................. 130 Data Control ........................................................................................................................... 131 Interrupt Control ...................................................................................................................... 132 Mode Control .......................................................................................................................... 133 Pad Control ............................................................................................................................. 133 Identification ........................................................................................................................... 133 Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. 133 Register Map .......................................................................................................................... 134 Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. 136 9 9.1 9.2 9.2.1 9.2.2 9.2.3 9.3 9.3.1 9.3.2 9.3.3 9.3.4 9.3.5 9.3.6 9.4 9.5 General-Purpose Timers ................................................................................................. 168 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. GPTM Reset Conditions .......................................................................................................... 32-Bit Timer Operating Modes .................................................................................................. 16-Bit Timer Operating Modes .................................................................................................. Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. 32-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode ....................................................................................... 32-Bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) Mode ......................................................................................... 16-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode ....................................................................................... 16-Bit Input Edge Count Mode ................................................................................................. 16-Bit Input Edge Timing Mode ................................................................................................ 16-Bit PWM Mode ................................................................................................................... Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. 169 169 169 169 171 175 175 176 176 177 177 178 178 179 10 10.1 10.2 Watchdog Timer ............................................................................................................... 204 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 204 Functional Description ............................................................................................................. 204 4 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 10.3 10.4 10.5 Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. 205 Register Map .......................................................................................................................... 205 Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. 206 11 11.1 11.2 11.2.1 11.2.2 11.2.3 11.2.4 11.2.5 11.2.6 11.3 11.4 11.5 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) ......................................... 227 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. Transmit/Receive Logic ........................................................................................................... Baud-Rate Generation ............................................................................................................. Data Transmission .................................................................................................................. FIFO Operation ....................................................................................................................... Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ Loopback Operation ................................................................................................................ Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. Bit Rate Generation ................................................................................................................. FIFO Operation ....................................................................................................................... Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ Frame Formats ....................................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. I2C Bus Functional Overview .................................................................................................... Available Speed Modes ........................................................................................................... Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ Loopback Operation ................................................................................................................ Command Sequence Flow Charts ............................................................................................ Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. I2C Register Map ..................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions (I2C Master) ........................................................................................... Register Descriptions (I2C Slave) ............................................................................................. Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. Internal Reference Programming .............................................................................................. Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. 228 228 228 229 230 230 230 231 231 232 233 265 265 266 266 266 267 274 275 276 302 302 303 305 306 306 307 313 314 315 328 338 338 340 341 341 342 12 12.1 12.2 12.2.1 12.2.2 12.2.3 12.2.4 12.3 12.4 12.5 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ................................................................................ 265 13 13.1 13.2 13.2.1 13.2.2 13.2.3 13.2.4 13.2.5 13.3 13.4 13.5 13.6 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface ............................................................................ 302 14 14.1 14.2 14.2.1 14.3 14.4 14.5 Analog Comparators ....................................................................................................... 337 15 15.1 15.2 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) ........................................................................................ 350 Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 350 Functional Description ............................................................................................................. 350 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 5 Table of Contents 15.2.1 15.2.2 15.2.3 15.2.4 15.2.5 15.2.6 15.2.7 15.2.8 15.3 15.4 15.5 PWM Timer ............................................................................................................................. PWM Comparators .................................................................................................................. PWM Signal Generator ............................................................................................................ Dead-Band Generator ............................................................................................................. Interrupt Selector ..................................................................................................................... Synchronization Methods ......................................................................................................... Fault Conditions ...................................................................................................................... Output Control Block ............................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. Block Diagram ........................................................................................................................ Functional Description ............................................................................................................. Initialization and Configuration ................................................................................................. Register Map .......................................................................................................................... Register Descriptions .............................................................................................................. 350 351 352 353 353 353 354 354 354 355 357 386 387 389 389 390 16 16.1 16.2 16.3 16.4 16.5 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) ............................................................................... 386 17 18 19 20 20.1 20.1.1 20.1.2 20.1.3 20.1.4 20.1.5 20.2 20.2.1 20.2.2 20.2.3 20.2.4 20.2.5 20.2.6 20.2.7 20.2.8 Pin Diagram ...................................................................................................................... 403 Signal Tables .................................................................................................................... 404 Operating Characteristics ............................................................................................... 412 Electrical Characteristics ................................................................................................ 413 DC Characteristics .................................................................................................................. 413 Maximum Ratings ................................................................................................................... 413 Recommended DC Operating Conditions .................................................................................. 413 On-Chip Low Drop-Out (LDO) Regulator Characteristics ............................................................ 414 Power Specifications ............................................................................................................... 414 Flash Memory Characteristics .................................................................................................. 415 AC Characteristics ................................................................................................................... 415 Load Conditions ...................................................................................................................... 415 Clocks .................................................................................................................................... 415 Analog Comparator ................................................................................................................. 416 I2C ......................................................................................................................................... 416 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ........................................................................................... 417 JTAG and Boundary Scan ........................................................................................................ 418 General-Purpose I/O ............................................................................................................... 420 Reset ..................................................................................................................................... 420 21 A A.1 A.2 A.2.1 A.2.2 A.3 A.3.1 A.3.2 A.3.3 Package Information ........................................................................................................ 423 Serial Flash Loader .......................................................................................................... 425 Serial Flash Loader ................................................................................................................. Interfaces ............................................................................................................................... UART ..................................................................................................................................... SSI ......................................................................................................................................... Packet Handling ...................................................................................................................... Packet Format ........................................................................................................................ Sending Packets ..................................................................................................................... Receiving Packets ................................................................................................................... 425 425 425 425 426 426 426 426 6 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller A.4 A.4.1 A.4.2 A.4.3 A.4.4 A.4.5 A.4.6 Commands ............................................................................................................................. COMMAND_PING (0X20) ........................................................................................................ COMMAND_GET_STATUS (0x23) ........................................................................................... COMMAND_DOWNLOAD (0x21) ............................................................................................. COMMAND_SEND_DATA (0x24) ............................................................................................. COMMAND_RUN (0x22) ......................................................................................................... COMMAND_RESET (0x25) ..................................................................................................... 427 427 427 427 428 428 428 B C C.1 C.2 C.3 C.4 Register Quick Reference ............................................................................................... 430 Ordering and Contact Information ................................................................................. 445 Ordering Information ................................................................................................................ Kits ......................................................................................................................................... Company Information .............................................................................................................. Support Information ................................................................................................................. 445 445 445 446 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 7 Table of Contents List of Figures Figure 1-1. Figure 1-2. Figure 2-1. Figure 2-2. Figure 5-1. Figure 5-2. Figure 5-3. Figure 5-4. Figure 5-5. Figure 6-1. Figure 6-2. Figure 7-1. Figure 8-1. Figure 8-2. Figure 8-3. Figure 8-4. Figure 9-1. Figure 9-2. Figure 9-3. Figure 9-4. Figure 10-1. Figure 11-1. Figure 11-2. Figure 12-1. Figure 12-2. Figure 12-3. Figure 12-4. Figure 12-5. Figure 12-6. Figure 12-7. Figure 12-8. Figure 12-9. Figure 12-10. Figure 12-11. Figure 12-12. Figure 13-1. Figure 13-2. Figure 13-3. Figure 13-4. Figure 13-5. Figure 13-6. Figure 13-7. Figure 13-8. Figure 13-9. Figure 13-10. Stellaris 600 Series High-Level Block Diagram ................................................................ 26 LM3S601 Controller System-Level Block Diagram ............................................................. 33 CPU Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... 35 TPIU Block Diagram ........................................................................................................ 36 JTAG Module Block Diagram ............................................................................................ 45 Test Access Port State Machine ....................................................................................... 48 IDCODE Register Format ................................................................................................. 52 BYPASS Register Format ................................................................................................ 52 Boundary Scan Register Format ....................................................................................... 53 External Circuitry to Extend Reset .................................................................................... 55 Main Clock Tree .............................................................................................................. 58 Flash Block Diagram ...................................................................................................... 113 GPIO Module Block Diagram .......................................................................................... 130 GPIO Port Block Diagram ............................................................................................... 131 GPIODATA Write Example ............................................................................................. 132 GPIODATA Read Example ............................................................................................. 132 GPTM Module Block Diagram ........................................................................................ 169 16-Bit Input Edge Count Mode Example .......................................................................... 173 16-Bit Input Edge Time Mode Example ........................................................................... 174 16-Bit PWM Mode Example ............................................................................................ 175 WDT Module Block Diagram .......................................................................................... 204 UART Module Block Diagram ......................................................................................... 228 UART Character Frame ................................................................................................. 229 SSI Module Block Diagram ............................................................................................. 265 TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Single Transfer) .................................................... 267 TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) ............................................ 268 Freescale SPI Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 ...................................... 269 Freescale SPI Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 .............................. 269 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=0 and SPH=1 ..................................................... 270 Freescale SPI Frame Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 ........................... 271 Freescale SPI Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 .................... 271 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=1 and SPH=1 ..................................................... 272 MICROWIRE Frame Format (Single Frame) .................................................................... 273 MICROWIRE Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) ......................................................... 274 MICROWIRE Frame Format, SSIFss Input Setup and Hold Requirements ........................ 274 I2C Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... 302 I2C Bus Configuration .................................................................................................... 303 START and STOP Conditions ......................................................................................... 303 Complete Data Transfer with a 7-Bit Address ................................................................... 304 R/S Bit in First Byte ........................................................................................................ 304 Data Validity During Bit Transfer on the I2C Bus ............................................................... 304 Master Single SEND ...................................................................................................... 307 Master Single RECEIVE ................................................................................................. 308 Master Burst SEND ....................................................................................................... 309 Master Burst RECEIVE .................................................................................................. 310 ® 8 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 13-11. Figure 13-12. Figure 13-13. Figure 14-1. Figure 14-2. Figure 14-3. Figure 15-1. Figure 15-2. Figure 15-3. Figure 15-4. Figure 15-5. Figure 16-1. Figure 16-2. Figure 17-1. Figure 20-1. Figure 20-2. Figure 20-3. Figure 20-4. Figure 20-5. Figure 20-6. Figure 20-7. Figure 20-8. Figure 20-9. Figure 20-10. Figure 20-11. Figure 20-12. Figure 20-13. Figure 20-14. Figure 21-1. Master Burst RECEIVE after Burst SEND ........................................................................ Master Burst SEND after Burst RECEIVE ........................................................................ Slave Command Sequence ............................................................................................ Analog Comparator Module Block Diagram ..................................................................... Structure of Comparator Unit .......................................................................................... Comparator Internal Reference Structure ........................................................................ PWM Module Block Diagram .......................................................................................... PWM Count-Down Mode ................................................................................................ PWM Count-Up/Down Mode .......................................................................................... PWM Generation Example In Count-Up/Down Mode ....................................................... PWM Dead-Band Generator ........................................................................................... QEI Block Diagram ........................................................................................................ Quadrature Encoder and Velocity Predivider Operation .................................................... Pin Connection Diagram ................................................................................................ Load Conditions ............................................................................................................ I2C Timing ..................................................................................................................... SSI Timing for TI Frame Format (FRF=01), Single Transfer Timing Measurement .............. SSI Timing for MICROWIRE Frame Format (FRF=10), Single Transfer ............................. SSI Timing for SPI Frame Format (FRF=00), with SPH=1 ................................................. JTAG Test Clock Input Timing ......................................................................................... JTAG Test Access Port (TAP) Timing .............................................................................. JTAG TRST Timing ........................................................................................................ External Reset Timing (RST) .......................................................................................... Power-On Reset Timing ................................................................................................. Brown-Out Reset Timing ................................................................................................ Software Reset Timing ................................................................................................... Watchdog Reset Timing ................................................................................................. LDO Reset Timing ......................................................................................................... 48-Pin LQFP Package ................................................................................................... 311 312 313 338 339 340 350 351 352 352 353 386 388 403 415 417 417 418 418 419 420 420 421 421 422 422 422 422 423 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 9 Table of Contents List of Tables Table 1. Table 3-1. Table 4-1. Table 4-2. Table 5-1. Table 5-2. Table 6-1. Table 6-2. Table 7-1. Table 7-2. Table 8-1. Table 8-2. Table 8-3. Table 9-1. Table 9-2. Table 10-1. Table 11-1. Table 12-1. Table 13-1. Table 13-2. Table 13-3. Table 14-1. Table 14-2. Table 14-3. Table 14-4. Table 14-5. Table 15-1. Table 16-1. Table 18-1. Table 18-2. Table 18-3. Table 18-4. Table 19-1. Table 19-2. Table 20-1. Table 20-2. Table 20-3. Table 20-4. Table 20-5. Table 20-6. Table 20-7. Table 20-8. Table 20-9. Table 20-10. Table 20-11. Table 20-12. Documentation Conventions ............................................................................................ 18 Memory Map ................................................................................................................... 40 Exception Types .............................................................................................................. 42 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 43 JTAG Port Pins Reset State ............................................................................................. 46 JTAG Instruction Register Commands ............................................................................... 50 System Control Register Map ........................................................................................... 61 PLL Mode Control ........................................................................................................... 76 Flash Protection Policy Combinations ............................................................................. 115 Flash Register Map ........................................................................................................ 118 GPIO Pad Configuration Examples ................................................................................. 133 GPIO Interrupt Configuration Example ............................................................................ 134 GPIO Register Map ....................................................................................................... 135 16-Bit Timer With Prescaler Configurations ..................................................................... 172 Timers Register Map ...................................................................................................... 178 Watchdog Timer Register Map ........................................................................................ 205 UART Register Map ....................................................................................................... 232 SSI Register Map .......................................................................................................... 275 Examples of I2C Master Timer Period versus Speed Mode ............................................... 305 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register Map ......................................................... 314 Write Field Decoding for I2CMCS[3:0] Field (Sheet 1 of 3) ................................................ 319 Comparator 0 Operating Modes ...................................................................................... 339 Comparator 1 Operating Modes ..................................................................................... 339 Comparator 2 Operating Modes ...................................................................................... 340 Internal Reference Voltage and ACREFCTL Field Values ................................................. 340 Analog Comparators Register Map ................................................................................. 342 PWM Register Map ........................................................................................................ 355 QEI Register Map .......................................................................................................... 389 Signals by Pin Number ................................................................................................... 404 Signals by Signal Name ................................................................................................. 406 Signals by Function, Except for GPIO ............................................................................. 409 GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions ................................................................................. 410 Temperature Characteristics ........................................................................................... 412 Thermal Characteristics ................................................................................................. 412 Maximum Ratings .......................................................................................................... 413 Recommended DC Operating Conditions ........................................................................ 413 LDO Regulator Characteristics ....................................................................................... 414 Detailed Power Specifications ........................................................................................ 414 Flash Memory Characteristics ........................................................................................ 415 Phase Locked Loop (PLL) Characteristics ....................................................................... 415 Clock Characteristics ..................................................................................................... 415 Analog Comparator Characteristics ................................................................................. 416 Analog Comparator Voltage Reference Characteristics .................................................... 416 I2C Characteristics ......................................................................................................... 416 SSI Characteristics ........................................................................................................ 417 JTAG Characteristics ..................................................................................................... 418 10 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Table 20-13. GPIO Characteristics ..................................................................................................... 420 Table 20-14. Reset Characteristics ..................................................................................................... 420 Table C-1. Part Ordering Information ............................................................................................... 445 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 11 Table of Contents List of Registers System Control .............................................................................................................................. 54 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Device Identification 0 (DID0), offset 0x000 ....................................................................... 63 Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL), offset 0x030 .................................... 65 LDO Power Control (LDOPCTL), offset 0x034 ................................................................... 66 Raw Interrupt Status (RIS), offset 0x050 ........................................................................... 67 Interrupt Mask Control (IMC), offset 0x054 ........................................................................ 68 Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC), offset 0x058 .................................................... 70 Reset Cause (RESC), offset 0x05C .................................................................................. 71 Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC), offset 0x060 .......................................................... 72 XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG), offset 0x064 .............................................................. 77 Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG), offset 0x144 .......................................... 78 Clock Verification Clear (CLKVCLR), offset 0x150 ............................................................. 79 Allow Unregulated LDO to Reset the Part (LDOARST), offset 0x160 ................................... 80 Device Identification 1 (DID1), offset 0x004 ....................................................................... 81 Device Capabilities 0 (DC0), offset 0x008 ......................................................................... 83 Device Capabilities 1 (DC1), offset 0x010 ......................................................................... 84 Device Capabilities 2 (DC2), offset 0x014 ......................................................................... 86 Device Capabilities 3 (DC3), offset 0x018 ......................................................................... 88 Device Capabilities 4 (DC4), offset 0x01C ......................................................................... 90 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0), offset 0x100 .................................... 91 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0), offset 0x110 .................................. 92 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0), offset 0x120 ......................... 93 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1), offset 0x104 .................................... 94 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1), offset 0x114 .................................. 97 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1), offset 0x124 ....................... 100 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2), offset 0x108 ................................... 103 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2), offset 0x118 ................................. 105 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2), offset 0x128 ....................... 107 Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0), offset 0x040 ............................................................. 109 Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1), offset 0x044 ............................................................. 110 Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2), offset 0x048 ............................................................. 112 Flash Memory Address (FMA), offset 0x000 .................................................................... Flash Memory Data (FMD), offset 0x004 ......................................................................... Flash Memory Control (FMC), offset 0x008 ..................................................................... Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS), offset 0x00C ............................................ Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM), offset 0x010 ........................................................ Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC), offset 0x014 ..................... USec Reload (USECRL), offset 0x140 ............................................................................ Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE), offset 0x130 ......................................... Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPE), offset 0x134 .................................... 119 120 121 123 124 125 126 127 128 Internal Memory ........................................................................................................................... 113 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) ................................................................................... 129 GPIO Data (GPIODATA), offset 0x000 ............................................................................ 137 GPIO Direction (GPIODIR), offset 0x400 ......................................................................... 138 GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS), offset 0x404 .................................................................. 139 12 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 1: GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE), offset 0x408 ........................................................ 140 GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV), offset 0x40C ................................................................ 141 GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM), offset 0x410 ................................................................... 142 GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS), offset 0x414 ........................................................ 143 GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS), offset 0x418 ................................................... 144 GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR), offset 0x41C ................................................................ 145 GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL), offset 0x420 ............................................ 146 GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R), offset 0x500 ........................................................ 148 GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R), offset 0x504 ........................................................ 149 GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R), offset 0x508 ........................................................ 150 GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR), offset 0x50C ......................................................... 151 GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR), offset 0x510 ................................................................ 152 GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR), offset 0x514 ........................................................... 153 GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR), offset 0x518 ................................................ 154 GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN), offset 0x51C ................................................................ 155 GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ....................................... 156 GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ....................................... 157 GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ....................................... 158 GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ...................................... 159 GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ....................................... 160 GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ....................................... 161 GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ....................................... 162 GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ...................................... 163 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 .......................................... 164 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 .......................................... 165 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 .......................................... 166 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ......................................... 167 GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG), offset 0x000 .............................................................. GPTM TimerA Mode (GPTMTAMR), offset 0x004 ............................................................ GPTM TimerB Mode (GPTMTBMR), offset 0x008 ............................................................ GPTM Control (GPTMCTL), offset 0x00C ........................................................................ GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR), offset 0x018 .............................................................. GPTM Raw Interrupt Status (GPTMRIS), offset 0x01C ..................................................... GPTM Masked Interrupt Status (GPTMMIS), offset 0x020 ................................................ GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR), offset 0x024 .............................................................. GPTM TimerA Interval Load (GPTMTAILR), offset 0x028 ................................................. GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR), offset 0x02C ................................................ GPTM TimerA Match (GPTMTAMATCHR), offset 0x030 ................................................... GPTM TimerB Match (GPTMTBMATCHR), offset 0x034 .................................................. GPTM TimerA Prescale (GPTMTAPR), offset 0x038 ........................................................ GPTM TimerB Prescale (GPTMTBPR), offset 0x03C ....................................................... GPTM TimerA Prescale Match (GPTMTAPMR), offset 0x040 ........................................... GPTM TimerB Prescale Match (GPTMTBPMR), offset 0x044 ........................................... GPTM TimerA (GPTMTAR), offset 0x048 ........................................................................ GPTM TimerB (GPTMTBR), offset 0x04C ....................................................................... 180 181 183 185 188 190 191 192 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 General-Purpose Timers ............................................................................................................. 168 Watchdog Timer ........................................................................................................................... 204 Watchdog Load (WDTLOAD), offset 0x000 ...................................................................... 207 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 13 Table of Contents Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Watchdog Value (WDTVALUE), offset 0x004 ................................................................... Watchdog Control (WDTCTL), offset 0x008 ..................................................................... Watchdog Interrupt Clear (WDTICR), offset 0x00C .......................................................... Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status (WDTRIS), offset 0x010 .................................................. Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status (WDTMIS), offset 0x014 ............................................. Watchdog Test (WDTTEST), offset 0x418 ....................................................................... Watchdog Lock (WDTLOCK), offset 0xC00 ..................................................................... Watchdog Peripheral Identification 4 (WDTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 5 (WDTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 6 (WDTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 7 (WDTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ................................ Watchdog Peripheral Identification 0 (WDTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 1 (WDTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 2 (WDTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ................................. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 3 (WDTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ................................. Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 0 (WDTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 .................................... Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 1 (WDTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 .................................... Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 2 (WDTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 .................................... Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 3 (WDTPCellID3 ), offset 0xFFC .................................. UART Data (UARTDR), offset 0x000 ............................................................................... UART Receive Status/Error Clear (UARTRSR/UARTECR), offset 0x004 ........................... UART Flag (UARTFR), offset 0x018 ................................................................................ UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTIBRD), offset 0x024 ............................................ UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTFBRD), offset 0x028 ....................................... UART Line Control (UARTLCRH), offset 0x02C ............................................................... UART Control (UARTCTL), offset 0x030 ......................................................................... UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select (UARTIFLS), offset 0x034 ........................................... UART Interrupt Mask (UARTIM), offset 0x038 ................................................................. UART Raw Interrupt Status (UARTRIS), offset 0x03C ...................................................... UART Masked Interrupt Status (UARTMIS), offset 0x040 ................................................. UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR), offset 0x044 ............................................................... UART Peripheral Identification 4 (UARTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ..................................... UART Peripheral Identification 5 (UARTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ..................................... UART Peripheral Identification 6 (UARTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ..................................... UART Peripheral Identification 7 (UARTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ..................................... UART Peripheral Identification 0 (UARTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ...................................... UART Peripheral Identification 1 (UARTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ...................................... UART Peripheral Identification 2 (UARTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ...................................... UART Peripheral Identification 3 (UARTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ..................................... UART PrimeCell Identification 0 (UARTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 1 (UARTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 2 (UARTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 3 (UARTPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ........................................ 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 234 236 238 240 241 242 244 245 247 249 250 251 253 254 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) ..................................................... 227 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ............................................................................................ 265 SSI Control 0 (SSICR0), offset 0x000 .............................................................................. 277 SSI Control 1 (SSICR1), offset 0x004 .............................................................................. 279 SSI Data (SSIDR), offset 0x008 ...................................................................................... 281 14 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: SSI Status (SSISR), offset 0x00C ................................................................................... SSI Clock Prescale (SSICPSR), offset 0x010 .................................................................. SSI Interrupt Mask (SSIIM), offset 0x014 ......................................................................... SSI Raw Interrupt Status (SSIRIS), offset 0x018 .............................................................. SSI Masked Interrupt Status (SSIMIS), offset 0x01C ........................................................ SSI Interrupt Clear (SSIICR), offset 0x020 ....................................................................... SSI Peripheral Identification 4 (SSIPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 5 (SSIPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 6 (SSIPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 7 (SSIPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ............................................ SSI Peripheral Identification 0 (SSIPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 1 (SSIPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 2 (SSIPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ............................................. SSI Peripheral Identification 3 (SSIPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ............................................ SSI PrimeCell Identification 0 (SSIPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 ............................................... SSI PrimeCell Identification 1 (SSIPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 ............................................... SSI PrimeCell Identification 2 (SSIPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 ............................................... SSI PrimeCell Identification 3 (SSIPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ............................................... I2C Master Slave Address (I2CMSA), offset 0x000 ........................................................... I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS), offset 0x004 ........................................................... I2C Master Data (I2CMDR), offset 0x008 ......................................................................... I2C Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR), offset 0x00C ........................................................... I2C Master Interrupt Mask (I2CMIMR), offset 0x010 ......................................................... I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status (I2CMRIS), offset 0x014 ................................................. I2C Master Masked Interrupt Status (I2CMMIS), offset 0x018 ........................................... I2C Master Interrupt Clear (I2CMICR), offset 0x01C ......................................................... I2C Master Configuration (I2CMCR), offset 0x020 ............................................................ I2C Slave Own Address (I2CSOAR), offset 0x000 ............................................................ I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR), offset 0x004 ........................................................... I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR), offset 0x008 ........................................................................... I2C Slave Interrupt Mask (I2CSIMR), offset 0x00C ........................................................... I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status (I2CSRIS), offset 0x010 ................................................... I2C Slave Masked Interrupt Status (I2CSMIS), offset 0x014 .............................................. I2C Slave Interrupt Clear (I2CSICR), offset 0x018 ............................................................ Analog Comparator Masked Interrupt Status (ACMIS), offset 0x00 .................................... Analog Comparator Raw Interrupt Status (ACRIS), offset 0x04 ......................................... Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable (ACINTEN), offset 0x08 ........................................... Analog Comparator Reference Voltage Control (ACREFCTL), offset 0x10 ......................... Analog Comparator Status 0 (ACSTAT0), offset 0x20 ....................................................... Analog Comparator Status 1 (ACSTAT1), offset 0x40 ....................................................... Analog Comparator Status 2 (ACSTAT2), offset 0x60 ....................................................... Analog Comparator Control 0 (ACCTL0), offset 0x24 ....................................................... Analog Comparator Control 1 (ACCTL1), offset 0x44 ....................................................... Analog Comparator Control 2 (ACCTL2), offset 0x64 ...................................................... 282 284 285 287 288 289 290 291 292 293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 316 317 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 329 330 332 333 334 335 336 343 344 345 346 347 347 347 348 348 348 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface ........................................................................................ 302 Analog Comparators ................................................................................................................... 337 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 15 Table of Contents Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) .................................................................................................... 350 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Register 33: Register 34: Register 35: Register 36: Register 37: Register 38: Register 39: Register 40: Register 41: Register 42: Register 43: Register 44: Register 45: Register 46: Register 47: PWM Master Control (PWMCTL), offset 0x000 ................................................................ 358 PWM Time Base Sync (PWMSYNC), offset 0x004 ........................................................... 359 PWM Output Enable (PWMENABLE), offset 0x008 .......................................................... 360 PWM Output Inversion (PWMINVERT), offset 0x00C ....................................................... 361 PWM Output Fault (PWMFAULT), offset 0x010 ................................................................ 362 PWM Interrupt Enable (PWMINTEN), offset 0x014 ........................................................... 363 PWM Raw Interrupt Status (PWMRIS), offset 0x018 ........................................................ 364 PWM Interrupt Status and Clear (PWMISC), offset 0x01C ................................................ 365 PWM Status (PWMSTATUS), offset 0x020 ...................................................................... 366 PWM0 Control (PWM0CTL), offset 0x040 ....................................................................... 367 PWM1 Control (PWM1CTL), offset 0x080 ....................................................................... 367 PWM2 Control (PWM2CTL), offset 0x0C0 ...................................................................... 367 PWM0 Interrupt Enable (PWM0INTEN), offset 0x044 ...................................................... 369 PWM1 Interrupt Enable (PWM1INTEN), offset 0x084 ...................................................... 369 PWM2 InterruptEnable (PWM2INTEN), offset 0x0C4 ...................................................... 369 PWM0 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM0RIS), offset 0x048 .................................................... 371 PWM1 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM1RIS), offset 0x088 .................................................... 371 PWM2 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM2RIS), offset 0x0C8 ................................................... 371 PWM0 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM0ISC), offset 0x04C ........................................... 372 PWM1 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM1ISC), offset 0x08C ........................................... 372 PWM2 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM2ISC), offset 0x0CC ........................................... 372 PWM0 Load (PWM0LOAD), offset 0x050 ....................................................................... 373 PWM1 Load (PWM1LOAD), offset 0x090 ....................................................................... 373 PWM2 Load (PWM2LOAD), offset 0x0D0 ....................................................................... 373 PWM0 Counter (PWM0COUNT), offset 0x054 ................................................................ 374 PWM1 Counter (PWM1COUNT), offset 0x094 ................................................................ 374 PWM2 Counter (PWM2COUNT), offset 0x0D4 ............................................................... 374 PWM0 Compare A (PWM0CMPA), offset 0x058 ............................................................. 375 PWM1 Compare A (PWM1CMPA), offset 0x098 ............................................................. 375 PWM2 Compare A (PWM2CMPA), offset 0x0D8 ............................................................. 375 PWM0 Compare B (PWM0CMPB), offset 0x05C ............................................................. 376 PWM1 Compare B (PWM1CMPB), offset 0x09C ............................................................. 376 PWM2 Compare B (PWM2CMPB), offset 0x0DC ............................................................ 376 PWM0 Generator A Control (PWM0GENA), offset 0x060 ................................................ 377 PWM1 Generator A Control (PWM1GENA), offset 0x0A0 ................................................ 377 PWM2 Generator A Control (PWM2GENA), offset 0x0E0 ................................................ 377 PWM0 Generator B Control (PWM0GENB), offset 0x064 ................................................ 380 PWM1 Generator B Control (PWM1GENB), offset 0x0A4 ................................................ 380 PWM2 Generator B Control (PWM2GENB), offset 0x0E4 ................................................ 380 PWM0 Dead-Band Control (PWM0DBCTL), offset 0x068 ................................................ 383 PWM1 Dead-Band Control (PWM1DBCTL), offset 0x0A8 ................................................. 383 PWM2 Dead-Band Control (PWM2DBCTL), offset 0x0E8 ................................................ 383 PWM0 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM0DBRISE), offset 0x06C ............................. 384 PWM1 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM1DBRISE), offset 0x0AC ............................. 384 PWM2 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM2DBRISE), offset 0x0EC ............................. 384 PWM0 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM0DBFALL), offset 0x070 ............................. 385 PWM1 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM1DBFALL), offset 0x0B0 ............................. 385 16 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 48: Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: PWM2 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM2DBFALL), offset 0x0F0 ............................. 385 QEI Control (QEICTL), offset 0x000 ................................................................................ QEI Status (QEISTAT), offset 0x004 ................................................................................ QEI Position (QEIPOS), offset 0x008 .............................................................................. QEI Maximum Position (QEIMAXPOS), offset 0x00C ....................................................... QEI Timer Load (QEILOAD), offset 0x010 ....................................................................... QEI Timer (QEITIME), offset 0x014 ................................................................................. QEI Velocity Counter (QEICOUNT), offset 0x018 ............................................................. QEI Velocity (QEISPEED), offset 0x01C .......................................................................... QEI Interrupt Enable (QEIINTEN), offset 0x020 ............................................................... QEI Raw Interrupt Status (QEIRIS), offset 0x024 ............................................................. QEI Interrupt Status and Clear (QEIISC), offset 0x028 ..................................................... 391 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) .......................................................................................... 386 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 17 About This Document About This Document This data sheet provides reference information for the LM3S601 microcontroller, describing the functional blocks of the system-on-chip (SoC) device designed around the ARM® Cortex™-M3 core. Audience This manual is intended for system software developers, hardware designers, and application developers. About This Manual This document is organized into sections that correspond to each major feature. Related Documents The following documents are referenced by the data sheet, and available on the documentation CD or from the Luminary Micro web site at www.luminarymicro.com: ■ ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual ■ ARM® CoreSight Technical Reference Manual ■ ARM® v7-M Architecture Application Level Reference Manual The following related documents are also referenced: ■ IEEE Standard 1149.1-Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture This documentation list was current as of publication date. Please check the Luminary Micro web site for additional documentation, including application notes and white papers. Documentation Conventions This document uses the conventions shown in Table 1 on page 18. Table 1. Documentation Conventions Notation Meaning General Register Notation REGISTER APB registers are indicated in uppercase bold. For example, PBORCTL is the Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control register. If a register name contains a lowercase n, it represents more than one register. For example, SRCRn represents any (or all) of the three Software Reset Control registers: SRCR0, SRCR1 , and SRCR2. A single bit in a register. Two or more consecutive and related bits. A hexadecimal increment to a register's address, relative to that module's base address as specified in “Memory Map” on page 40. Registers are numbered consecutively throughout the document to aid in referencing them. The register number has no meaning to software. bit bit field offset 0xnnn Register N 18 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Notation reserved Meaning Register bits marked reserved are reserved for future use. In most cases, reserved bits are set to 0; however, user software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide software compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. The range of register bits inclusive from xx to yy. For example, 31:15 means bits 15 through 31 in that register. This value in the register bit diagram indicates whether software running on the controller can change the value of the bit field. Software can read this field. The bit or field is cleared by hardware after reading the bit/field. Software can read this field. Always write the chip reset value. Software can read or write this field. Software can read or write this field. A write of a 0 to a W1C bit does not affect the bit value in the register. A write of a 1 clears the value of the bit in the register; the remaining bits remain unchanged. This register type is primarily used for clearing interrupt status bits where the read operation provides the interrupt status and the write of the read value clears only the interrupts being reported at the time the register was read. yy:xx Register Bit/Field Types RC RO R/W R/W1C W1C Software can write this field. A write of a 0 to a W1C bit does not affect the bit value in the register. A write of a 1 clears the value of the bit in the register; the remaining bits remain unchanged. A read of the register returns no meaningful data. This register is typically used to clear the corresponding bit in an interrupt register. WO Register Bit/Field Reset Value 0 1 Pin/Signal Notation [] pin signal assert a signal Only a write by software is valid; a read of the register returns no meaningful data. This value in the register bit diagram shows the bit/field value after any reset, unless noted. Bit cleared to 0 on chip reset. Bit set to 1 on chip reset. Nondeterministic. Pin alternate function; a pin defaults to the signal without the brackets. Refers to the physical connection on the package. Refers to the electrical signal encoding of a pin. Change the value of the signal from the logically False state to the logically True state. For active High signals, the asserted signal value is 1 (High); for active Low signals, the asserted signal value is 0 (Low). The active polarity (High or Low) is defined by the signal name (see SIGNAL and SIGNAL below). Change the value of the signal from the logically True state to the logically False state. Signal names are in uppercase and in the Courier font. An overbar on a signal name indicates that it is active Low. To assert SIGNAL is to drive it Low; to deassert SIGNAL is to drive it High. Signal names are in uppercase and in the Courier font. An active High signal has no overbar. To assert SIGNAL is to drive it High; to deassert SIGNAL is to drive it Low. deassert a signal SIGNAL SIGNAL Numbers X An uppercase X indicates any of several values is allowed, where X can be any legal pattern. For example, a binary value of 0X00 can be either 0100 or 0000, a hex value of 0xX is 0x0 or 0x1, and so on. Hexadecimal numbers have a prefix of 0x. For example, 0x00FF is the hexadecimal number FF. All other numbers within register tables are assumed to be binary. Within conceptual information, binary numbers are indicated with a b suffix, for example, 1011b, and decimal numbers are written without a prefix or suffix. 0x October 01, 2007 Preliminary 19 Architectural Overview 1 Architectural Overview The Luminary Micro Stellaris family of microcontrollers—the first ARM® Cortex™-M3 based controllers—brings high-performance 32-bit computing to cost-sensitive embedded microcontroller applications. These pioneering parts deliver customers 32-bit performance at a cost equivalent to legacy 8- and 16-bit devices, all in a package with a small footprint. The LM3S601 microcontroller is targeted for industrial applications, including test and measurement equipment, factory automation, HVAC and building control, motion control, medical instrumentation, fire and security, and power/energy. In addition, the LM3S601 microcontroller offers the advantages of ARM's widely available development tools, System-on-Chip (SoC) infrastructure IP applications, and a large user community. Additionally, the microcontroller uses ARM's Thumb®-compatible Thumb-2 instruction set to reduce memory requirements and, thereby, cost. Finally, the LM3S601 microcontroller is code-compatible ® to all members of the extensive Stellaris family; providing flexibility to fit our customers' precise needs. Luminary Micro offers a complete solution to get to market quickly, with evaluation and development boards, white papers and application notes, an easy-to-use peripheral driver library, and a strong support, sales, and distributor network. ® 1.1 Product Features The LM3S601 microcontroller includes the following product features: ■ 32-Bit RISC Performance – 32-bit ARM® Cortex™-M3 v7M architecture optimized for small-footprint embedded applications – System timer (SysTick), providing a simple, 24-bit clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism – Thumb®-compatible Thumb-2-only instruction set processor core for high code density – 50-MHz operation – Hardware-division and single-cycle-multiplication – Integrated Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) providing deterministic interrupt handling – 25 interrupts with eight priority levels – Memory protection unit (MPU), providing a privileged mode for protected operating system functionality – Unaligned data access, enabling data to be efficiently packed into memory – Atomic bit manipulation (bit-banding), delivering maximum memory utilization and streamlined peripheral control ■ Internal Memory 20 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller – 32 KB single-cycle flash • • • User-managed flash block protection on a 2-KB block basis User-managed flash data programming User-defined and managed flash-protection block – 8 KB single-cycle SRAM ■ General-Purpose Timers – Three General-Purpose Timer Modules (GPTM), each of which provides two 16-bit timer/counters. Each GPTM can be configured to operate independently as timers or event counters as a single 32-bit timer, as one 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) to event capture, or for Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) – 32-bit Timer modes • • • • Programmable one-shot timer Programmable periodic timer Real-Time Clock when using an external 32.768-KHz clock as the input User-enabled stalling in periodic and one-shot mode when the controller asserts the CPU Halt flag during debug – 16-bit Timer modes • • • • General-purpose timer function with an 8-bit prescaler Programmable one-shot timer Programmable periodic timer User-enabled stalling when the controller asserts CPU Halt flag during debug – 16-bit Input Capture modes • • Input edge count capture Input edge time capture – 16-bit PWM mode • Simple PWM mode with software-programmable output inversion of the PWM signal ■ ARM FiRM-compliant Watchdog Timer – 32-bit down counter with a programmable load register – Separate watchdog clock with an enable – Programmable interrupt generation logic with interrupt masking – Lock register protection from runaway software October 01, 2007 Preliminary 21 Architectural Overview – Reset generation logic with an enable/disable – User-enabled stalling when the controller asserts the CPU Halt flag during debug ■ Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) – Master or slave operation – Programmable clock bit rate and prescale – Separate transmit and receive FIFOs, 16 bits wide, 8 locations deep – Programmable interface operation for Freescale SPI, MICROWIRE, or Texas Instruments synchronous serial interfaces – Programmable data frame size from 4 to 16 bits – Internal loopback test mode for diagnostic/debug testing ■ UART – Two fully programmable 16C550-type UARTs – Separate 16x8 transmit (TX) and 16x12 receive (RX) FIFOs to reduce CPU interrupt service loading – Programmable baud-rate generator with fractional divider – Programmable FIFO length, including 1-byte deep operation providing conventional double-buffered interface – FIFO trigger levels of 1/8, 1/4, 1/2, 3/4, and 7/8 – Standard asynchronous communication bits for start, stop, and parity – False-start-bit detection – Line-break generation and detection ■ Analog Comparators – Three independent integrated analog comparators – Configurable for output to: drive an output pin or generate an interrupt – Compare external pin input to external pin input or to internal programmable voltage reference ■ I2C – Master and slave receive and transmit operation with transmission speed up to 100 Kbps in Standard mode and 400 Kbps in Fast mode – Interrupt generation – Master with arbitration and clock synchronization, multimaster support, and 7-bit addressing mode 22 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller ■ PWM – Three PWM generator blocks, each with one 16-bit counter, two comparators, a PWM generator, and a dead-band generator – One 16-bit counter • • • • Runs in Down or Up/Down mode Output frequency controlled by a 16-bit load value Load value updates can be synchronized Produces output signals at zero and load value – Two PWM comparators • • Comparator value updates can be synchronized Produces output signals on match – PWM generator • • Output PWM signal is constructed based on actions taken as a result of the counter and PWM comparator output signals Produces two independent PWM signals – Dead-band generator • • Produces two PWM signals with programmable dead-band delays suitable for driving a half-H bridge Can be bypassed, leaving input PWM signals unmodified – Flexible output control block with PWM output enable of each PWM signal • • • • • • ■ QEI – Hardware position integrator tracks the encoder position – Velocity capture using built-in timer – Interrupt generation on index pulse, velocity-timer expiration, direction change, and quadrature error detection PWM output enable of each PWM signal Optional output inversion of each PWM signal (polarity control) Optional fault handling for each PWM signal Synchronization of timers in the PWM generator blocks Synchronization of timer/comparator updates across the PWM generator blocks Interrupt status summary of the PWM generator blocks October 01, 2007 Preliminary 23 Architectural Overview ■ GPIOs – 0-36 GPIOs, depending on configuration – 5-V-tolerant input/outputs – Programmable interrupt generation as either edge-triggered or level-sensitive – Bit masking in both read and write operations through address lines – Programmable control for GPIO pad configuration: • • • • • ■ Power – On-chip Low Drop-Out (LDO) voltage regulator, with programmable output user-adjustable from 2.25 V to 2.75 V – Low-power options on controller: Sleep and Deep-sleep modes – Low-power options for peripherals: software controls shutdown of individual peripherals – User-enabled LDO unregulated voltage detection and automatic reset – 3.3-V supply brown-out detection and reporting via interrupt or reset ■ Flexible Reset Sources – Power-on reset (POR) – Reset pin assertion – Brown-out (BOR) detector alerts to system power drops – Software reset – Watchdog timer reset – Internal low drop-out (LDO) regulator output goes unregulated ■ Additional Features – Six reset sources – Programmable clock source control – Clock gating to individual peripherals for power savings Weak pull-up or pull-down resistors 2-mA, 4-mA, and 8-mA pad drive Slew rate control for the 8-mA drive Open drain enables Digital input enables 24 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller – IEEE 1149.1-1990 compliant Test Access Port (TAP) controller – Debug access via JTAG and Serial Wire interfaces – Full JTAG boundary scan ■ Industrial-range 48-pin RoHS-compliant LQFP package 1.2 Target Applications ■ Factory automation and control ■ Industrial control power devices ■ Building and home automation ■ Stepper motors ■ Brushless DC motors ■ AC induction motors 1.3 High-Level Block Diagram Figure 1-1 on page 26 represents the full set of features in the Stellaris 600 series of devices; not all features may be available on the LM3S601 microcontroller. ® October 01, 2007 Preliminary 25 Architectural Overview Figure 1-1. Stellaris 600 Series High-Level Block Diagram ® 1.4 Functional Overview The following sections provide an overview of the features of the LM3S601 microcontroller. The page number in parenthesis indicates where that feature is discussed in detail. Ordering and support information can be found in “Ordering and Contact Information” on page 445. 26 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1.4.1 1.4.1.1 ARM Cortex™-M3 Processor Core (see page 34) All members of the Stellaris product family, including the LM3S601 microcontroller, are designed around an ARM Cortex™-M3 processor core. The ARM Cortex-M3 processor provides the core for a high-performance, low-cost platform that meets the needs of minimal memory implementation, reduced pin count, and low-power consumption, while delivering outstanding computational performance and exceptional system response to interrupts. “ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core” on page 34 provides an overview of the ARM core; the core is detailed in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. ® 1.4.1.2 System Timer (SysTick) Cortex-M3 includes an integrated system timer, SysTick. SysTick provides a simple, 24-bit clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism. The counter can be used in several different ways, for example: ■ An RTOS tick timer which fires at a programmable rate (for example, 100 Hz) and invokes a SysTick routine. ■ A high-speed alarm timer using the system clock. ■ A variable rate alarm or signal timer—the duration is range-dependent on the reference clock used and the dynamic range of the counter. ■ A simple counter. Software can use this to measure time to completion and time used. ■ An internal clock source control based on missing/meeting durations. The COUNTFLAG bit-field in the control and status register can be used to determine if an action completed within a set duration, as part of a dynamic clock management control loop. 1.4.1.3 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) The LM3S601 controller includes the ARM Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) on the ARM Cortex-M3 core. The NVIC and Cortex-M3 prioritize and handle all exceptions. All exceptions are handled in Handler Mode. The processor state is automatically stored to the stack on an exception, and automatically restored from the stack at the end of the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). The vector is fetched in parallel to the state saving, which enables efficient interrupt entry. The processor supports tail-chaining, which enables back-to-back interrupts to be performed without the overhead of state saving and restoration. Software can set eight priority levels on 7 exceptions (system handlers) and 25 interrupts. “Interrupts” on page 42 provides an overview of the NVIC controller and the interrupt map. Exceptions and interrupts are detailed in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. 1.4.2 Motor Control Peripherals To enhance motor control, the LM3S601 controller features Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) outputs and the Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI). 1.4.2.1 PWM (see page 174) Pulse width modulation (PWM) is a powerful technique for digitally encoding analog signal levels. High-resolution counters are used to generate a square wave, and the duty cycle of the square October 01, 2007 Preliminary 27 Architectural Overview wave is modulated to encode an analog signal. Typical applications include switching power supplies and motor control. On the LM3S601, PWM motion control functionality can be achieved through dedicated, flexible motion control hardware (the PWM pins) or through the motion control features of the general-purpose timers (using the CCP pins). PWM Pins (see page 350) The LM3S601 PWM module consists of three PWM generator blocks and a control block. Each PWM generator block contains one timer (16-bit down or up/down counter), two comparators, a PWM signal generator, a dead-band generator, and an interrupt. The control block determines the polarity of the PWM signals, and which signals are passed through to the pins. Each PWM generator block produces two PWM signals that can either be independent signals or a single pair of complementary signals with dead-band delays inserted. The output of the PWM generation blocks are managed by the output control block before being passed to the device pins. CCP Pins (see page 174) The General-Purpose Timer Module's CCP (Capture Compare PWM) pins are software programmable to support a simple PWM mode with a software-programmable output inversion of the PWM signal. 1.4.2.2 QEI (see page 386) A quadrature encoder, also known as a 2-channel incremental encoder, converts linear displacement into a pulse signal. By monitoring both the number of pulses and the relative phase of the two signals, you can track the position, direction of rotation, and speed. In addition, a third channel, or index signal, can be used to reset the position counter. The Stellaris quadrature encoder with index (QEI) module interprets the code produced by a quadrature encoder wheel to integrate position over time and determine direction of rotation. In addition, it can capture a running estimate of the velocity of the encoder wheel. 1.4.3 1.4.3.1 Analog Peripherals For support of analog signals, the LM3S601 microcontroller offers three analog comparators. Analog Comparators (see page 337) An analog comparator is a peripheral that compares two analog voltages, and provides a logical output that signals the comparison result. The LM3S601 microcontroller provides three independent integrated analog comparators that can be configured to drive an output or generate an interrupt . A comparator can compare a test voltage against any one of these voltages: ■ An individual external reference voltage ■ A shared single external reference voltage ■ A shared internal reference voltage The comparator can provide its output to a device pin, acting as a replacement for an analog comparator on the board, or it can be used to signal the application via interrupts to cause it to start capturing a sample sequence. 28 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1.4.4 Serial Communications Peripherals The LM3S601 controller supports both asynchronous and synchronous serial communications with: ■ Two fully programmable 16C550-type UARTs ■ One SSI module ■ One I2C module 1.4.4.1 UART (see page 227) A Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) is an integrated circuit used for RS-232C serial communications, containing a transmitter (parallel-to-serial converter) and a receiver (serial-to-parallel converter), each clocked separately. The LM3S601 controller includes two fully programmable 16C550-type UARTs that support data transfer speeds up to 460.8 Kbps. (Although similar in functionality to a 16C550 UART, it is not register-compatible.) Separate 16x8 transmit (TX) and 16x12 receive (RX) FIFOs reduce CPU interrupt service loading. The UART can generate individually masked interrupts from the RX, TX, modem status, and error conditions. The module provides a single combined interrupt when any of the interrupts are asserted and are unmasked. 1.4.4.2 SSI (see page 265) Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) is a four-wire bi-directional communications interface. The LM3S601 controller includes one SSI module that provides the functionality for synchronous serial communications with peripheral devices, and can be configured to use the Freescale SPI, MICROWIRE, or TI synchronous serial interface frame formats. The size of the data frame is also configurable, and can be set between 4 and 16 bits, inclusive. The SSI module performs serial-to-parallel conversion on data received from a peripheral device, and parallel-to-serial conversion on data transmitted to a peripheral device. The TX and RX paths are buffered with internal FIFOs, allowing up to eight 16-bit values to be stored independently. The SSI module can be configured as either a master or slave device. As a slave device, the SSI module can also be configured to disable its output, which allows a master device to be coupled with multiple slave devices. The SSI module also includes a programmable bit rate clock divider and prescaler to generate the output serial clock derived from the SSI module's input clock. Bit rates are generated based on the input clock and the maximum bit rate is determined by the connected peripheral. 1.4.4.3 I2C (see page 302) The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) bus provides bi-directional data transfer through a two-wire design (a serial data line SDA and a serial clock line SCL). The I2C bus interfaces to external I2C devices such as serial memory (RAMs and ROMs), networking devices, LCDs, tone generators, and so on. The I2C bus may also be used for system testing and diagnostic purposes in product development and manufacture. The LM3S601 controller includes one I2C module that provides the ability to communicate to other IC devices over an I2C bus. The I2C bus supports devices that can both transmit and receive (write and read) data. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 29 Architectural Overview Devices on the I2C bus can be designated as either a master or a slave. The I2C module supports both sending and receiving data as either a master or a slave, and also supports the simultaneous operation as both a master and a slave. The four I2C modes are: Master Transmit, Master Receive, Slave Transmit, and Slave Receive. A Stellaris I2C module can operate at two speeds: Standard (100 Kbps) and Fast (400 Kbps). Both the I2C master and slave can generate interrupts. The I2C master generates interrupts when a transmit or receive operation completes (or aborts due to an error). The I2C slave generates interrupts when data has been sent or requested by a master. ® 1.4.5 1.4.5.1 System Peripherals Programmable GPIOs (see page 129) General-purpose input/output (GPIO) pins offer flexibility for a variety of connections. The Stellaris GPIO module is composed of five physical GPIO blocks, each corresponding to an individual GPIO port. The GPIO module is FiRM-compliant (compliant to the ARM Foundation IP for Real-Time Microcontrollers specification) and supports 0-36 programmable input/output pins. The number of GPIOs available depends on the peripherals being used (see “Signal Tables” on page 404 for the signals available to each GPIO pin). The GPIO module features programmable interrupt generation as either edge-triggered or level-sensitive on all pins, programmable control for GPIO pad configuration, and bit masking in both read and write operations through address lines. ® 1.4.5.2 Three Programmable Timers (see page 168) Programmable timers can be used to count or time external events that drive the Timer input pins. The Stellaris General-Purpose Timer Module (GPTM) contains three GPTM blocks. Each GPTM block provides two 16-bit timer/counters that can be configured to operate independently as timers or event counters, or configured to operate as one 32-bit timer or one 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC). When configured in 32-bit mode, a timer can run as a one-shot timer, periodic timer, or Real-Time Clock (RTC). When in 16-bit mode, a timer can run as a one-shot timer or periodic timer, and can extend its precision by using an 8-bit prescaler. A 16-bit timer can also be configured for event capture or Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) generation. ® 1.4.5.3 Watchdog Timer (see page 204) A watchdog timer can generate nonmaskable interrupts (NMIs) or a reset when a time-out value is reached. The watchdog timer is used to regain control when a system has failed due to a software error or to the failure of an external device to respond in the expected way. The Stellaris Watchdog Timer module consists of a 32-bit down counter, a programmable load register, interrupt generation logic, and a locking register. The Watchdog Timer can be configured to generate an interrupt to the controller on its first time-out, and to generate a reset signal on its second time-out. Once the Watchdog Timer has been configured, the lock register can be written to prevent the timer configuration from being inadvertently altered. ® 1.4.6 Memory Peripherals The LM3S601 controller offers both single-cycle SRAM and single-cycle Flash memory. 30 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1.4.6.1 SRAM (see page 113) The LM3S601 static random access memory (SRAM) controller supports 8 KB SRAM. The internal ® SRAM of the Stellaris devices is located at offset 0x0000.0000 of the device memory map. To reduce the number of time-consuming read-modify-write (RMW) operations, ARM has introduced bit-banding technology in the new Cortex-M3 processor. With a bit-band-enabled processor, certain regions in the memory map (SRAM and peripheral space) can use address aliases to access individual bits in a single, atomic operation. 1.4.6.2 Flash (see page 114) The LM3S601 Flash controller supports 32 KB of flash memory. The flash is organized as a set of 1-KB blocks that can be individually erased. Erasing a block causes the entire contents of the block to be reset to all 1s. These blocks are paired into a set of 2-KB blocks that can be individually protected. The blocks can be marked as read-only or execute-only, providing different levels of code protection. Read-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, protecting the contents of those blocks from being modified. Execute-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, and can only be read by the controller instruction fetch mechanism, protecting the contents of those blocks from being read by either the controller or by a debugger. 1.4.7 1.4.7.1 Additional Features Memory Map (see page 40) A memory map lists the location of instructions and data in memory. The memory map for the LM3S601 controller can be found in “Memory Map” on page 40. Register addresses are given as a hexadecimal increment, relative to the module's base address as shown in the memory map. The ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual provides further information on the memory map. 1.4.7.2 JTAG TAP Controller (see page 44) The Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) port provides a standardized serial interface for controlling the Test Access Port (TAP) and associated test logic. The TAP, JTAG instruction register, and JTAG data registers can be used to test the interconnects of assembled printed circuit boards, obtain manufacturing information on the components, and observe and/or control the inputs and outputs of the controller during normal operation. The JTAG port provides a high degree of testability and chip-level access at a low cost. The JTAG port is comprised of the standard five pins: TRST, TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. Data is transmitted serially into the controller on TDI and out of the controller on TDO. The interpretation of this data is dependent on the current state of the TAP controller. For detailed information on the operation of the JTAG port and TAP controller, please refer to the IEEE Standard 1149.1-Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture. The Luminary Micro JTAG controller works with the ARM JTAG controller built into the Cortex-M3 core. This is implemented by multiplexing the TDO outputs from both JTAG controllers. ARM JTAG instructions select the ARM TDO output while Luminary Micro JTAG instructions select the Luminary Micro TDO outputs. The multiplexer is controlled by the Luminary Micro JTAG controller, which has comprehensive programming for the ARM, Luminary Micro, and unimplemented JTAG instructions. 1.4.7.3 System Control and Clocks (see page 54) System control determines the overall operation of the device. It provides information about the device, controls the clocking of the device and individual peripherals, and handles reset detection and reporting. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 31 Architectural Overview 1.4.8 Hardware Details Details on the pins and package can be found in the following sections: ■ “Pin Diagram” on page 403 ■ “Signal Tables” on page 404 ■ “Operating Characteristics” on page 412 ■ “Electrical Characteristics” on page 413 ■ “Package Information” on page 423 32 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1.4.9 System Block Diagram Figure 1-2. LM3S601 Controller System-Level Block Diagram VDD_3.3V LDO GND ARM Cortex-M3 (50 MHz) CM3Core NVIC Debug OSC0 OSC1 POR BOR System Control & Clocks GPIO Port A Watchdog Timer IOSC PLL APB Bridge SRAM (8 KB) Bus DCode ICode Flash (32 KB) LDO VDD_2.5V RST GPIO Port B PB7/TRST Analog Comparators PB6/C0+ PB5/C1PB4/C0PB3/I2CSDA PB2/I2CSCL PA5/SSITx PA4/SSIRx PA3/SSIFss PA2/SSIClk PA1/U0Tx PA0/U0Rx SSI I 2C UART0 Peripheral Bus Peripheral Bus Master Slave GPIO Port C PWM1 PB1/PWM3 PB0/PWM2 PC3/TDO/SWO PC2/TDI PC1/TMS/SWDIO PC0/TCK/SWCLK PC7/C2PC5/C0o/C1+ PC6/PhB/C2+ PC4/PhA JTAG SWD/SWO GPIO Port D PWM0 UART1 PD6/Fault PD0/PWM0 PD1/PWM1 PD2/U1Rx PD3/U1Tx GPIO Port E PE0/PWM4 PE1/PWM5 PWM2 GP Timer0 PD4/CCP0 PD5/CCP2 PE4/CCP3 GP Timer1 QEI PD7/IDX PE2/CCP4 PE5/CCP5 PE3/CCP1 GP Timer2 LM3S601 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 33 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core 2 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core The ARM Cortex-M3 processor provides the core for a high-performance, low-cost platform that meets the needs of minimal memory implementation, reduced pin count, and low power consumption, while delivering outstanding computational performance and exceptional system response to interrupts. Features include: ■ Compact core. ■ Thumb-2 instruction set, delivering the high-performance expected of an ARM core in the memory size usually associated with 8- and 16-bit devices; typically in the range of a few kilobytes of memory for microcontroller class applications. ■ Rapid application execution through Harvard architecture characterized by separate buses for instruction and data. ■ Exceptional interrupt handling, by implementing the register manipulations required for handling an interrupt in hardware. ■ Memory protection unit (MPU) to provide a privileged mode of operation for complex applications. ■ Migration from the ARM7™ processor family for better performance and power efficiency. ■ Full-featured debug solution with a: – Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) – Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) unit for implementing breakpoints – Data Watchpoint and Trigger (DWT) unit for implementing watchpoints, trigger resources, and system profiling – Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) for support of printf style debugging – Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) for bridging to a Trace Port Analyzer The Stellaris family of microcontrollers builds on this core to bring high-performance 32-bit computing to cost-sensitive embedded microcontroller applications, such as factory automation and control, industrial control power devices, building and home automation, and stepper motors. For more information on the ARM Cortex-M3 processor core, see the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. For information on SWJ-DP, see the ARM® CoreSight Technical Reference Manual. ® 34 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 2.1 Block Diagram Figure 2-1. CPU Block Diagram Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller Interrupts Sleep Debug Instructions Memory Protection Unit Data Trace Port Interface Unit CM3 Core ARM Cortex-M3 Serial Wire Output Trace Port (SWO) Flash Patch and Breakpoint Instrumentation Data Watchpoint Trace Macrocell and Trace Private Peripheral Bus (external) ROM Table Private Peripheral Bus (internal) Bus Matrix Adv. Peripheral Bus I-code bus D-code bus System bus Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port Adv. HighPerf. Bus Access Port 2.2 Functional Description Important: The ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual describes all the features of an ARM Cortex-M3 in detail. However, these features differ based on the implementation. ® This section describes the Stellaris implementation. Luminary Micro has implemented the ARM Cortex-M3 core as shown in Figure 2-1 on page 35. As noted in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual, several Cortex-M3 components are flexible in their implementation: SW/JTAG-DP, ETM, TPIU, the ROM table, the MPU, and the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC). Each of these is addressed in the sections that follow. 2.2.1 Serial Wire and JTAG Debug Luminary Micro has replaced the ARM SW-DP and JTAG-DP with the ARM CoreSight™-compliant Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) interface. This means Chapter 12, “Debug Port,” of the ® ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual does not apply to Stellaris devices. The SWJ-DP interface combines the SWD and JTAG debug ports into one module. See the CoreSight™ Design Kit Technical Reference Manual for details on SWJ-DP. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 35 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core 2.2.2 Embedded Trace Macrocell (ETM) ETM was not implemented in the Stellaris devices. This means Chapters 15 and 16 of the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual can be ignored. ® 2.2.3 Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) The TPIU acts as a bridge between the Cortex-M3 trace data from the ITM, and an off-chip Trace ® Port Analyzer. The Stellaris devices have implemented TPIU as shown in Figure 2-2 on page 36. This is similar to the non-ETM version described in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual, however, SWJ-DP only provides SWV output for the TPIU. Figure 2-2. TPIU Block Diagram Debug ATB Slave Port ATB Interface Asynchronous FIFO Trace Out (serializer) Serial Wire Trace Port (SWO) APB Slave Port APB Interface 2.2.4 ROM Table The default ROM table was implemented as described in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. 2.2.5 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) The Memory Protection Unit (MPU) is included on the LM3S601 controller and supports the standard ARMv7 Protected Memory System Architecture (PMSA) model. The MPU provides full support for protection regions, overlapping protection regions, access permissions, and exporting memory attributes to the system. 2.2.6 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) The Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC): ■ Facilitates low-latency exception and interrupt handling ■ Controls power management ■ Implements system control registers 36 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller The NVIC supports up to 240 dynamically reprioritizable interrupts each with up to 256 levels of priority. The NVIC and the processor core interface are closely coupled, which enables low latency interrupt processing and efficient processing of late arriving interrupts. The NVIC maintains knowledge of the stacked (nested) interrupts to enable tail-chaining of interrupts. You can only fully access the NVIC from privileged mode, but you can pend interrupts in user-mode if you enable the Configuration Control Register (see the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual). Any other user-mode access causes a bus fault. All NVIC registers are accessible using byte, halfword, and word unless otherwise stated. All NVIC registers and system debug registers are little endian regardless of the endianness state of the processor. 2.2.6.1 Interrupts The ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual describes the maximum number of interrupts and interrupt priorities. The LM3S601 microcontroller supports 25 interrupts with eight priority levels. 2.2.6.2 System Timer (SysTick) Cortex-M3 includes an integrated system timer, SysTick. SysTick provides a simple, 24-bit clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism. The counter can be used in several different ways, for example: ■ An RTOS tick timer which fires at a programmable rate (for example, 100 Hz) and invokes a SysTick routine. ■ A high-speed alarm timer using the system clock. ■ A variable rate alarm or signal timer—the duration is range-dependent on the reference clock used and the dynamic range of the counter. ■ A simple counter. Software can use this to measure time to completion and time used. ■ An internal clock source control based on missing/meeting durations. The COUNTFLAG bit-field in the control and status register can be used to determine if an action completed within a set duration, as part of a dynamic clock management control loop. Functional Description The timer consists of three registers: ■ A control and status counter to configure its clock, enable the counter, enable the SysTick interrupt, and determine counter status. ■ The reload value for the counter, used to provide the counter's wrap value. ■ The current value of the counter. A fourth register, the SysTick Calibration Value Register, is not implemented in the Stellaris devices. When enabled, the timer counts down from the reload value to zero, reloads (wraps) to the value in the SysTick Reload Value register on the next clock edge, then decrements on subsequent clocks. Writing a value of zero to the Reload Value register disables the counter on the next wrap. When the counter reaches zero, the COUNTFLAG status bit is set. The COUNTFLAG bit clears on reads. ® October 01, 2007 Preliminary 37 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core Writing to the Current Value register clears the register and the COUNTFLAG status bit. The write does not trigger the SysTick exception logic. On a read, the current value is the value of the register at the time the register is accessed. If the core is in debug state (halted), the counter will not decrement. The timer is clocked with respect to a reference clock. The reference clock can be the core clock or an external clock source. SysTick Control and Status Register Use the SysTick Control and Status Register to enable the SysTick features. The reset is 0x0000.0000. Bit/Field 31:17 Name reserved Type Reset Description RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Returns 1 if timer counted to 0 since last time this was read. Clears on read by application. If read by the debugger using the DAP, this bit is cleared on read-only if the MasterType bit in the AHB-AP Control Register is set to 0. Otherwise, the COUNTFLAG bit is not changed by the debugger read. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 0 = external reference clock. (Not implemented for Stellaris microcontrollers.) 1 = core clock. If no reference clock is provided, it is held at 1 and so gives the same time as the core clock. The core clock must be at least 2.5 times faster than the reference clock. If it is not, the count values are unpredictable. 1 TICKINT R/W 0 1 = counting down to 0 pends the SysTick handler. 0 = counting down to 0 does not pend the SysTick handler. Software can use the COUNTFLAG to determine if ever counted to 0. 0 ENABLE R/W 0 1 = counter operates in a multi-shot way. That is, counter loads with the Reload value and then begins counting down. On reaching 0, it sets the COUNTFLAG to 1 and optionally pends the SysTick handler, based on TICKINT. It then loads the Reload value again, and begins counting. 0 = counter disabled. 16 COUNTFLAG R/W 0 15:3 reserved RO 0 2 CLKSOURCE R/W 0 SysTick Reload Value Register Use the SysTick Reload Value Register to specify the start value to load into the current value register when the counter reaches 0. It can be any value between 1 and 0x00FF.FFFF. A start value of 0 is possible, but has no effect because the SysTick interrupt and COUNTFLAG are activated when counting from 1 to 0. Therefore, as a multi-shot timer, repeated over and over, it fires every N+1 clock pulse, where N is any value from 1 to 0x00FF.FFFF. So, if the tick interrupt is required every 100 clock pulses, 99 must be written into the RELOAD. If a new value is written on each tick interrupt, so treated as single shot, then the actual count down must be written. For example, if a tick is next required after 400 clock pulses, 400 must be written into the RELOAD. Bit/Field 31:24 Name reserved Type Reset Description RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 38 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 23:0 Name Type Reset Description Value to load into the SysTick Current Value Register when the counter reaches 0. RELOAD W1C SysTick Current Value Register Use the SysTick Current Value Register to find the current value in the register. Bit/Field 31:24 Name reserved Type Reset Description RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Current value at the time the register is accessed. No read-modify-write protection is provided, so change with care. This register is write-clear. Writing to it with any value clears the register to 0. Clearing this register also clears the COUNTFLAG bit of the SysTick Control and Status Register. 23:0 CURRENT W1C - SysTick Calibration Value Register The SysTick Calibration Value register is not implemented. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 39 Memory Map 3 Memory Map The memory map for the LM3S601 controller is provided in Table 3-1 on page 40. In this manual, register addresses are given as a hexadecimal increment, relative to the module’s base address as shown in the memory map. See also Chapter 4, “Memory Map” in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. Important: In Table 3-1 on page 40, addresses not listed are reserved. Table 3-1. Memory Map Start a End Description For details on registers, see page ... b c Memory 0x0000.0000 0x2000.0000 0x2010.0000 0x2200.0000 0x2204.0000 FiRM Peripherals 0x4000.0000 0x4000.4000 0x4000.5000 0x4000.6000 0x4000.7000 0x4000.8000 0x4000.C000 0x4000.D000 Peripherals 0x4002.0000 0x4002.0800 0x4002.4000 0x4002.8000 0x4002.C000 0x4003.0000 0x4003.1000 0x4003.2000 0x4003.C000 0x400F.D000 0x400F.E000 0x4200.0000 Private Peripheral Bus 0x4002.07FF 0x4002.0FFF 0x4002.7FFF 0x4002.8FFF 0x4002.CFFF 0x4003.0FFF 0x4003.1FFF 0x4003.2FFF 0x4003.CFFF 0x400F.DFFF 0x400F.FFFF 0x43FF.FFFF I2C Master 0 I2C Slave 0 GPIO Port E PWM QEI0 Timer0 Timer1 Timer2 Analog Comparators Flash control System control Bit-banded alias of 0x4000.0000 through 0x400F.FFFF 315 328 136 357 390 179 179 179 337 118 62 0x4000.0FFF 0x4000.4FFF 0x4000.5FFF 0x4000.6FFF 0x4000.7FFF 0x4000.8FFF 0x4000.CFFF 0x4000.DFFF Watchdog timer GPIO Port A GPIO Port B GPIO Port C GPIO Port D SSI0 UART0 UART1 206 136 136 136 136 276 233 233 0x0000.7FFF 0x2000.1FFF 0x200F.FFFF 0x22003.FFFF 0x23FF.FFFF On-chip flash 118 118 113 - Bit-banded on-chip SRAM Reserved Bit-band alias of 0x2000.0000 through 0x200F.FFFF Reserved 40 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Start End Description For details on registers, see page ... ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual 0xE000.0000 0xE000.1000 0xE000.2000 0xE000.3000 0xE000.E000 0xE000.F000 0xE004.0000 0xE004.1000 0xE004.2000 0xE010.0000 0xE000.0FFF 0xE000.1FFF 0xE000.2FFF 0xE000.DFFF 0xE000.EFFF 0xE003.FFFF 0xE004.0FFF 0xE004.1FFF 0xE00F.FFFF 0xFFFF.FFFF Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) Data Watchpoint and Trace (DWT) Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) Reserved Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) Reserved Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) Reserved Reserved Reserved for vendor peripherals - a. All reserved space returns a bus fault when read or written. b. The unavailable flash will bus fault throughout this range. c. The unavailable SRAM will bus fault throughout this range. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 41 Interrupts 4 Interrupts The ARM Cortex-M3 processor and the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) prioritize and handle all exceptions. All exceptions are handled in Handler Mode. The processor state is automatically stored to the stack on an exception, and automatically restored from the stack at the end of the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). The vector is fetched in parallel to the state saving, which enables efficient interrupt entry. The processor supports tail-chaining, which enables back-to-back interrupts to be performed without the overhead of state saving and restoration. Table 4-1 on page 42 lists all the exceptions. Software can set eight priority levels on seven of these exceptions (system handlers) as well as on 25 interrupts (listed in Table 4-2 on page 43). Priorities on the system handlers are set with the NVIC System Handler Priority registers. Interrupts are enabled through the NVIC Interrupt Set Enable register and prioritized with the NVIC Interrupt Priority registers. You can also group priorities by splitting priority levels into pre-emption priorities and subpriorities. All the interrupt registers are described in Chapter 8, “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller” in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. Internally, the highest user-settable priority (0) is treated as fourth priority, after a Reset, NMI, and a Hard Fault. Note that 0 is the default priority for all the settable priorities. If you assign the same priority level to two or more interrupts, their hardware priority (the lower the position number) determines the order in which the processor activates them. For example, if both GPIO Port A and GPIO Port B are priority level 1, then GPIO Port A has higher priority. See Chapter 5, “Exceptions” and Chapter 8, “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller” in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual for more information on exceptions and interrupts. Note: In Table 4-2 on page 43 interrupts not listed are reserved. Table 4-1. Exception Types Exception Type Reset Position 0 1 Priority a Description Stack top is loaded from first entry of vector table on reset. -3 (highest) Invoked on power up and warm reset. On first instruction, drops to lowest priority (and then is called the base level of activation). This is asynchronous. -2 Cannot be stopped or preempted by any exception but reset. This is asynchronous. An NMI is only producible by software, using the NVIC Interrupt Control State register. Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI) 2 Hard Fault Memory Management 3 4 -1 settable All classes of Fault, when the fault cannot activate due to priority or the configurable fault handler has been disabled. This is synchronous. MPU mismatch, including access violation and no match. This is synchronous. The priority of this exception can be changed. Bus Fault 5 settable Pre-fetch fault, memory access fault, and other address/memory related faults. This is synchronous when precise and asynchronous when imprecise. You can enable or disable this fault. Usage Fault SVCall 6 7-10 11 settable settable Usage fault, such as undefined instruction executed or illegal state transition attempt. This is synchronous. Reserved. System service call with SVC instruction. This is synchronous. 42 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Exception Type Debug Monitor Position 12 Priority a Description Debug monitor (when not halting). This is synchronous, but only active when enabled. It does not activate if lower priority than the current activation. Reserved. Pendable request for system service. This is asynchronous and only pended by software. System tick timer has fired. This is asynchronous. Asserted from outside the ARM Cortex-M3 core and fed through the NVIC (prioritized). These are all asynchronous. Table 4-2 on page 43 lists the interrupts on the LM3S601 controller. settable PendSV SysTick Interrupts 13 14 15 16 and above settable settable settable a. 0 is the default priority for all the settable priorities. Table 4-2. Interrupts Interrupt (Bit in Interrupt Registers) Description 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 10 11 12 13 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30-31 GPIO Port A GPIO Port B GPIO Port C GPIO Port D GPIO Port E UART0 UART1 SSI0 I2C0 PWM Generator 0 PWM Generator 1 PWM Generator 2 QEI0 Watchdog timer Timer0 A Timer0 B Timer1 A Timer1 B Timer2 A Timer2 B Analog Comparator 0 Analog Comparator 1 Analog Comparator 2 System Control Flash Control Reserved October 01, 2007 Preliminary 43 JTAG Interface 5 JTAG Interface The Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) port is an IEEE standard that defines a Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture for digital integrated circuits and provides a standardized serial interface for controlling the associated test logic. The TAP, Instruction Register (IR), and Data Registers (DR) can be used to test the interconnections of assembled printed circuit boards and obtain manufacturing information on the components. The JTAG Port also provides a means of accessing and controlling design-for-test features such as I/O pin observation and control, scan testing, and debugging. The JTAG port is comprised of the standard five pins: TRST, TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. Data is transmitted serially into the controller on TDI and out of the controller on TDO. The interpretation of this data is dependent on the current state of the TAP controller. For detailed information on the operation of the JTAG port and TAP controller, please refer to the IEEE Standard 1149.1-Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture. The Luminary Micro JTAG controller works with the ARM JTAG controller built into the Cortex-M3 core. This is implemented by multiplexing the TDO outputs from both JTAG controllers. ARM JTAG instructions select the ARM TDO output while Luminary Micro JTAG instructions select the Luminary Micro TDO outputs. The multiplexer is controlled by the Luminary Micro JTAG controller, which has comprehensive programming for the ARM, Luminary Micro, and unimplemented JTAG instructions. The JTAG module has the following features: ■ IEEE 1149.1-1990 compatible Test Access Port (TAP) controller ■ Four-bit Instruction Register (IR) chain for storing JTAG instructions ■ IEEE standard instructions: – BYPASS instruction – IDCODE instruction – SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction – EXTEST instruction – INTEST instruction ■ ARM additional instructions: – APACC instruction – DPACC instruction – ABORT instruction ■ Integrated ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) See the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual for more information on the ARM JTAG controller. 44 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 5.1 Block Diagram Figure 5-1. JTAG Module Block Diagram TRST TCK TMS TDI TAP Controller Instruction Register (IR) BYPASS Data Register Boundar y Scan Data Register IDCODE Data Register ABORT Data Register DPACC Data Register APACC Data Register TDO Cor tex-M3 Debug Por t 5.2 Functional Description A high-level conceptual drawing of the JTAG module is shown in Figure 5-1 on page 45. The JTAG module is composed of the Test Access Port (TAP) controller and serial shift chains with parallel update registers. The TAP controller is a simple state machine controlled by the TRST, TCK and TMS inputs. The current state of the TAP controller depends on the current value of TRST and the sequence of values captured on TMS at the rising edge of TCK. The TAP controller determines when the serial shift chains capture new data, shift data from TDI towards TDO, and update the parallel load registers. The current state of the TAP controller also determines whether the Instruction Register (IR) chain or one of the Data Register (DR) chains is being accessed. The serial shift chains with parallel load registers are comprised of a single Instruction Register (IR) chain and multiple Data Register (DR) chains. The current instruction loaded in the parallel load register determines which DR chain is captured, shifted, or updated during the sequencing of the TAP controller. Some instructions, like EXTEST and INTEST, operate on data currently in a DR chain and do not capture, shift, or update any of the chains. Instructions that are not implemented decode to the BYPASS instruction to ensure that the serial path between TDI and TDO is always connected (see Table 5-2 on page 50 for a list of implemented instructions). See “JTAG and Boundary Scan” on page 418 for JTAG timing diagrams. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 45 JTAG Interface 5.2.1 JTAG Interface Pins The JTAG interface consists of five standard pins: TRST, TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. These pins and their associated reset state are given in Table 5-1 on page 46. Detailed information on each pin follows. Table 5-1. JTAG Port Pins Reset State Pin Name TRST TCK TMS TDI TDO Data Direction Input Input Input Input Output Internal Pull-Up Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Internal Pull-Down Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Drive Strength N/A N/A N/A N/A 2-mA driver Drive Value N/A N/A N/A N/A High-Z 5.2.1.1 Test Reset Input (TRST) The TRST pin is an asynchronous active Low input signal for initializing and resetting the JTAG TAP controller and associated JTAG circuitry. When TRST is asserted, the TAP controller resets to the Test-Logic-Reset state and remains there while TRST is asserted. When the TAP controller enters the Test-Logic-Reset state, the JTAG Instruction Register (IR) resets to the default instruction, IDCODE. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TRST pin is enabled after reset. Changes to the pull-up resistor settings on GPIO Port B should ensure that the internal pull-up resistor remains enabled on PB7/TRST; otherwise JTAG communication could be lost. 5.2.1.2 Test Clock Input (TCK) The TCK pin is the clock for the JTAG module. This clock is provided so the test logic can operate independently of any other system clocks. In addition, it ensures that multiple JTAG TAP controllers that are daisy-chained together can synchronously communicate serial test data between components. During normal operation, TCK is driven by a free-running clock with a nominal 50% duty cycle. When necessary, TCK can be stopped at 0 or 1 for extended periods of time. While TCK is stopped at 0 or 1, the state of the TAP controller does not change and data in the JTAG Instruction and Data Registers is not lost. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TCK pin is enabled after reset. This assures that no clocking occurs if the pin is not driven from an external source. The internal pull-up and pull-down resistors can be turned off to save internal power as long as the TCK pin is constantly being driven by an external source. 5.2.1.3 Test Mode Select (TMS) The TMS pin selects the next state of the JTAG TAP controller. TMS is sampled on the rising edge of TCK. Depending on the current TAP state and the sampled value of TMS, the next state is entered. Because the TMS pin is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TMS to change on the falling edge of TCK. Holding TMS high for five consecutive TCK cycles drives the TAP controller state machine to the Test-Logic-Reset state. When the TAP controller enters the Test-Logic-Reset state, the JTAG Instruction Register (IR) resets to the default instruction, IDCODE. Therefore, this sequence can be used as a reset mechanism, similar to asserting TRST. The JTAG Test Access Port state machine can be seen in its entirety in Figure 5-2 on page 48. 46 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TMS pin is enabled after reset. Changes to the pull-up resistor settings on GPIO Port C should ensure that the internal pull-up resistor remains enabled on PC1/TMS; otherwise JTAG communication could be lost. 5.2.1.4 Test Data Input (TDI) The TDI pin provides a stream of serial information to the IR chain and the DR chains. TDI is sampled on the rising edge of TCK and, depending on the current TAP state and the current instruction, presents this data to the proper shift register chain. Because the TDI pin is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TDI to change on the falling edge of TCK. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TDI pin is enabled after reset. Changes to the pull-up resistor settings on GPIO Port C should ensure that the internal pull-up resistor remains enabled on PC2/TDI; otherwise JTAG communication could be lost. 5.2.1.5 Test Data Output (TDO) The TDO pin provides an output stream of serial information from the IR chain or the DR chains. The value of TDO depends on the current TAP state, the current instruction, and the data in the chain being accessed. In order to save power when the JTAG port is not being used, the TDO pin is placed in an inactive drive state when not actively shifting out data. Because TDO can be connected to the TDI of another controller in a daisy-chain configuration, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TDO to change on the falling edge of TCK. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TDO pin is enabled after reset. This assures that the pin remains at a constant logic level when the JTAG port is not being used. The internal pull-up and pull-down resistors can be turned off to save internal power if a High-Z output value is acceptable during certain TAP controller states. 5.2.2 JTAG TAP Controller The JTAG TAP controller state machine is shown in Figure 5-2 on page 48. The TAP controller state machine is reset to the Test-Logic-Reset state on the assertion of a Power-On-Reset (POR) or the assertion of TRST. Asserting the correct sequence on the TMS pin allows the JTAG module to shift in new instructions, shift in data, or idle during extended testing sequences. For detailed information on the function of the TAP controller and the operations that occur in each state, please refer to IEEE Standard 1149.1. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 47 JTAG Interface Figure 5-2. Test Access Port State Machine Test Logic Reset 1 0 Run Test Idle 1 Select DR Scan 0 1 Capture DR 0 Shift DR 1 Exit 1 DR 0 Pause DR 1 0 Exit 2 DR 1 Update DR 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 Select IR Scan 0 Capture IR 0 Shift IR 1 Exit 1 IR 0 Pause IR 1 Exit 2 IR 1 Update IR 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 5.2.3 Shift Registers The Shift Registers consist of a serial shift register chain and a parallel load register. The serial shift register chain samples specific information during the TAP controller ’s CAPTURE states and allows this information to be shifted out of TDO during the TAP controller ’s SHIFT states. While the sampled data is being shifted out of the chain on TDO, new data is being shifted into the serial shift register on TDI. This new data is stored in the parallel load register during the TAP controller ’s UPDATE states. Each of the shift registers is discussed in detail in “Register Descriptions” on page 50. 5.2.4 Operational Considerations There are certain operational considerations when using the JTAG module. Because the JTAG pins can be programmed to be GPIOs, board configuration and reset conditions on these pins must be considered. In addition, because the JTAG module has integrated ARM Serial Wire Debug, the method for switching between these two operational modes is described below. 48 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 5.2.4.1 GPIO Functionality When the controller is reset with either a POR or RST, the JTAG port pins default to their JTAG configurations. The default configuration includes enabling the pull-up resistors (setting GPIOPUR to 1 for PB7 and PC[3:0]) and enabling the alternate hardware function (setting GPIOAFSEL to 1 for PB7 and PC[3:0]) on the JTAG pins. It is possible for software to configure these pins as GPIOs after reset by writing 0s to PB7 and PC[3:0] in the GPIOAFSEL register. If the user does not require the JTAG port for debugging or board-level testing, this provides five more GPIOs for use in the design. Caution – If the JTAG pins are used as GPIOs in a design, PB7 and PC2 cannot have external pull-down resistors connected to both of them at the same time. If both pins are pulled Low during reset, the controller has unpredictable behavior. If this happens, remove one or both of the pull-down resistors, and apply RST or power-cycle the part. In addition, it is possible to create a software sequence that prevents the debugger from connecting to the Stellaris® microcontroller. If the program code loaded into flash immediately changes the JTAG pins to their GPIO functionality, the debugger may not have enough time to connect and halt the controller before the JTAG pin functionality switches. This may lock the debugger out of the part. This can be avoided with a software routine that restores JTAG functionality based on an external or software trigger. 5.2.4.2 ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) In order to seamlessly integrate the ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) functionality, a serial-wire debugger must be able to connect to the Cortex-M3 core without having to perform, or have any knowledge of, JTAG cycles. This is accomplished with a SWD preamble that is issued before the SWD session begins. The preamble used to enable the SWD interface of the SWJ-DP module starts with the TAP controller in the Test-Logic-Reset state. From here, the preamble sequences the TAP controller through the following states: Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, Capture IR, Exit1 IR, Update IR, Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, Capture IR, Exit1 IR, Update IR, Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, and Test-Logic-Reset states. Stepping through the JTAG TAP Instruction Register (IR) load sequences of the TAP state machine twice without shifting in a new instruction enables the SWD interface and disables the JTAG interface. For more information on this operation and the SWD interface, see the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual and the ARM® CoreSight Technical Reference Manual. Because this sequence is a valid series of JTAG operations that could be issued, the ARM JTAG TAP controller is not fully compliant to the IEEE Standard 1149.1. This is the only instance where the ARM JTAG TAP controller does not meet full compliance with the specification. Due to the low probability of this sequence occurring during normal operation of the TAP controller, it should not affect normal performance of the JTAG interface. 5.3 Initialization and Configuration After a Power-On-Reset or an external reset (RST), the JTAG pins are automatically configured for JTAG communication. No user-defined initialization or configuration is needed. However, if the user application changes these pins to their GPIO function, they must be configured back to their JTAG functionality before JTAG communication can be restored. This is done by enabling the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]) for their alternate function using the GPIOAFSEL register. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 49 JTAG Interface 5.4 Register Descriptions There are no APB-accessible registers in the JTAG TAP Controller or Shift Register chains. The registers within the JTAG controller are all accessed serially through the TAP Controller. The registers can be broken down into two main categories: Instruction Registers and Data Registers. 5.4.1 Instruction Register (IR) The JTAG TAP Instruction Register (IR) is a four-bit serial scan chain with a parallel load register connected between the JTAG TDI and TDO pins. When the TAP Controller is placed in the correct states, bits can be shifted into the Instruction Register. Once these bits have been shifted into the chain and updated, they are interpreted as the current instruction. The decode of the Instruction Register bits is shown in Table 5-2 on page 50. A detailed explanation of each instruction, along with its associated Data Register, follows. Table 5-2. JTAG Instruction Register Commands IR[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 1000 1010 1011 1110 1111 All Others Instruction EXTEST INTEST Description Drives the values preloaded into the Boundary Scan Chain by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction onto the pads. Drives the values preloaded into the Boundary Scan Chain by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction into the controller. SAMPLE / PRELOAD Captures the current I/O values and shifts the sampled values out of the Boundary Scan Chain while new preload data is shifted in. ABORT DPACC APACC IDCODE BYPASS Reserved Shifts data into the ARM Debug Port Abort Register. Shifts data into and out of the ARM DP Access Register. Shifts data into and out of the ARM AC Access Register. Loads manufacturing information defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 into the IDCODE chain and shifts it out. Connects TDI to TDO through a single Shift Register chain. Defaults to the BYPASS instruction to ensure that TDI is always connected to TDO. 5.4.1.1 EXTEST Instruction The EXTEST instruction does not have an associated Data Register chain. The EXTEST instruction uses the data that has been preloaded into the Boundary Scan Data Register using the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction. When the EXTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the preloaded data in the Boundary Scan Data Register associated with the outputs and output enables are used to drive the GPIO pads rather than the signals coming from the core. This allows tests to be developed that drive known values out of the controller, which can be used to verify connectivity. 5.4.1.2 INTEST Instruction The INTEST instruction does not have an associated Data Register chain. The INTEST instruction uses the data that has been preloaded into the Boundary Scan Data Register using the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction. When the INTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the preloaded data in the Boundary Scan Data Register associated with the inputs are used to drive the signals going into the core rather than the signals coming from the GPIO pads. This allows tests to be developed that drive known values into the controller, which can be used for testing. It is important to note that although the RST input pin is on the Boundary Scan Data Register chain, it is only observable. 50 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 5.4.1.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction connects the Boundary Scan Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction samples the current state of the pad pins for observation and preloads new test data. Each GPIO pad has an associated input, output, and output enable signal. When the TAP controller enters the Capture DR state during this instruction, the input, output, and output-enable signals to each of the GPIO pads are captured. These samples are serially shifted out of TDO while the TAP controller is in the Shift DR state and can be used for observation or comparison in various tests. While these samples of the inputs, outputs, and output enables are being shifted out of the Boundary Scan Data Register, new data is being shifted into the Boundary Scan Data Register from TDI. Once the new data has been shifted into the Boundary Scan Data Register, the data is saved in the parallel load registers when the TAP controller enters the Update DR state. This update of the parallel load register preloads data into the Boundary Scan Data Register that is associated with each input, output, and output enable. This preloaded data can be used with the EXTEST and INTEST instructions to drive data into or out of the controller. Please see “Boundary Scan Data Register” on page 52 for more information. 5.4.1.4 ABORT Instruction The ABORT instruction connects the associated ABORT Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the ABORT Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this Data Register clears various error bits or initiates a DAP abort of a previous request. Please see the “ABORT Data Register” on page 53 for more information. 5.4.1.5 DPACC Instruction The DPACC instruction connects the associated DPACC Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the DPACC Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this register and reading the data output from this register allows read and write access to the ARM debug and status registers. Please see “DPACC Data Register” on page 53 for more information. 5.4.1.6 APACC Instruction The APACC instruction connects the associated APACC Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the APACC Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this register and reading the data output from this register allows read and write access to internal components and buses through the Debug Port. Please see “APACC Data Register” on page 53 for more information. 5.4.1.7 IDCODE Instruction The IDCODE instruction connects the associated IDCODE Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides information on the manufacturer, part number, and version of the ARM core. This information can be used by testing equipment and debuggers to automatically configure their input and output data streams. IDCODE is the default instruction that is loaded into the JTAG Instruction Register when a power-on-reset (POR) is asserted, TRST is asserted, or the Test-Logic-Reset state is entered. Please see “IDCODE Data Register” on page 52 for more information. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 51 JTAG Interface 5.4.1.8 BYPASS Instruction The BYPASS instruction connects the associated BYPASS Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction is used to create a minimum length serial path between the TDI and TDO ports. The BYPASS Data Register is a single-bit shift register. This instruction improves test efficiency by allowing components that are not needed for a specific test to be bypassed in the JTAG scan chain by loading them with the BYPASS instruction. Please see “BYPASS Data Register” on page 52 for more information. 5.4.2 Data Registers The JTAG module contains six Data Registers. These include: IDCODE, BYPASS, Boundary Scan, APACC, DPACC, and ABORT serial Data Register chains. Each of these Data Registers is discussed in the following sections. 5.4.2.1 IDCODE Data Register The format for the 32-bit IDCODE Data Register defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 is shown in Figure 5-3 on page 52. The standard requires that every JTAG-compliant device implement either the IDCODE instruction or the BYPASS instruction as the default instruction. The LSB of the IDCODE Data Register is defined to be a 1 to distinguish it from the BYPASS instruction, which has an LSB of 0. This allows auto configuration test tools to determine which instruction is the default instruction. The major uses of the JTAG port are for manufacturer testing of component assembly, and program development and debug. To facilitate the use of auto-configuration debug tools, the IDCODE instruction outputs a value of 0x1BA00477. This value indicates an ARM Cortex-M3, Version 1 processor. This allows the debuggers to automatically configure themselves to work correctly with the Cortex-M3 during debug. Figure 5-3. IDCODE Register Format 5.4.2.2 BYPASS Data Register The format for the 1-bit BYPASS Data Register defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 is shown in Figure 5-4 on page 52. The standard requires that every JTAG-compliant device implement either the BYPASS instruction or the IDCODE instruction as the default instruction. The LSB of the BYPASS Data Register is defined to be a 0 to distinguish it from the IDCODE instruction, which has an LSB of 1. This allows auto configuration test tools to determine which instruction is the default instruction. Figure 5-4. BYPASS Register Format 5.4.2.3 Boundary Scan Data Register The format of the Boundary Scan Data Register is shown in Figure 5-5 on page 53. Each GPIO pin, in a counter-clockwise direction from the JTAG port pins, is included in the Boundary Scan Data Register. Each GPIO pin has three associated digital signals that are included in the chain. These 52 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller signals are input, output, and output enable, and are arranged in that order as can be seen in the figure. In addition to the GPIO pins, the controller reset pin, RST, is included in the chain. Because the reset pin is always an input, only the input signal is included in the Data Register chain. When the Boundary Scan Data Register is accessed with the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction, the input, output, and output enable from each digital pad are sampled and then shifted out of the chain to be verified. The sampling of these values occurs on the rising edge of TCK in the Capture DR state of the TAP controller. While the sampled data is being shifted out of the Boundary Scan chain in the Shift DR state of the TAP controller, new data can be preloaded into the chain for use with the EXTEST and INTEST instructions. These instructions either force data out of the controller, with the EXTEST instruction, or into the controller, with the INTEST instruction. Figure 5-5. Boundary Scan Register Format TDI I N O U T G PIO PB6 O E ... I N O U T GP IO m O E I N RST I N O U T GPIO m+ 1 O E ... I N O U T G PIO n O TDO E For detailed information on the order of the input, output, and output enable bits for each of the ® GPIO ports, please refer to the Stellaris Family Boundary Scan Description Language (BSDL) files, downloadable from www.luminarymicro.com. 5.4.2.4 APACC Data Register The format for the 35-bit APACC Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. 5.4.2.5 DPACC Data Register The format for the 35-bit DPACC Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. 5.4.2.6 ABORT Data Register The format for the 35-bit ABORT Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 53 System Control 6 System Control System control determines the overall operation of the device. It provides information about the device, controls the clocking to the core and individual peripherals, and handles reset detection and reporting. 6.1 Functional Description The System Control module provides the following capabilities: ■ Device identification, see “Device Identification” on page 54 ■ Local control, such as reset (see “Reset Control” on page 54), power (see “Power Control” on page 57) and clock control (see “Clock Control” on page 57) ■ System control (Run, Sleep, and Deep-Sleep modes), see “System Control” on page 60 6.1.1 Device Identification Seven read-only registers provide software with information on the microcontroller, such as version, part number, SRAM size, flash size, and other features. See the DID0, DID1, and DC0-DC4 registers. 6.1.2 Reset Control This section discusses aspects of hardware functions during reset as well as system software requirements following the reset sequence. 6.1.2.1 Reset Sources The controller has six sources of reset: 1. External reset input pin (RST) assertion, see “RST Pin Assertion” on page 54. 2. Power-on reset (POR), see “Power-On Reset (POR)” on page 55. 3. Internal brown-out (BOR) detector, see “Brown-Out Reset (BOR)” on page 55. 4. Software-initiated reset (with the software reset registers), see “Software Reset” on page 56. 5. A watchdog timer reset condition violation, see “Watchdog Timer Reset” on page 57. 6. Internal low drop-out (LDO) regulator output After a reset, the Reset Cause (RESC) register is set with the reset cause. The bits in this register are sticky and maintain their state across multiple reset sequences,except when an external reset is the cause, and then all the other bits in the RESC register are cleared. Note: The main oscillator is used for external resets and power-on resets; the internal oscillator is used during the internal process by internal reset and clock verification circuitry. 6.1.2.2 RST Pin Assertion The external reset pin (RST) resets the controller. This resets the core and all the peripherals except the JTAG TAP controller (see “JTAG Interface” on page 44). The external reset sequence is as follows: 54 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1. The external reset pin (RST) is asserted and then de-asserted. 2. After RST is de-asserted, the main crystal oscillator is allowed to settle and there is an internal main oscillator counter that takes from 15-30 ms to account for this. During this time, internal reset to the rest of the controller is held active. 3. The internal reset is released and the core fetches and loads the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. The external reset timing is shown in Figure 20-9 on page 421. 6.1.2.3 Power-On Reset (POR) The Power-On Reset (POR) circuitry detects a rise in power-supply voltage (VDD) and generates an on-chip reset pulse. To use the on-chip circuitry, the RST input needs to be connected to the power supply (VDD) through a pull-up resistor (1K to 10K Ω). The device must be operating within the specified operating parameters at the point when the on-chip power-on reset pulse is complete. The specified operating parameters include supply voltage, frequency, temperature, and so on. If the operating conditions are not met at the point of POR end, ® the Stellaris controller does not operate correctly. In this case, the reset must be extended using external circuitry. The RST input may be used with the circuit as shown in Figure 6-1 on page 55. Figure 6-1. External Circuitry to Extend Reset Stellaris D1 R1 RST C1 R2 The R1 and C1 components define the power-on delay. The R2 resistor mitigates any leakage from the RST input. The diode (D1) discharges C1 rapidly when the power supply is turned off. The Power-On Reset sequence is as follows: 1. The controller waits for the later of external reset (RST) or internal POR to go inactive. 2. After the resets are inactive, the main crystal oscillator is allowed to settle and there is an internal main oscillator counter that takes from 15-30 ms to account for this. During this time, internal reset to the rest of the controller is held active. 3. The internal reset is released and the core fetches and loads the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. The internal POR is only active on the initial power-up of the controller. The Power-On Reset timing is shown in Figure 20-10 on page 421. Note: The power-on reset also resets the JTAG controller. An external reset does not. 6.1.2.4 Brown-Out Reset (BOR) A drop in the input voltage resulting in the assertion of the internal brown-out detector can be used to reset the controller. This is initially disabled and may be enabled by software. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 55 System Control The system provides a brown-out detection circuit that triggers if the power supply (VDD) drops below a brown-out threshold voltage (VBTH). The circuit is provided to guard against improper operation of logic and peripherals that operate off the power supply voltage (VDD) and not the LDO voltage. If a brown-out condition is detected, the system may generate a controller interrupt or a system reset. The BOR circuit has a digital filter that protects against noise-related detection for the interrupt condition. This feature may be optionally enabled. Brown-out resets are controlled with the Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL) register. The BORIOR bit in the PBORCTL register must be set for a brown-out condition to trigger a reset. The brown-out reset sequence is as follows: 1. When VDD drops below VBTH, an internal BOR condition is set. 2. If the BORWT bit in the PBORCTL register is set and BORIOR is not set, the BOR condition is resampled again, after a delay specified by BORTIM, to determine if the original condition was caused by noise. If the BOR condition is not met the second time, then no further action is taken. 3. If the BOR condition exists, an internal reset is asserted. 4. The internal reset is released and the controller fetches and loads the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. 5. The internal BOR condition is reset after 500 µs to prevent another BOR condition from being set before software has a chance to investigate the original cause. The internal Brown-Out Reset timing is shown in Figure 20-11 on page 422. 6.1.2.5 Software Reset Software can reset a specific peripheral or generate a reset to the entire system . Peripherals can be individually reset by software via three registers that control reset signals to each peripheral (see the SRCRn registers). If the bit position corresponding to a peripheral is set and subsequently cleared, the peripheral is reset. The encoding of the reset registers is consistent with the encoding of the clock gating control for peripherals and on-chip functions (see “System Control” on page 60). Note that all reset signals for all clocks of the specified unit are asserted as a result of a software-initiated reset. The entire system can be reset by software by setting the SYSRESETREQ bit in the Cortex-M3 Application Interrupt and Reset Control register resets the entire system including the core. The software-initiated system reset sequence is as follows: 1. A software system reset is initiated by writing the SYSRESETREQ bit in the ARM Cortex-M3 Application Interrupt and Reset Control register. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is deasserted and the controller loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. The software-initiated system reset timing is shown in Figure 20-12 on page 422. 56 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 6.1.2.6 Watchdog Timer Reset The watchdog timer module's function is to prevent system hangs. The watchdog timer can be configured to generate an interrupt to the controller on its first time-out, and to generate a reset signal on its second time-out. After the first time-out event, the 32-bit counter is reloaded with the value of the Watchdog Timer Load (WDTLOAD) register, and the timer resumes counting down from that value. If the timer counts down to its zero state again before the first time-out interrupt is cleared, and the reset signal has been enabled, the watchdog timer asserts its reset signal to the system. The watchdog timer reset sequence is as follows: 1. The watchdog timer times out for the second time without being serviced. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is released and the controller loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. The watchdog reset timing is shown in Figure 20-13 on page 422. 6.1.2.7 Low Drop-Out A reset can be initiated when the internal low drop-out (LDO) regulator output goes unregulated. This is initially disabled and may be enabled by software. LDO is controlled with the LDO Power Control (LDOPCTL) register. The LDO reset sequence is as follows: 1. LDO goes unregulated and the LDOARST bit in the LDOARST register is set. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is released and the controller fetches and loads the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. The LDO reset timing is shown in Figure 20-14 on page 422. 6.1.3 Power Control The Stellaris microcontroller provides an integrated LDO regulator that is used to provide power to the majority of the controller's internal logic. The LDO regulator provides software a mechanism to adjust the regulated value, in small increments (VSTEP), over the range of 2.25 V to 2.75 V (inclusive)—or 2.5 V ± 10%. The adjustment is made by changing the value of the VADJ field in the LDO Power Control (LDOPCTL) register. ® 6.1.4 6.1.4.1 Clock Control System control determines the control of clocks in this part. Fundamental Clock Sources There are two clock sources for use in the device: ■ Internal Oscillator (IOSC): The internal oscillator is an on-chip clock source. It does not require the use of any external components. The frequency of the internal oscillator is 12 MHz ± 30%. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 57 System Control Applications that do not depend on accurate clock sources may use this clock source to reduce system cost. ■ Main Oscillator: The main oscillator provides a frequency-accurate clock source by one of two means: an external single-ended clock source is connected to the OSC0 input pin, or an external crystal is connected across the OSC0 input and OSC1 output pins. The crystal value allowed depends on whether the main oscillator is used as the clock reference source to the PLL. If so, the crystal must be one of the supported frequencies between 3.579545 MHz through 8.192 MHz (inclusive). If the PLL is not being used, the crystal may be any one of the supported frequencies between 1 MHz and 8.192 MHz. The single-ended clock source range is from DC through the specified speed of the device. The supported crystals are listed in the XTAL bit in the RCC register (see page 72). The internal system clock (sysclk), is derived from any of the two sources plus two others: the output of the internal PLL, and the internal oscillator divided by four (3 MHz ± 30%). The frequency of the PLL clock reference must be in the range of 3.579545 MHz to 8.192 MHz (inclusive). Nearly all of the control for the clocks is provided by the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register. Figure 6-2 on page 58 shows the logic for the main clock tree. The peripheral blocks are driven by the system clock signal and can be programmatically enabled/disabled. The PWM clock signal is a synchronous divide by of the system clock to provide the PWM circuit with more range. Figure 6-2. Main Clock Tree USESYSDIVa OSC1 OSC2 Main Osc 1-8 MHz SYSDIVa Internal Osc 12 MHz PLL ÷4 OSCSRCa (200 MHz output) System Clock OENa XTAL a BYPASSa PWMDIVa PWM Clock PWRDNa USEPWMDIVa a. These are bit fields within the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register. 6.1.4.2 Crystal Configuration for the Main Oscillator (MOSC) The main oscillator supports the use of a select number of crystals. If the main oscillator is used by the PLL as a reference clock, the supported range of crystals is 3.579545 to 8.192 MHz, otherwise, the range of supported crystals is 1 to 8.192 MHz. The XTAL bit in the RCC register (see page 72) describes the available crystal choices and default programming values. Software configures the RCC register XTAL field with the crystal number. If the PLL is used in the design, the XTAL field value is internally translated to the PLL settings. 58 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 6.1.4.3 PLL Frequency Configuration The PLL is disabled by default during power-on reset and is enabled later by software if required. Software configures the PLL input reference clock source, specifies the output divisor to set the system clock frequency, and enables the PLL to drive the output. If the main oscillator provides the clock reference to the PLL, the translation provided by hardware and used to program the PLL is available for software in the XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG) register (see page 77). The internal translation provides a translation within ± 1% of the targeted PLL VCO frequency. The XTAL bit in the RCC register (see page 72) describes the available crystal choices and default programming of the PLLCFG register. The crystal number is written into the XTAL field of the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register. Any time the XTAL field changes, the new settings are translated and the internal PLL settings are updated. 6.1.4.4 PLL Modes The PLL has two modes of operation: Normal and Power-Down ■ Normal: The PLL multiplies the input clock reference and drives the output. ■ Power-Down: Most of the PLL internal circuitry is disabled and the PLL does not drive the output. The modes are programmed using the RCC register fields (see page 72). 6.1.4.5 PLL Operation If the PLL configuration is changed, the PLL output frequency is unstable until it reconverges (relocks) to the new setting. The time between the configuration change and relock is TREADY (see Table 20-6 on page 415). During this time, the PLL is not usable as a clock reference. The PLL is changed by one of the following: ■ Change to the XTAL value in the RCC register—writes of the same value do not cause a relock. ■ Change in the PLL from Power-Down to Normal mode. A counter is defined to measure the TREADY requirement. The counter is clocked by the main oscillator. The range of the main oscillator has been taken into account and the down counter is set to 0x1200 (that is, ~600 μs at an 8.192 MHz external oscillator clock). Hardware is provided to keep the PLL from being used as a system clock until the TREADY condition is met after one of the two changes above. It is the user's responsibility to have a stable clock source (like the main oscillator) before the RCC register is switched to use the PLL. 6.1.4.6 Clock Verification Timers There are three identical clock verification circuits that can be enabled though software. The circuit checks the faster clock by a slower clock using timers: ■ The main oscillator checks the PLL. ■ The main oscillator checks the internal oscillator. ■ The internal oscillator divided by 64 checks the main oscillator. If the verification timer function is enabled and a failure is detected, the main clock tree is immediately switched to a working clock and an interrupt is generated to the controller. Software can then October 01, 2007 Preliminary 59 System Control determine the course of action to take. The actual failure indication and clock switching does not clear without a write to the CLKVCLR register, an external reset, or a POR reset. The clock verification timers are controlled by the PLLVER , IOSCVER , and MOSCVER bits in the RCC register. 6.1.5 System Control For power-savings purposes, the RCGCn , SCGCn , and DCGCn registers control the clock gating logic for each peripheral or block in the system while the controller is in Run, Sleep, and Deep-Sleep mode, respectively. The DC1 , DC2 and DC4 registers act as a write mask for the RCGCn , SCGCn, and DCGCn registers. In Run mode, the controller is actively executing code. In Sleep mode, the clocking of the device is unchanged but the controller no longer executes code (and is no longer clocked). In Deep-Sleep mode, the clocking of the device may change (depending on the Run mode clock configuration) and the controller no longer executes code (and is no longer clocked). An interrupt returns the device to Run mode from one of the sleep modes. Each mode is described in more detail in this section. There are four levels of operation for the device defined as: ■ Run Mode. Run mode provides normal operation of the processor and all of the peripherals that are currently enabled by the RCGCn registers. The system clock can be any of the available clock sources including the PLL. ■ Sleep Mode. Sleep mode is entered by the Cortex-M3 core executing a WFI (Wait for Interrupt) instruction. Any properly configured interrupt event in the system will bring the processor back into Run mode. See the system control NVIC section of the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual for more details. In Sleep mode, the Cortex-M3 processor core and the memory subsystem are not clocked. Peripherals are clocked that are enabled in the SCGCn register when auto-clock gating is enabled (see the RCC register) or the RCGCn register when the auto-clock gating is disabled. The system clock has the same source and frequency as that during Run mode. ■ Deep-Sleep Mode. Deep-Sleep mode is entered by first writing the Deep Sleep Enable bit in the ARM Cortex-M3 NVIC system control register and then executing a WFI instruction. Any properly configured interrupt event in the system will bring the processor back into Run mode. See the system control NVIC section of the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual for more details. The Cortex-M3 processor core and the memory subsystem are not clocked. Peripherals are clocked that are enabled in the DCGCn register when auto-clock gating is enabled (see the RCC register) or the RCGCn register when auto-clock gating is disabled. The system clock source is the main oscillator by default or the internal oscillator specified in the DSLPCLKCFG register if one is enabled. When the DSLPCLKCFG register is used, the internal oscillator is powered up, if necessary, and the main oscillator is powered down. If the PLL is running at the time of the WFI instruction, hardware will power the PLL down and override the SYSDIV field of the active RCC register to be /16 or /64, respectively. When the Deep-Sleep exit event occurs, hardware brings the system clock back to the source and frequency it had at the onset of Deep-Sleep mode before enabling the clocks that had been stopped during the Deep-Sleep duration. 6.2 Initialization and Configuration The PLL is configured using direct register writes to the RCC register. The steps required to successfully change the PLL-based system clock are: 60 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 1. Bypass the PLL and system clock divider by setting the BYPASS bit and clearing the USESYS bit in the RCC register. This configures the system to run off a “raw” clock source (using the main oscillator or internal oscillator) and allows for the new PLL configuration to be validated before switching the system clock to the PLL. 2. Select the crystal value (XTAL) and oscillator source (OSCSRC), and clear the PWRDN and OEN bits in RCC. Setting the XTAL field automatically pulls valid PLL configuration data for the appropriate crystal, and clearing the PWRDN and OEN bits powers and enables the PLL and its output. 3. Select the desired system divider (SYSDIV) in RCC and set the USESYS bit in RCC. The SYSDIV field determines the system frequency for the microcontroller. 4. Wait for the PLL to lock by polling the PLLLRIS bit in the Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) register. 5. Enable use of the PLL by clearing the BYPASS bit in RCC. Note: If the BYPASS bit is cleared before the PLL locks, it is possible to render the device unusable. 6.3 Register Map Table 6-1 on page 61 lists the System Control registers, grouped by function. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. Note: Spaces in the System Control register space that are not used are reserved for future or internal use by Luminary Micro, Inc. Software should not modify any reserved memory address. Table 6-1. System Control Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x010 0x014 0x018 0x01C 0x030 0x034 0x040 0x044 0x048 0x050 0x054 Name DID0 DID1 DC0 DC1 DC2 DC3 DC4 PBORCTL LDOPCTL SRCR0 SRCR1 SRCR2 RIS IMC Type RO RO RO RO RO RO RO R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO R/W Reset 0x001F.000F 0x0010.309F 0x0707.1113 0x3F00.37FF 0x0000.001F 0x0000.7FFD 0x0000.0000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description Device Identification 0 Device Identification 1 Device Capabilities 0 Device Capabilities 1 Device Capabilities 2 Device Capabilities 3 Device Capabilities 4 Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control LDO Power Control Software Reset Control 0 Software Reset Control 1 Software Reset Control 2 Raw Interrupt Status Interrupt Mask Control See page 63 81 83 84 86 88 90 65 66 109 110 112 67 68 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 61 System Control Offset 0x058 0x05C 0x060 0x064 0x100 0x104 0x108 0x110 0x114 0x118 0x120 0x124 0x128 0x144 0x150 0x160 Name MISC RESC RCC PLLCFG RCGC0 RCGC1 RCGC2 SCGC0 SCGC1 SCGC2 DCGC0 DCGC1 DCGC2 DSLPCLKCFG CLKVCLR LDOARST Type R/W1C R/W R/W RO R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 0x07AE.3AD1 0x00000040 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000040 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000040 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x0780.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description Masked Interrupt Status and Clear Reset Cause Run-Mode Clock Configuration XTAL to PLL Translation Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 Deep Sleep Clock Configuration Clock Verification Clear Allow Unregulated LDO to Reset the Part See page 70 71 72 77 91 94 103 92 97 105 93 100 107 78 79 80 6.4 Register Descriptions All addresses given are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. 62 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: Device Identification 0 (DID0), offset 0x000 This register identifies the version of the device. Device Identification 0 (DID0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x000 Type RO, reset 31 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 30 29 VER RO 0 13 RO 0 12 MAJOR Type Reset RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 MINOR RO RO RO RO RO RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. DID0 Version This field defines the DID0 register format version. The version number is numeric. The value of the VER field is encoded as follows: Value Description 0x0 Initial DID0 register format definition for Stellaris® Sandstorm-class devices. 30:28 VER RO 0x0 27:16 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Major Revision This field specifies the major revision number of the device. The major revision reflects changes to base layers of the design. The major revision number is indicated in the part number as a letter (A for first revision, B for second, and so on). This field is encoded as follows: Value Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 Revision A (initial device) Revision B (first base layer revision) Revision C (second base layer revision) 15:8 MAJOR RO - and so on. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 63 System Control Bit/Field 7:0 Name MINOR Type RO Reset - Description Minor Revision This field specifies the minor revision number of the device. The minor revision reflects changes to the metal layers of the design. The MINOR field value is reset when the MAJOR field is changed. This field is numeric and is encoded as follows: Value Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 Initial device, or a major revision update. First metal layer change. Second metal layer change. and so on. 64 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL), offset 0x030 This register is responsible for controlling reset conditions after initial power-on reset. Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.7FFD 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 BORTIM Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 BORIOR BORWT R/W 0 R/W 1 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. BOR Time Delay This field specifies the number of internal oscillator clocks delayed before the BOR output is resampled if the BORWT bit is set. The width of this field is derived by the t BOR width of 500 μs and the internal oscillator (IOSC) frequency of 12 MHz ± 30%. At +30%, the counter value has to exceed 7,800. 15:2 BORTIM R/W 0x1FFF 1 BORIOR R/W 0 BOR Interrupt or Reset This bit controls how a BOR event is signaled to the controller. If set, a reset is signaled. Otherwise, an interrupt is signaled. 0 BORWT R/W 1 BOR Wait and Check for Noise This bit specifies the response to a brown-out signal assertion if BORIOR is not set. If BORWT is set to 1 and BORIOR is cleared to 0, the controller waits BORTIM IOSC periods and resamples the BOR output. If still asserted, a BOR interrupt is signalled. If no longer asserted, the initial assertion is suppressed (attributable to noise). If BORWT is 0, BOR assertions do not resample the output and any condition is reported immediately if enabled. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 65 System Control Register 3: LDO Power Control (LDOPCTL), offset 0x034 The VADJ field in this register adjusts the on-chip output voltage (VOUT). LDO Power Control (LDOPCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x034 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 VADJ RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. LDO Output Voltage This field sets the on-chip output voltage. The programming values for the VADJ field are provided below. Value 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 VOUT (V) 2.50 2.45 2.40 2.35 2.30 2.25 5:0 VADJ R/W 0x0 0x06-0x3F Reserved 0x1B 0x1C 0x1D 0x1E 0x1F 2.75 2.70 2.65 2.60 2.55 66 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: Raw Interrupt Status (RIS), offset 0x050 Central location for system control raw interrupts. These are set and cleared by hardware. Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x050 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 PLLLRIS RO 0 RO 0 5 CLRIS RO 0 RO 0 4 IOFRIS RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 MOFRIS LDORIS BORRIS PLLFRIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:7 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL Lock Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set when the PLL TREADY Timer asserts. 6 PLLLRIS RO 0 5 CLRIS RO 0 Current Limit Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set if the LDO’s CLE output asserts. 4 IOFRIS RO 0 Internal Oscillator Fault Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set if an internal oscillator fault is detected. 3 MOFRIS RO 0 Main Oscillator Fault Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set if a main oscillator fault is detected. 2 LDORIS RO 0 LDO Power Unregulated Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set if a LDO voltage is unregulated. 1 BORRIS RO 0 Brown-Out Reset Raw Interrupt Status This bit is the raw interrupt status for any brown-out conditions. If set, a brown-out condition is currently active. This is an unregistered signal from the brown-out detection circuit. An interrupt is reported if the BORIM bit in the IMC register is set and the BORIOR bit in the PBORCTL register is cleared. 0 PLLFRIS RO 0 PLL Fault Raw Interrupt Status This bit is set if a PLL fault is detected (stops oscillating). October 01, 2007 Preliminary 67 System Control Register 5: Interrupt Mask Control (IMC), offset 0x054 Central location for system control interrupt masks. Interrupt Mask Control (IMC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x054 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 PLLLIM R/W 0 RO 0 5 CLIM R/W 0 RO 0 4 IOFIM R/W 0 RO 0 3 MOFIM R/W 0 RO 0 2 LDOIM R/W 0 RO 0 1 BORIM R/W 0 RO 0 0 PLLFIM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:7 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL Lock Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether a current limit detection is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if PLLLRIS in RIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 6 PLLLIM R/W 0 5 CLIM R/W 0 Current Limit Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether a current limit detection is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if CLRIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 4 IOFIM R/W 0 Internal Oscillator Fault Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether an internal oscillator fault detection is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if IOFRIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 3 MOFIM R/W 0 Main Oscillator Fault Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether a main oscillator fault detection is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if MOFRIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 2 LDOIM R/W 0 LDO Power Unregulated Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether an LDO unregulated power situation is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if LDORIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 1 BORIM R/W 0 Brown-Out Reset Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether a brown-out condition is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if BORRIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. 68 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 0 Name PLLFIM Type R/W Reset 0 Description PLL Fault Interrupt Mask This bit specifies whether a PLL fault detection is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, an interrupt is generated if PLLFRIS is set; otherwise, an interrupt is not generated. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 69 System Control Register 6: Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC), offset 0x058 Central location for system control result of RIS AND IMC to generate an interrupt to the controller. All of the bits are R/W1C and this action also clears the corresponding raw interrupt bit in the RIS register (see page 67). Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x058 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 PLLLMIS R/W1C 0 RO 0 5 CLMIS R/W1C 0 RO 0 4 IOFMIS R/W1C 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 MOFMIS LDOMIS BORMIS reserved R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:7 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL Lock Masked Interrupt Status This bit is set when the PLL TREADY timer asserts. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 6 PLLLMIS R/W1C 0 5 CLMIS R/W1C 0 Current Limit Masked Interrupt Status This bit is set if the LDO’s CLE output asserts. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 4 IOFMIS R/W1C 0 Internal Oscillator Fault Masked Interrupt Status This bit is set if an internal oscillator fault is detected. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 3 MOFMIS R/W1C 0 Main Oscillator Fault Masked Interrupt Status This bit is set if a main oscillator fault is detected. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 2 LDOMIS R/W1C 0 LDO Power Unregulated Masked Interrupt Status This bit is set if LDO power is unregulated. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 1 BORMIS R/W1C 0 BOR Masked Interrupt Status This bit is the masked interrupt status for any brown-out conditions. If set, a brown-out condition was detected. An interrupt is reported if the BORIM bit in the IMC register is set and the BORIOR bit in the PBORCTL register is cleared. The interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 70 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: Reset Cause (RESC), offset 0x05C This field specifies the cause of the reset event to software. The reset value is determined by the cause of the reset. When an external reset is the cause (EXT is set), all other reset bits are cleared. However, if the reset is due to any other cause, the remaining bits are sticky, allowing software to see all causes. Reset Cause (RESC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x05C Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 LDO RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W RO 0 4 SW R/W RO 0 3 WDT R/W RO 0 2 BOR R/W RO 0 1 POR R/W RO 0 0 EXT R/W - reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. LDO Reset When set, indicates the LDO circuit has lost regulation and has generated a reset event. 5 LDO R/W - 4 SW R/W - Software Reset When set, indicates a software reset is the cause of the reset event. 3 WDT R/W - Watchdog Timer Reset When set, indicates a watchdog reset is the cause of the reset event. 2 BOR R/W - Brown-Out Reset When set, indicates a brown-out reset is the cause of the reset event. 1 POR R/W - Power-On Reset When set, indicates a power-on reset is the cause of the reset event. 0 EXT R/W - External Reset When set, indicates an external reset (RST assertion) is the cause of the reset event. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 71 System Control Register 8: Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC), offset 0x060 This register is defined to provide source control and frequency speed. Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x060 Type R/W, reset 0x07AE.3AD1 31 30 29 28 27 ACG RO 0 12 OEN R/W 1 R/W 0 11 R/W 1 10 26 25 24 23 22 USESYSDIV 21 20 19 18 PWMDIV 17 16 reserved reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 PWRDN R/W 1 SYSDIV R/W 1 9 R/W 1 8 XTAL R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 reserved USEPWMDIV RO 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 1 3 R/W 0 6 R/W 1 2 R/W 1 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 BYPASS PLLVER R/W 1 R/W 0 OSCSRC R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 IOSCVER MOSCVER IOSCDIS MOSCDIS R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 Bit/Field 31:28 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Auto Clock Gating This bit specifies whether the system uses the Sleep-Mode Clock Gating Control (SCGCn) registers and Deep-Sleep-Mode Clock Gating Control (DCGCn) registers if the controller enters a Sleep or Deep-Sleep mode (respectively). If set, the SCGCn or DCGCn registers are used to control the clocks distributed to the peripherals when the controller is in a sleep mode. Otherwise, the Run-Mode Clock Gating Control (RCGCn) registers are used when the controller enters a sleep mode. The RCGCn registers are always used to control the clocks in Run mode. This allows peripherals to consume less power when the controller is in a sleep mode and the peripheral is unused. 27 ACG R/W 0 72 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 26:23 Name SYSDIV Type R/W Reset 0xF Description System Clock Divisor Specifies which divisor is used to generate the system clock from the PLL output. The PLL VCO frequency is 200 MHz. Value Divisor (BYPASS=1) Frequency (BYPASS=0) 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 0xC 0xD 0xE 0xF reserved /2 /3 /4 /5 /6 /7 /8 /9 /10 /11 /12 /13 /14 /15 /16 reserved reserved reserved 50 MHz 40 MHz 33.33 MHz 28.57 MHz 25 MHz 22.22 MHz 20 MHz 18.18 MHz 16.67 MHz 15.38 MHz 14.29 MHz 13.33 MHz 12.5 MHz (default) When reading the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register (see page 72), the SYSDIV value is MINSYSDIV if a lower divider was requested and the PLL is being used. This lower value is allowed to divide a non-PLL source. 22 USESYSDIV R/W 0 Enable System Clock Divider Use the system clock divider as the source for the system clock. The system clock divider is forced to be used when the PLL is selected as the source. 21 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Enable PWM Clock Divisor Use the PWM clock divider as the source for the PWM clock. 20 USEPWMDIV R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 73 System Control Bit/Field 19:17 Name PWMDIV Type R/W Reset 0x7 Description PWM Unit Clock Divisor This field specifies the binary divisor used to predivide the system clock down for use as the timing reference for the PWM module. This clock is only power 2 divide and rising edge is synchronous without phase shift from the system clock. Value Divisor 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 /2 /4 /8 /16 /32 /64 /64 /64 (default) 16:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL Power Down This bit connects to the PLL PWRDN input. The reset value of 1 powers down the PLL. See Table 6-2 on page 76 for PLL mode control. 13 PWRDN R/W 1 12 OEN R/W 1 PLL Output Enable This bit specifies whether the PLL output driver is enabled. If cleared, the driver transmits the PLL clock to the output. Otherwise, the PLL clock does not oscillate outside the PLL module. Note: Both PWRDN and OEN must be cleared to run the PLL. 11 BYPASS R/W 1 PLL Bypass Chooses whether the system clock is derived from the PLL output or the OSC source. If set, the clock that drives the system is the OSC source. Otherwise, the clock that drives the system is the PLL output clock divided by the system divider. 10 PLLVER R/W 0 PLL Verification This bit controls the PLL verification timer function. If set, the verification timer is enabled and an interrupt is generated if the PLL becomes inoperative. Otherwise, the verification timer is not enabled. 74 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 9:6 Name XTAL Type R/W Reset 0xB Description Crystal Value This field specifies the crystal value attached to the main oscillator. The encoding for this field is provided below. Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 0xC 0xD 0xE 0xF Crystal Frequency (MHz) Not Using the PLL 1.000 1.8432 2.000 2.4576 3.579545 MHz 3.6864 MHz 4 MHz 4.096 MHz 4.9152 MHz 5 MHz 5.12 MHz 6 MHz (reset value) 6.144 MHz 7.3728 MHz 8 MHz 8.192 MHz Crystal Frequency (MHz) Using the PLL reserved reserved reserved reserved 5:4 OSCSRC R/W 0x0 Oscillator Source Picks among the four input sources for the OSC. The values are: Value Input Source 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Main oscillator (default) Internal oscillator (default) Internal oscillator / 4 (this is necessary if used as input to PLL) reserved 3 IOSCVER R/W 0 Internal Oscillator Verification Timer This bit controls the internal oscillator verification timer function. If set, the verification timer is enabled and an interrupt is generated if the timer becomes inoperative. Otherwise, the verification timer is not enabled. 2 MOSCVER R/W 0 Main Oscillator Verification Timer This bit controls the main oscillator verification timer function. If set, the verification timer is enabled and an interrupt is generated if the timer becomes inoperative. Otherwise, the verification timer is not enabled. 1 IOSCDIS R/W 0 Internal Oscillator Disable 0: Internal oscillator (IOSC) is enabled. 1: Internal oscillator is disabled. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 75 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name MOSCDIS Type R/W Reset 1 Description Main Oscillator Disable 0: Main oscillator is enabled. 1: Main oscillator is disabled (default). Table 6-2. PLL Mode Control PWRDN OEN Mode 1 0 X 0 Power down Normal 76 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG), offset 0x064 This register provides a means of translating external crystal frequencies into the appropriate PLL settings. This register is initialized during the reset sequence and updated anytime that the XTAL field changes in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register (see page 72). The PLL frequency is calculated using the PLLCFG field values, as follows: PLLFreq = OSCFreq * (F + 2) / (R + 2) XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x064 Type RO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 OD Type Reset RO RO RO RO RO RO RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 F RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 R RO RO RO RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL OD Value This field specifies the value supplied to the PLL’s OD input. Value Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Divide by 1 Divide by 2 Divide by 4 Reserved 15:14 OD RO - 13:5 F RO - PLL F Value This field specifies the value supplied to the PLL’s F input. 4:0 R RO - PLL R Value This field specifies the value supplied to the PLL’s R input. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 77 System Control Register 10: Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG), offset 0x144 This register is used to automatically switch from the main oscillator to the internal oscillator when entering Deep-Sleep mode. The system clock source is the main oscillator by default. When this register is set, the internal oscillator is powered up and the main oscillator is powered down. When the Deep-Sleep exit event occurs, hardware brings the system clock back to the source and frequency it had at the onset of Deep-Sleep mode. Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x144 Type R/W, reset 0x0780.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 IOSC R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. IOSC Clock Source When set, forces IOSC to be clock source during Deep-Sleep (overrides DSOSCSRC field if set) 0 IOSC R/W 0 78 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 11: Clock Verification Clear (CLKVCLR), offset 0x150 This register is provided as a means of clearing the clock verification circuits by software. Since the clock verification circuits force a known good clock to control the process, the controller is allowed the opportunity to solve the problem and clear the verification fault. This register clears all clock verification faults. To clear a clock verification fault, the VERCLR bit must be set and then cleared by software. This bit is not self-clearing. Clock Verification Clear (CLKVCLR) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x150 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 VERCLR R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Clock Verification Clear Clears clock verification faults. 0 VERCLR R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 79 System Control Register 12: Allow Unregulated LDO to Reset the Part (LDOARST), offset 0x160 This register is provided as a means of allowing the LDO to reset the part if the voltage goes unregulated. Use this register to choose whether to automatically reset the part if the LDO goes unregulated, based on the design tolerance for LDO fluctuation. Allow Unregulated LDO to Reset the Part (LDOARST) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x160 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 LDOARST R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name Reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. LDO Reset When set, allows unregulated LDO output to reset the part. 0 LDOARST R/W 0 80 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: Device Identification 1 (DID1), offset 0x004 This register identifies the device family, part number, temperature range, and package type. Device Identification 1 (DID1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 31 30 VER Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 29 28 27 26 FAM RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 TEMP RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PARTNO RO 0 4 PKG RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 ROHS RO 1 RO RO 0 1 QUAL RO RO 1 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:28 Name VER Type RO Reset 0x0 Description DID1 Version This field defines the DID1 register format version. The version number is numeric. The value of the VER field is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x0 Initial DID1 register format definition, indicating a Stellaris LM3Snnn device. 27:24 FAM RO 0x0 Family This field provides the family identification of the device within the Luminary Micro product portfolio. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x0 Stellaris family of microcontollers, that is, all devices with external part numbers starting with LM3S. 23:16 PARTNO RO 0x21 Part Number This field provides the part number of the device within the family. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x21 LM3S601 15:8 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 81 System Control Bit/Field 7:5 Name TEMP Type RO Reset 0x1 Description Temperature Range This field specifies the temperature rating of the device. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x1 Industrial temperature range (-40°C to 85°C) 4:3 PKG RO 0x1 Package Type This field specifies the package type. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x1 48-pin LQFP package 2 ROHS RO 1 RoHS-Compliance This bit specifies whether the device is RoHS-compliant. A 1 indicates the part is RoHS-compliant. 1:0 QUAL RO - Qualification Status This field specifies the qualification status of the device. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 Engineering Sample (unqualified) Pilot Production (unqualified) Fully Qualified 82 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 14: Device Capabilities 0 (DC0), offset 0x008 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. Device Capabilities 0 (DC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x008 Type RO, reset 0x001F.000F 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 SRAMSZ Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 1 4 RO 1 3 RO 1 2 RO 1 1 RO 1 0 FLASHSZ Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field 31:16 Name SRAMSZ Type RO Reset 0x001F Description SRAM Size Indicates the size of the on-chip SRAM memory. Value Description 0x001F 8 KB of SRAM 15:0 FLASHSZ RO 0x000F Flash Size Indicates the size of the on-chip flash memory. Value Description 0x000F 32 KB of Flash October 01, 2007 Preliminary 83 System Control Register 15: Device Capabilities 1 (DC1), offset 0x010 This register provides a list of features available in the system. The Stellaris family uses this register format to indicate the availability of the following family features in the specific device: PWM, ADC, Watchdog timer, and debug capabilities. This register also indicates the maximum clock frequency and maximum ADC sample rate. The format of this register is consistent with the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 clock control registers and the SRCR0 software reset control register. Device Capabilities 1 (DC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x010 Type RO, reset 0x0010.309F 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 MPU RO 1 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 PWM RO 1 4 PLL RO 1 RO 0 3 WDT RO 1 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 2 SWO RO 1 RO 0 1 SWD RO 1 RO 0 0 JTAG RO 1 MINSYSDIV Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 Bit/Field 31:21 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM Module Present When set, indicates that the PWM module is present. 20 PWM RO 1 19:16 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. System Clock Divider Minimum 4-bit divider value for system clock. The reset value is hardware-dependent. See the RCC register for how to change the system clock divisor using the SYSDIV bit. Value Description 0x3 Specifies a 50-MHz CPU clock with a PLL divider of 4. 15:12 MINSYSDIV RO 0x3 11:8 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. MPU Present When set, indicates that the Cortex-M3 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) module is present. See the ARM Cortex-M3 Technical Reference Manual for details on the MPU. 7 MPU RO 1 6:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 84 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 4 Name PLL Type RO Reset 1 Description PLL Present When set, indicates that the on-chip Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is present. 3 WDT RO 1 Watchdog Timer Present When set, indicates that a watchdog timer is present. 2 SWO RO 1 SWO Trace Port Present When set, indicates that the Serial Wire Output (SWO) trace port is present. 1 SWD RO 1 SWD Present When set, indicates that the Serial Wire Debugger (SWD) is present. 0 JTAG RO 1 JTAG Present When set, indicates that the JTAG debugger interface is present. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 85 System Control Register 16: Device Capabilities 2 (DC2), offset 0x014 This register provides a list of features available in the system. The Stellaris family uses this register format to indicate the availability of the following family features in the specific device: Analog Comparators, General-Purpose Timers, I2Cs, QEIs, SSIs, and UARTs. The format of this register is consistent with the RCGC1, SCGC1, and DCGC1 clock control registers and the SRCR1 software reset control register. Device Capabilities 2 (DC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x0707.1113 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 I2C0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 11 28 27 26 COMP2 RO 1 10 reserved RO 0 RO 0 25 COMP1 RO 1 9 24 COMP0 RO 1 8 QEI0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 reserved RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SSI0 RO 1 RO 0 3 reserved RO 0 RO 0 20 19 18 TIMER2 RO 1 2 17 TIMER1 RO 1 1 UART1 RO 1 16 TIMER0 RO 1 0 UART0 RO 1 Bit/Field 31:27 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Comparator 2 Present When set, indicates that analog comparator 2 is present. 26 COMP2 RO 1 25 COMP1 RO 1 Analog Comparator 1 Present When set, indicates that analog comparator 1 is present. 24 COMP0 RO 1 Analog Comparator 0 Present When set, indicates that analog comparator 0 is present. 23:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Timer 2 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 2 is present. 18 TIMER2 RO 1 17 TIMER1 RO 1 Timer 1 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 1 is present. 16 TIMER0 RO 1 Timer 0 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 0 is present. 15:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C Module 0 Present When set, indicates that I2C module 0 is present. 12 I2C0 RO 1 86 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 11:9 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. QEI0 Present When set, indicates that QEI module 0 is present. 8 QEI0 RO 1 7:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI0 Present When set, indicates that SSI module 0 is present. 4 SSI0 RO 1 3:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART1 Present When set, indicates that UART module 1 is present. 1 UART1 RO 1 0 UART0 RO 1 UART0 Present When set, indicates that UART module 0 is present. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 87 System Control Register 17: Device Capabilities 3 (DC3), offset 0x018 This register provides a list of features available in the system. The Stellaris family uses this register format to indicate the availability of the following family features in the specific device: Analog Comparator I/Os, CCP I/Os, ADC I/Os, and PWM I/Os. Device Capabilities 3 (DC3) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x3F00.37FF 31 30 29 CCP5 RO 1 13 28 CCP4 RO 1 12 27 CCP3 RO 1 11 26 CCP2 RO 1 10 25 CCP1 RO 1 9 24 CCP0 RO 1 8 C0O RO 1 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 PWM5 RO 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved RO 0 4 PWM4 RO 1 RO 0 3 PWM3 RO 1 RO 0 2 PWM2 RO 1 RO 0 1 PWM1 RO 1 RO 0 0 PWM0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 C2PLUS C2MINUS reserved C1PLUS C1MINUS RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 C0PLUS C0MINUS RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field 31:30 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. CCP5 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 5 is present. 29 CCP5 RO 1 28 CCP4 RO 1 CCP4 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 4 is present. 27 CCP3 RO 1 CCP3 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 3 is present. 26 CCP2 RO 1 CCP2 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 2 is present. 25 CCP1 RO 1 CCP1 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 1 is present. 24 CCP0 RO 1 CCP0 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 0 is present. 23:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. C2+ Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 2 (+) input pin is present. 13 C2PLUS RO 1 12 C2MINUS RO 1 C2- Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 2 (-) input pin is present. 88 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. C1+ Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 1 (+) input pin is present. 10 C1PLUS RO 1 9 C1MINUS RO 1 C1- Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 1 (-) input pin is present. 8 C0O RO 1 C0o Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 output pin is present. 7 C0PLUS RO 1 C0+ Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 (+) input pin is present. 6 C0MINUS RO 1 C0- Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 (-) input pin is present. 5 PWM5 RO 1 PWM5 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 5 is present. 4 PWM4 RO 1 PWM4 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 4 is present. 3 PWM3 RO 1 PWM3 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 3 is present. 2 PWM2 RO 1 PWM2 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 2 is present. 1 PWM1 RO 1 PWM1 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 1 is present. 0 PWM0 RO 1 PWM0 Pin Present When set, indicates that the PWM pin 0 is present. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 89 System Control Register 18: Device Capabilities 4 (DC4), offset 0x01C This register provides a list of features available in the system. The Stellaris family uses this register format to indicate the availability of GPIOs in the specific device. The format of this register is consistent with the RCGC2, SCGC2, and DCGC2 clock control registers and the SRCR2 software reset control register. Device Capabilities 4 (DC4) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0000.001F 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 GPIOE RO 1 RO 0 3 GPIOD RO 1 RO 0 2 GPIOC RO 1 RO 0 1 GPIOB RO 1 RO 0 0 GPIOA RO 1 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Port E Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port E is present. 4 GPIOE RO 1 3 GPIOD RO 1 GPIO Port D Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port D is present. 2 GPIOC RO 1 GPIO Port C Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port C is present. 1 GPIOB RO 1 GPIO Port B Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port B is present. 0 GPIOA RO 1 GPIO Port A Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port A is present. 90 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 19: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0), offset 0x100 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x100 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 PWM R/W 0 4 RO 0 3 WDT R/W 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 2 RO 0 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:21 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the PWM module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 20 PWM R/W 0 19:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the WDT module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 3 WDT R/W 0 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 91 System Control Register 20: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0), offset 0x110 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x110 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 PWM R/W 0 4 RO 0 3 WDT R/W 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 2 RO 0 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:21 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the PWM module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 20 PWM R/W 0 19:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the WDT module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 3 WDT R/W 0 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 92 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 21: Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0), offset 0x120 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x120 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 PWM R/W 0 4 RO 0 3 WDT R/W 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 2 RO 0 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:21 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the PWM module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 20 PWM R/W 0 19:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the WDT module. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, a read or write to the unit generates a bus fault. 3 WDT R/W 0 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 93 System Control Register 22: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1), offset 0x104 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x104 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 I2C0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 28 27 26 COMP2 R/W 0 10 reserved RO 0 RO 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 9 24 COMP0 R/W 0 8 QEI0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 reserved RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SSI0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 reserved RO 0 RO 0 20 19 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 2 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 1 UART1 R/W 0 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 0 UART0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:27 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Comparator 2 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 26 COMP2 R/W 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 23:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 94 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 18 Name TIMER2 Type R/W Reset 0 Description Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 15:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 11:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. QEI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for QEI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 8 QEI0 R/W 0 7:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 SSI0 R/W 0 3:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 95 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name UART0 Type R/W Reset 0 Description UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 96 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 23: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1), offset 0x114 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x114 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 I2C0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 28 27 26 COMP2 R/W 0 10 reserved RO 0 RO 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 9 24 COMP0 R/W 0 8 QEI0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 reserved RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SSI0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 reserved RO 0 RO 0 20 19 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 2 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 1 UART1 R/W 0 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 0 UART0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:27 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Comparator 2 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 26 COMP2 R/W 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 23:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 97 System Control Bit/Field 18 Name TIMER2 Type R/W Reset 0 Description Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 15:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 11:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. QEI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for QEI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 8 QEI0 R/W 0 7:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 SSI0 R/W 0 3:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 98 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 0 Name UART0 Type R/W Reset 0 Description UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 99 System Control Register 24: Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1), offset 0x124 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x124 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 I2C0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 28 27 26 COMP2 R/W 0 10 reserved RO 0 RO 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 9 24 COMP0 R/W 0 8 QEI0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 reserved RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SSI0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 reserved RO 0 RO 0 20 19 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 2 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 1 UART1 R/W 0 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 0 UART0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:27 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Comparator 2 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 26 COMP2 R/W 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 23:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 100 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 18 Name TIMER2 Type R/W Reset 0 Description Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 15:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 11:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. QEI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for QEI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 8 QEI0 R/W 0 7:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 SSI0 R/W 0 3:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 101 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name UART0 Type R/W Reset 0 Description UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 102 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 25: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2), offset 0x108 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x108 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 GPIOE R/W 0 RO 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 RO 0 2 GPIOC R/W 0 RO 0 1 GPIOB R/W 0 RO 0 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Port E Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 103 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name GPIOA Type R/W Reset 0 Description Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 104 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 26: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2), offset 0x118 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x118 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 GPIOE R/W 0 RO 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 RO 0 2 GPIOC R/W 0 RO 0 1 GPIOB R/W 0 RO 0 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Port E Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 105 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name GPIOA Type R/W Reset 0 Description Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 106 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 27: Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2), offset 0x128 This register controls the clock gating logic. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or unit. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional units are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or units to control. This is to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x128 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 GPIOE R/W 0 RO 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 RO 0 2 GPIOC R/W 0 RO 0 1 GPIOB R/W 0 RO 0 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Port E Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 107 System Control Bit/Field 0 Name GPIOA Type R/W Reset 0 Description Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the unit receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the unit is unclocked and disabled. If the unit is unclocked, reads or writes to the unit will generate a bus fault. 108 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 28: Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0), offset 0x040 Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 1 (DC1) register. Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x040 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 25 24 23 22 21 20 PWM R/W 0 4 RO 0 3 WDT R/W 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 2 RO 0 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:21 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM Reset Control Reset control for PWM module. 20 PWM R/W 0 19:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Reset Control Reset control for Watchdog unit. 3 WDT R/W 0 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 109 System Control Register 29: Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1), offset 0x044 Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 2 (DC2) register. Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x044 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 I2C0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 28 27 26 COMP2 R/W 0 10 reserved RO 0 RO 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 9 24 COMP0 R/W 0 8 QEI0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 reserved RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SSI0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 reserved RO 0 RO 0 20 19 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 2 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 1 UART1 R/W 0 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 0 UART0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:27 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Comp 2 Reset Control Reset control for analog comparator 2. 26 COMP2 R/W 0 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comp 1 Reset Control Reset control for analog comparator 1. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comp 0 Reset Control Reset control for analog comparator 0. 23:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Timer 2 Reset Control Reset control for General-Purpose Timer module 2. 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Reset Control Reset control for General-Purpose Timer module 1. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Reset Control Reset control for General-Purpose Timer module 0. 15:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C0 Reset Control Reset control for I2C unit 0. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 11:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 110 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 8 Name QEI0 Type R/W Reset 0 Description QEI0 Reset Control Reset control for QEI unit 0. 7:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI0 Reset Control Reset control for SSI unit 0. 4 SSI0 R/W 0 3:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART1 Reset Control Reset control for UART unit 1. 1 UART1 R/W 0 0 UART0 R/W 0 UART0 Reset Control Reset control for UART unit 0. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 111 System Control Register 30: Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2), offset 0x048 Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 4 (DC4) register. Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x048 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 GPIOE R/W 0 RO 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 RO 0 2 GPIOC R/W 0 RO 0 1 GPIOB R/W 0 RO 0 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Port E Reset Control Reset control for GPIO Port E. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Reset Control Reset control for GPIO Port D. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Reset Control Reset control for GPIO Port C. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Reset Control Reset control for GPIO Port B. 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Port A Reset Control Reset control for GPIO Port A. 112 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 7 Internal Memory The LM3S601 microcontroller comes with 8 KB of bit-banded SRAM and 32 KB of flash memory. The flash controller provides a user-friendly interface, making flash programming a simple task. Flash protection can be applied to the flash memory on a 2-KB block basis. 7.1 Block Diagram Figure 7-1. Flash Block Diagram Flash Timing USECRL Flash Control ICode Cortex-M3 DCode FMA FMD FMC System Bus FCRIS FCIM FCMISC Bridge APB Flash Array Flash Protection FMPRE SRAM Array FMPPE 7.2 7.2.1 Functional Description This section describes the functionality of both the flash and SRAM memories. SRAM Memory The internal SRAM of the Stellaris devices is located at address 0x2000.0000 of the device memory map. To reduce the number of time consuming read-modify-write (RMW) operations, ARM has introduced bit-banding technology in the Cortex-M3 processor. With a bit-band-enabled processor, certain regions in the memory map (SRAM and peripheral space) can use address aliases to access individual bits in a single, atomic operation. The bit-band alias is calculated by using the formula: ® October 01, 2007 Preliminary 113 Internal Memory bit-band alias = bit-band base + (byte offset * 32) + (bit number * 4) For example, if bit 3 at address 0x2000.1000 is to be modified, the bit-band alias is calculated as: 0x2200.0000 + (0x1000 * 32) + (3 * 4) = 0x2202.000C With the alias address calculated, an instruction performing a read/write to address 0x2202.000C allows direct access to only bit 3 of the byte at address 0x2000.1000. For details about bit-banding, please refer to Chapter 4, “Memory Map” in the ARM® Cortex™-M3 Technical Reference Manual. 7.2.2 Flash Memory The flash is organized as a set of 1-KB blocks that can be individually erased. Erasing a block causes the entire contents of the block to be reset to all 1s. An individual 32-bit word can be programmed to change bits that are currently 1 to a 0. These blocks are paired into a set of 2-KB blocks that can be individually protected. The protection allows blocks to be marked as read-only or execute-only, providing different levels of code protection. Read-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, protecting the contents of those blocks from being modified. Execute-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, and can only be read by the controller instruction fetch mechanism, protecting the contents of those blocks from being read by either the controller or by a debugger. See also “Serial Flash Loader” on page 425 for a preprogrammed flash-resident utility used to download code to the flash memory of a device without the use of a debug interface. 7.2.2.1 Flash Memory Timing The timing for the flash is automatically handled by the flash controller. However, in order to do so, it must know the clock rate of the system in order to time its internal signals properly. The number of clock cycles per microsecond must be provided to the flash controller for it to accomplish this timing. It is software's responsibility to keep the flash controller updated with this information via the USec Reload (USECRL) register. On reset, the USECRL register is loaded with a value that configures the flash timing so that it works with the maximum clock rate of the part. If software changes the system operating frequency, the new operating frequency minus 1 (in MHz) must be loaded into USECRL before any flash modifications are attempted. For example, if the device is operating at a speed of 20 MHz, a value of 0x13 (20-1) must be written to the USECRL register. 7.2.2.2 Flash Memory Protection The user is provided two forms of flash protection per 2-KB flash blocks in two 32-bit wide registers.The protection policy for each form is controlled by individual bits (per policy per block) in the FMPPEn and FMPREn registers. ■ Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPEn): If set, the block may be programmed (written) or erased. If cleared, the block may not be changed. ■ Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPREn): If set, the block may be executed or read by software or debuggers. If cleared, the block may only be executed. The contents of the memory block are prohibited from being accessed as data and traversing the DCode bus. The policies may be combined as shown in Table 7-1 on page 115. 114 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Table 7-1. Flash Protection Policy Combinations FMPPEn FMPREn Protection 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 Execute-only protection. The block may only be executed and may not be written or erased. This mode is used to protect code. The block may be written, erased or executed, but not read. This combination is unlikely to be used. Read-only protection. The block may be read or executed but may not be written or erased. This mode is used to lock the block from further modification while allowing any read or execute access. No protection. The block may be written, erased, executed or read. An access that attempts to program or erase a PE-protected block is prohibited. A controller interrupt may be optionally generated (by setting the AMASK bit in the FIM register) to alert software developers of poorly behaving software during the development and debug phases. An access that attempts to read an RE-protected block is prohibited. Such accesses return data filled with all 0s. A controller interrupt may be optionally generated to alert software developers of poorly behaving software during the development and debug phases. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This implements a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. 7.2.2.3 Flash Protection by Disabling Debug Access Flash memory may also be protected by permanently disabling access to the Debug Access Port (DAP) through the JTAG and SWD interfaces. This is accomplished by clearing the DBG field of the FMPRE register. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (DBG field): If set to 0x2, access to the DAP is enabled through the JTAG and SWD interfaces. If clear, access to the DAP is disabled. The DBG field programming becomes permanent, and irreversible, after a commit sequence is performed. In the initial state, provided from the factory, access is enabled in order to facilitate code development and debug. Access to the DAP may be disabled at the end of the manufacturing flow, once all tests have passed and software loaded. This change will not take effect until the next power-up of the device. Note that it is recommended that disabling access to the DAP be combined with a mechanism for providing end-user installable updates (if necessary) such as the Stellaris boot loader. Important: Once the DBG field is cleared and committed, this field can never be restored to the factory-programmed value—which means JTAG/SWD interface to the debug module can never be re-enabled. This sequence does NOT disable the JTAG controller, it only disables the access of the DAP through the JTAG or SWD interfaces. The JTAG interface remains functional and access to the Test Access Port remains enabled, allowing the user to execute the IEEE JTAG-defined instructions (for example, to perform boundary scan operations). If the user will also be using the FMPRE bits to protect flash memory from being read as data (to mark sets of 2 KB blocks of flash memory as execute-only), these one-time-programmable bits should be written at the same time that the debug disable bits are programmed. Mechanisms to execute the one-time code sequence to disable all debug access include: ■ Selecting the debug disable option in the Stellaris boot loader October 01, 2007 Preliminary 115 Internal Memory ■ Loading the debug disable sequence into SRAM and running it once from SRAM after programming the final end application code into flash 7.3 Flash Memory Initialization and Configuration This section shows examples for using the flash controller to perform various operations on the contents of the flash memory. 7.3.1 Changing Flash Protection Bits As discussed in “Flash Memory Protection” on page 114, changes to the protection bits must be committed before they take effect. The sequence below is used change and commit a block protection bit in the FMPRE or FMPPE registers. The sequence to change and commit a bit in software is as follows: 1. The Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE) and Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPE) registers are written, changing the intended bit(s). The action of these changes can be tested by software while in this state. 2. The Flash Memory Address (FMA) register (see page 119) bit 0 is set to 1 if the FMPPE register is to be committed; otherwise, a 0 commits the FMPRE register. 3. The Flash Memory Control (FMC) register (see page 121) is written with the COMT bit set. This initiates a write sequence and commits the changes. There is a special sequence to change and commit the DBG bits in the Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE) register. This sequence also sets and commits any changes from 1 to 0 in the block protection bits (for execute-only) in the FMPRE register. 1. The Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE) register is written, changing the intended bit(s). The action of these changes can be tested by software while in this state. 2. The Flash Memory Address (FMA) register (see ppage 119) is written with a value of 0x900. 3. The Flash Memory Control (FMC) register (see page 121) is written with the COMT bit set. This initiates a write sequence and commits the changes. Below is an example code sequence to permanently disable the JTAG and SWD interface to the debug module using Luminary Micro's DriverLib peripheral driver library: #include "hw_types.h" #include "hw_flash.h" void permanently_disable_jtag_swd(void) { // // Clear the DBG field of the FMPRE register. Note that the value // used in this instance does not affect the state of the BlockN // bits, but were the value different, all bits in the FMPRE are // affected by this function! // HWREG(FLASH_FMPRE) &= 0x3fffffff; // // The following sequence activates the one-time 116 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller // programming of the FMPRE register. // HWREG(FLASH_FMA) = 0x900; HWREG(FLASH_FMC) = (FLASH_FMC_WRKEY | FLASH_FMC_COMT); // // Wait until the operation is complete. // while (HWREG(FLASH_FMC) & FLASH_FMC_COMT) { } } 7.3.2 Flash Programming The Stellaris devices provide a user-friendly interface for flash programming. All erase/program operations are handled via three registers: FMA, FMD, and FMC. ® 7.3.2.1 To program a 32-bit word 1. Write source data to the FMD register. 2. Write the target address to the FMA register. 3. Write the flash write key and the WRITE bit (a value of 0xA442.0001) to the FMC register. 4. Poll the FMC register until the WRITE bit is cleared. 7.3.2.2 To perform an erase of a 1-KB page 1. Write the page address to the FMA register. 2. Write the flash write key and the ERASE bit (a value of 0xA442.0002) to the FMC register. 3. Poll the FMC register until the ERASE bit is cleared. 7.3.2.3 To perform a mass erase of the flash 1. Write the flash write key and the MERASE bit (a value of 0xA442.0004) to the FMC register. 2. Poll the FMC register until the MERASE bit is cleared. 7.4 Register Map Table 7-2 on page 118 lists the Flash memory and control registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register's address. The FMA, FMD, FMC, FCRIS, FCIM, and FCMISC registers are relative to the Flash control base address of 0x400F.D000. The FMPREn, FMPPEn, USECRL, USER_DBG, and USER_REGn registers are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 117 Internal Memory Table 7-2. Flash Register Map Offset Name Type Reset Description See page Flash Control Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 FMA FMD FMC FCRIS FCIM FCMISC R/W R/W R/W RO R/W R/W1C 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Address Flash Memory Data Flash Memory Control Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status Flash Controller Interrupt Mask Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear 119 120 121 123 124 125 System Control Offset 0x130 0x134 0x140 FMPRE FMPPE USECRL R/W R/W R/W 0x8000.FFFF 0x0000.FFFF 0x31 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable Flash Memory Protection Program Enable USec Reload 127 128 126 7.5 Flash Register Descriptions (Flash Control Offset) The remainder of this section lists and describes the Flash Memory registers, in numerical order by address offset. Registers in this section are relative to the Flash control base address of 0x400F.D000. 118 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: Flash Memory Address (FMA), offset 0x000 During a write operation, this register contains a 4-byte-aligned address and specifies where the data is written. During erase operations, this register contains a 1 KB-aligned address and specifies which page is erased. Note that the alignment requirements must be met by software or the results of the operation are unpredictable. Flash Memory Address (FMA) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 reserved Type Reset RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 OFFSET R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:15 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Address Offset Address offset in flash where operation is performed. 14:0 OFFSET R/W 0x0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 119 Internal Memory Register 2: Flash Memory Data (FMD), offset 0x004 This register contains the data to be written during the programming cycle or read during the read cycle. Note that the contents of this register are undefined for a read access of an execute-only block. This register is not used during the erase cycles. Flash Memory Data (FMD) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 DATA Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name DATA Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Data Value Data value for write operation. 120 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: Flash Memory Control (FMC), offset 0x008 When this register is written, the flash controller initiates the appropriate access cycle for the location specified by the Flash Memory Address (FMA) register (see page 119). If the access is a write access, the data contained in the Flash Memory Data (FMD) register (see page 120) is written. This is the final register written and initiates the memory operation. There are four control bits in the lower byte of this register that, when set, initiate the memory operation. The most used of these register bits are the ERASE and WRITE bits. It is a programming error to write multiple control bits and the results of such an operation are unpredictable. Flash Memory Control (FMC) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WRKEY Type Reset WO 0 15 WO 0 14 WO 0 13 WO 0 12 WO 0 11 WO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 WO 0 9 WO 0 8 WO 0 7 WO 0 6 WO 0 5 WO 0 4 WO 0 3 COMT R/W 0 WO 0 2 WO 0 1 WO 0 0 WRITE R/W 0 MERASE ERASE R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name WRKEY Type WO Reset 0x0 Description Flash Write Key This field contains a write key, which is used to minimize the incidence of accidental flash writes. The value 0xA442 must be written into this field for a write to occur. Writes to the FMC register without this WRKEY value are ignored. A read of this field returns the value 0. 15:4 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Commit Register Value Commit (write) of register value to nonvolatile storage. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. If read, the state of the previous commit access is provided. If the previous commit access is complete, a 0 is returned; otherwise, if the commit access is not complete, a 1 is returned. This can take up to 50 μs. 3 COMT R/W 0 2 MERASE R/W 0 Mass Erase Flash Memory If this bit is set, the flash main memory of the device is all erased. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. If read, the state of the previous mass erase access is provided. If the previous mass erase access is complete, a 0 is returned; otherwise, if the previous mass erase access is not complete, a 1 is returned. This can take up to 250 ms. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 121 Internal Memory Bit/Field 1 Name ERASE Type R/W Reset 0 Description Erase a Page of Flash Memory If this bit is set, the page of flash main memory as specified by the contents of FMA is erased. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. If read, the state of the previous erase access is provided. If the previous erase access is complete, a 0 is returned; otherwise, if the previous erase access is not complete, a 1 is returned. This can take up to 25 ms. 0 WRITE R/W 0 Write a Word into Flash Memory If this bit is set, the data stored in FMD is written into the location as specified by the contents of FMA. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. If read, the state of the previous write update is provided. If the previous write access is complete, a 0 is returned; otherwise, if the write access is not complete, a 1 is returned. This can take up to 50 µs. 122 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS), offset 0x00C This register indicates that the flash controller has an interrupt condition. An interrupt is only signaled if the corresponding FCIM register bit is set. Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x00C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 PRIS RO 0 RO 0 0 ARIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Raw Interrupt Status This bit indicates the current state of the programming cycle. If set, the programming cycle completed; if cleared, the programming cycle has not completed. Programming cycles are either write or erase actions generated through the Flash Memory Control (FMC) register bits (see page 121). 1 PRIS RO 0 0 ARIS RO 0 Access Raw Interrupt Status This bit indicates if the flash was improperly accessed. If set, the program tried to access the flash counter to the policy as set in the Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPREn) and Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPEn) registers. Otherwise, no access has tried to improperly access the flash. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 123 Internal Memory Register 5: Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM), offset 0x010 This register controls whether the flash controller generates interrupts to the controller. Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 PMASK R/W 0 RO 0 0 AMASK R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Interrupt Mask This bit controls the reporting of the programming raw interrupt status to the controller. If set, a programming-generated interrupt is promoted to the controller. Otherwise, interrupts are recorded but suppressed from the controller. 1 PMASK R/W 0 0 AMASK R/W 0 Access Interrupt Mask This bit controls the reporting of the access raw interrupt status to the controller. If set, an access-generated interrupt is promoted to the controller. Otherwise, interrupts are recorded but suppressed from the controller. 124 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 6: Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC), offset 0x014 This register provides two functions. First, it reports the cause of an interrupt by indicating which interrupt source or sources are signalling the interrupt. Second, it serves as the method to clear the interrupt reporting. Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 PMISC R/W1C 0 RO 0 0 AMISC R/W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Masked Interrupt Status and Clear This bit indicates whether an interrupt was signaled because a programming cycle completed and was not masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1. The PRIS bit in the FCRIS register (see page 123) is also cleared when the PMISC bit is cleared. 1 PMISC R/W1C 0 0 AMISC R/W1C 0 Access Masked Interrupt Status and Clear This bit indicates whether an interrupt was signaled because an improper access was attempted and was not masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1. The ARIS bit in the FCRIS register is also cleared when the AMISC bit is cleared. 7.6 Flash Register Descriptions (System Control Offset) The remainder of this section lists and describes the Flash Memory registers, in numerical order by address offset. Registers in this section are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 125 Internal Memory Register 7: USec Reload (USECRL), offset 0x140 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400F.E000 This register is provided as a means of creating a 1-μs tick divider reload value for the flash controller. The internal flash has specific minimum and maximum requirements on the length of time the high voltage write pulse can be applied. It is required that this register contain the operating frequency (in MHz -1) whenever the flash is being erased or programmed. The user is required to change this value if the clocking conditions are changed for a flash erase/program operation. USec Reload (USECRL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x140 Type R/W, reset 0x31 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 USEC RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Microsecond Reload Value MHz -1 of the controller clock when the flash is being erased or programmed. USEC should be set to 0x31 (50 MHz) whenever the flash is being erased or programmed. 7:0 USEC R/W 0x31 126 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 8: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE), offset 0x130 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (see the FMPPE registers for the execute-only protection bits). This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settingsare a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This implements a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. For additional information, see the “Flash Memory Protection” section. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPRE) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x130 Type R/W, reset 0x8000.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field 31:0 Name READ_ENABLE Type R/W Reset Description 0x8000FFFF Flash Read Enable Each bit position maps 2 Kbytes of Flash to be read-enabled. Value Description 0x8000FFFF Enables 32 KB of flash. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 127 Internal Memory Register 9: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPE), offset 0x134 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (see the FMPRE registers for the read-only protection bits). This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This implements a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. For additional information, see the “Flash Memory Protection” section. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPE) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x134 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field 31:0 Name PROG_ENABLE Type R/W Reset Description 0x0000FFFF Flash Programming Enable Each bit position maps 2 Kbytes of Flash to be write-enabled. Value Description 0x0000FFFF Enables 32 KB of flash. 128 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 8 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) The GPIO module is composed of five physical GPIO blocks, each corresponding to an individual GPIO port (Port A, Port B, Port C, Port D, and Port E, ). The GPIO module is FiRM-compliant and supports 0-36 programmable input/output pins, depending on the peripherals being used. The GPIO module has the following features: ■ Programmable control for GPIO interrupts – Interrupt generation masking – Edge-triggered on rising, falling, or both – Level-sensitive on High or Low values ■ 5-V-tolerant input/outputs ■ Bit masking in both read and write operations through address lines ■ Programmable control for GPIO pad configuration – Weak pull-up or pull-down resistors – 2-mA, 4-mA, and 8-mA pad drive – Slew rate control for the 8-mA drive – Open drain enables – Digital input enables October 01, 2007 Preliminary 129 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) 8.1 Block Diagram Figure 8-1. GPIO Module Block Diagram PA0 GPIO Port A PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 U0Rx U0Tx SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx SSITx SSI CCP2 Timer1 CCP3 CCP5 UART0 PWM2 Timer2 PWM4 PWM5 GPIO Port E CCP4 PE0 PE1 PE2 PE3 PE4 PE5 PB0 PB1 GPIO Port B PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PWM2 PWM3 I2CSCL I2CSDA C0C1C0+ PWM1 Fault PWM0 PWM0 PWM1 GPIO Port D U1Rx U1Tx CCP0 PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 I2C CCP1 UART1 Timer0 C2Analog C2+ Comparators C0o/C1+ PhB PhA QEI IDX PD7 JTAG TCK/SWCLK TMS/SWDIO TRST GPIO Port C PC1 PC2 PC3 TDO/SWO PC4 TDI PC5 PC6 8.2 Functional Description Important: All GPIO pins are inputs by default (GPIODIR=0 and GPIOAFSEL=0), with the exception of the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). The JTAG pins default to their JTAG functionality (GPIOAFSEL=1). A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting an external reset (RST) puts both groups of pins back to their default state. Each GPIO port is a separate hardware instantiation of the same physical block (see Figure 8-2 on page 131). The LM3S601 microcontroller contains five ports and thus five of these physical GPIO blocks. 130 Preliminary PC7 PC0 October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 8-2. GPIO Port Block Diagram Mode Control GPIOAFSEL Alternate Input Alternate Output Alternate Output Enable Pad Output DEMUX MUX Pad Input Data Control GPIODATA GPIODIR GPIO Input GPIO Output Digital I/O Pad Package I/O Pin MUX GPIO Output Enable Pad Output Enable Interrupt Control Interrupt Pad Control GPIODR2R GPIODR4R GPIODR8R GPIOSLR GPIOPUR GPIOPDR GPIOODR GPIODEN GPIOIS GPIOIBE GPIOIEV GPIOIM GPIORIS GPIOMIS GPIOICR Identification Registers GPIOPeriphID0 GPIOPeriphID1 GPIOPeriphID2 GPIOPeriphID3 GPIOPeriphID4 GPIOPeriphID5 GPIOPeriphID6 GPIOPeriphID7 GPIOPCellID0 GPIOPCellID1 GPIOPCellID2 GPIOPCellID3 8.2.1 Data Control The data control registers allow software to configure the operational modes of the GPIOs. The data direction register configures the GPIO as an input or an output while the data register either captures incoming data or drives it out to the pads. 8.2.1.1 Data Direction Operation The GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) register (see page 138) is used to configure each individual pin as an input or output. When the data direction bit is set to 0, the GPIO is configured as an input and the corresponding data register bit will capture and store the value on the GPIO port. When the data direction bit is set to 1, the GPIO is configured as an output and the corresponding data register bit will be driven out on the GPIO port. 8.2.1.2 Data Register Operation To aid in the efficiency of software, the GPIO ports allow for the modification of individual bits in the GPIO Data (GPIODATA) register (see page 137) by using bits [9:2] of the address bus as a mask. This allows software drivers to modify individual GPIO pins in a single instruction, without affecting the state of the other pins. This is in contrast to the "typical" method of doing a read-modify-write operation to set or clear an individual GPIO pin. To accommodate this feature, the GPIODATA register covers 256 locations in the memory map. During a write, if the address bit associated with that data bit is set to 1, the value of the GPIODATA register is altered. If it is cleared to 0, it is left unchanged. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 131 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) For example, writing a value of 0xEB to the address GPIODATA + 0x098 would yield as shown in Figure 8-3 on page 132, where u is data unchanged by the write. Figure 8-3. GPIODATA Write Example ADDR[9:2] 0x098 0xEB GPIODATA 9 0 8 0 7 1 6 0 5 0 4 1 3 1 2 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 u 7 u 6 1 5 u 4 u 3 0 2 1 1 u 0 During a read, if the address bit associated with the data bit is set to 1, the value is read. If the address bit associated with the data bit is set to 0, it is read as a zero, regardless of its actual value. For example, reading address GPIODATA + 0x0C4 yields as shown in Figure 8-4 on page 132. Figure 8-4. GPIODATA Read Example ADDR[9:2] 0x0C4 GPIODATA Returned Value 9 0 8 0 7 1 6 1 5 0 4 0 3 0 2 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 7 0 6 1 5 1 4 0 3 0 2 0 1 0 0 8.2.2 Interrupt Control The interrupt capabilities of each GPIO port are controlled by a set of seven registers. With these registers, it is possible to select the source of the interrupt, its polarity, and the edge properties. When one or more GPIO inputs cause an interrupt, a single interrupt output is sent to the interrupt controller for the entire GPIO port. For edge-triggered interrupts, software must clear the interrupt to enable any further interrupts. For a level-sensitive interrupt, it is assumed that the external source holds the level constant for the interrupt to be recognized by the controller. Three registers are required to define the edge or sense that causes interrupts: ■ GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 139) ■ GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE) register (see page 140) ■ GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 141) Interrupts are enabled/disabled via the GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) register (see page 142). When an interrupt condition occurs, the state of the interrupt signal can be viewed in two locations: the GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS) and GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS) registers (see page 143 and page 144). As the name implies, the GPIOMIS register only shows interrupt conditions that are allowed to be passed to the controller. The GPIORIS register indicates that a GPIO pin meets the conditions for an interrupt, but has not necessarily been sent to the controller. Interrupts are cleared by writing a 1 to the GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR) register (see page 145). 132 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller When programming the following interrupt control registers, the interrupts should be masked (GPIOIM set to 0). Writing any value to an interrupt control register (GPIOIS, GPIOIBE, or GPIOIEV) can generate a spurious interrupt if the corresponding bits are enabled. 8.2.3 Mode Control The GPIO pins can be controlled by either hardware or software. When hardware control is enabled via the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 146), the pin state is controlled by its alternate function (that is, the peripheral). Software control corresponds to GPIO mode, where the GPIODATA register is used to read/write the corresponding pins. 8.2.4 Pad Control The pad control registers allow for GPIO pad configuration by software based on the application requirements. The pad control registers include the GPIODR2R, GPIODR4R, GPIODR8R, GPIOODR, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, GPIOSLR, and GPIODEN registers. 8.2.5 Identification The identification registers configured at reset allow software to detect and identify the module as a GPIO block. The identification registers include the GPIOPeriphID0-GPIOPeriphID7 registers as well as the GPIOPCellID0-GPIOPCellID3 registers. 8.3 Initialization and Configuration To use the GPIO, the peripheral clock must be enabled by setting the appropriate GPIO Port bit field (GPIOn) in the RCGC2 register. On reset, all GPIO pins (except for the five JTAG pins) default to general-purpose inut mode (GPIODIR=0 and GPIOAFSEL=0). Table 8-1 on page 133 shows all possible configurations of the GPIO pads and the control register settings required to achieve them. Table 8-2 on page 134 shows how a rising edge interrupt would be configured for pin 2 of a GPIO port. Table 8-1. GPIO Pad Configuration Examples Configuration GPIO Register Bit Value AFSEL Digital Input (GPIO) Digital Output (GPIO) Open Drain Input (GPIO) Open Drain Output (GPIO) Open Drain Input/Output (I2C) Digital Input (Timer CCP) Digital Input (QEI) Digital Output (PWM) Digital Output (Timer PWM) Digital Input/Output (SSI) 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 DIR 0 1 0 1 X X X X X X a ODR 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 DEN 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PUR ? ? X X X ? ? ? ? ? PDR ? ? X X X ? ? ? ? ? DR2R X ? X ? ? X X ? ? ? DR4R X ? X ? ? X X ? ? ? DR8R X ? X ? ? X X ? ? ? SLR X ? X ? ? X X ? ? ? October 01, 2007 Preliminary 133 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Configuration GPIO Register Bit Value AFSEL DIR X 0 X a ODR 0 0 0 DEN 1 0 1 PUR ? 0 ? PDR ? 0 ? DR2R ? X ? DR4R ? X ? DR8R ? X ? SLR ? X ? Digital Input/Output (UART) Analog Input (Comparator) Digital Output (Comparator) 1 0 1 a. X=Ignored (don’t care bit) ?=Can be either 0 or 1, depending on the configuration Table 8-2. GPIO Interrupt Configuration Example Register Desired Interrupt Event Trigger 0=edge 1=level GPIOIBE 0=single edge 1=both edges GPIOIEV 0=Low level, or negative edge 1=High level, or positive edge GPIOIM 0=masked 1=not masked a. X=Ignored (don’t care bit) 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 X X X X X 1 X X X X X X X 0 X X Pin 2 Bit Value 7 6 a 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOIS X X X X X 0 X X 8.4 Register Map Table 8-3 on page 135 lists the GPIO registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to that GPIO port’s base address: ■ GPIO Port A: 0x4000.4000 ■ GPIO Port B: 0x4000.5000 ■ GPIO Port C: 0x4000.6000 ■ GPIO Port D: 0x4000.7000 ■ GPIO Port E: 0x4002.4000 Important: The GPIO registers in this chapter are duplicated in each GPIO block, however, depending on the block, all eight bits may not be connected to a GPIO pad. In those 134 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller cases, writing to those unconnected bits has no effect and reading those unconnected bits returns no meaningful data. Note: The default reset value for the GPIOAFSEL register is 0x0000.0000 for all GPIO pins, with the exception of the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). These five pins default to JTAG functionality. Because of this, the default reset value of GPIOAFSEL for GPIO Port B is 0x0000.0080 while the default reset value for Port C is 0x0000.000F. Table 8-3. GPIO Register Map Offset 0x000 0x400 0x404 0x408 0x40C 0x410 0x414 0x418 0x41C 0x420 0x500 0x504 0x508 0x50C 0x510 0x514 0x518 0x51C 0xFD0 0xFD4 0xFD8 0xFDC 0xFE0 0xFE4 0xFE8 0xFEC 0xFF0 Name GPIODATA GPIODIR GPIOIS GPIOIBE GPIOIEV GPIOIM GPIORIS GPIOMIS GPIOICR GPIOAFSEL GPIODR2R GPIODR4R GPIODR8R GPIOODR GPIOPUR GPIOPDR GPIOSLR GPIODEN GPIOPeriphID4 GPIOPeriphID5 GPIOPeriphID6 GPIOPeriphID7 GPIOPeriphID0 GPIOPeriphID1 GPIOPeriphID2 GPIOPeriphID3 GPIOPCellID0 Type R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO RO W1C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.00FF 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.00FF 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.00FF 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0061 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0018 0x0000.0001 0x0000.000D Description GPIO Data GPIO Direction GPIO Interrupt Sense GPIO Interrupt Both Edges GPIO Interrupt Event GPIO Interrupt Mask GPIO Raw Interrupt Status GPIO Masked Interrupt Status GPIO Interrupt Clear GPIO Alternate Function Select GPIO 2-mA Drive Select GPIO 4-mA Drive Select GPIO 8-mA Drive Select GPIO Open Drain Select GPIO Pull-Up Select GPIO Pull-Down Select GPIO Slew Rate Control Select GPIO Digital Enable GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 See page 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 135 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Offset 0xFF4 0xFF8 0xFFC Name GPIOPCellID1 GPIOPCellID2 GPIOPCellID3 Type RO RO RO Reset 0x0000.00F0 0x0000.0005 0x0000.00B1 Description GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 See page 165 166 167 8.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the GPIO registers, in numerical order by address offset. 136 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: GPIO Data (GPIODATA), offset 0x000 The GPIODATA register is the data register. In software control mode, values written in the GPIODATA register are transferred onto the GPIO port pins if the respective pins have been configured as outputs through the GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) register (see page 138). In order to write to GPIODATA, the corresponding bits in the mask, resulting from the address bus bits [9:2], must be High. Otherwise, the bit values remain unchanged by the write. Similarly, the values read from this register are determined for each bit by the mask bit derived from the address used to access the data register, bits [9:2]. Bits that are 1 in the address mask cause the corresponding bits in GPIODATA to be read, and bits that are 0 in the address mask cause the corresponding bits in GPIODATA to be read as 0, regardless of their value. A read from GPIODATA returns the last bit value written if the respective pins are configured as outputs, or it returns the value on the corresponding input pin when these are configured as inputs. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Data (GPIODATA) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DATA RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Data This register is virtually mapped to 256 locations in the address space. To facilitate the reading and writing of data to these registers by independent drivers, the data read from and the data written to the registers are masked by the eight address lines ipaddr[9:2]. Reads from this register return its current state. Writes to this register only affect bits that are not masked by ipaddr[9:2] and are configured as outputs. See “Data Register Operation” on page 131 for examples of reads and writes. 7:0 DATA R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 137 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 2: GPIO Direction (GPIODIR), offset 0x400 The GPIODIR register is the data direction register. Bits set to 1 in the GPIODIR register configure the corresponding pin to be an output, while bits set to 0 configure the pins to be inputs. All bits are cleared by a reset, meaning all GPIO pins are inputs by default. GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x400 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DIR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Data Direction The DIR values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Pins are inputs. Pins are outputs. 7:0 DIR R/W 0x00 138 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS), offset 0x404 The GPIOIS register is the interrupt sense register. Bits set to 1 in GPIOIS configure the corresponding pins to detect levels, while bits set to 0 configure the pins to detect edges. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x404 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 IS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Sense The IS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Edge on corresponding pin is detected (edge-sensitive). Level on corresponding pin is detected (level-sensitive). 7:0 IS R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 139 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 4: GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE), offset 0x408 The GPIOIBE register is the interrupt both-edges register. When the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 139) is set to detect edges, bits set to High in GPIOIBE configure the corresponding pin to detect both rising and falling edges, regardless of the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 141). Clearing a bit configures the pin to be controlled by GPIOIEV. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x408 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 IBE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Both Edges The IBE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt generation is controlled by the GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 141). Both edges on the corresponding pin trigger an interrupt. Note: Single edge is determined by the corresponding bit in GPIOIEV. 7:0 IBE R/W 0x00 140 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 5: GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV), offset 0x40C The GPIOIEV register is the interrupt event register. Bits set to High in GPIOIEV configure the corresponding pin to detect rising edges or high levels, depending on the corresponding bit value in the GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 139). Clearing a bit configures the pin to detect falling edges or low levels, depending on the corresponding bit value in GPIOIS. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x40C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 IEV RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Event The IEV values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Falling edge or Low levels on corresponding pins trigger interrupts. Rising edge or High levels on corresponding pins trigger interrupts. 7:0 IEV R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 141 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 6: GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM), offset 0x410 The GPIOIM register is the interrupt mask register. Bits set to High in GPIOIM allow the corresponding pins to trigger their individual interrupts and the combined GPIOINTR line. Clearing a bit disables interrupt triggering on that pin. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x410 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 IME RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Mask Enable The IME values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Corresponding pin interrupt is masked. Corresponding pin interrupt is not masked. 7:0 IME R/W 0x00 142 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS), offset 0x414 The GPIORIS register is the raw interrupt status register. Bits read High in GPIORIS reflect the status of interrupt trigger conditions detected (raw, prior to masking), indicating that all the requirements have been met, before they are finally allowed to trigger by the GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) register (see page 142). Bits read as zero indicate that corresponding input pins have not initiated an interrupt. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x414 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Raw Status Reflects the status of interrupt trigger condition detection on pins (raw, prior to masking). The RIS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Corresponding pin interrupt requirements not met. Corresponding pin interrupt has met requirements. 7:0 RIS RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 143 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 8: GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS), offset 0x418 The GPIOMIS register is the masked interrupt status register. Bits read High in GPIOMIS reflect the status of input lines triggering an interrupt. Bits read as Low indicate that either no interrupt has been generated, or the interrupt is masked. GPIOMIS is the state of the interrupt after masking. GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x418 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 MIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Masked Interrupt Status Masked value of interrupt due to corresponding pin. The MIS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Corresponding GPIO line interrupt not active. Corresponding GPIO line asserting interrupt. 7:0 MIS RO 0x00 144 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR), offset 0x41C The GPIOICR register is the interrupt clear register. Writing a 1 to a bit in this register clears the corresponding interrupt edge detection logic register. Writing a 0 has no effect. GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x41C Type W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 IC RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Clear The IC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Corresponding interrupt is unaffected. Corresponding interrupt is cleared. 7:0 IC W1C 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 145 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 10: GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL), offset 0x420 The GPIOAFSEL register is the mode control select register. Writing a 1 to any bit in this register selects the hardware control for the corresponding GPIO line. All bits are cleared by a reset, therefore no GPIO line is set to hardware control by default. Important: All GPIO pins are inputs by default (GPIODIR=0 and GPIOAFSEL=0), with the exception of the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). The JTAG pins default to their JTAG functionality (GPIOAFSEL=1). A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting an external reset (RST) puts both groups of pins back to their default state. Caution – If the JTAG pins are used as GPIOs in a design, PB7 and PC2 cannot have external pull-down resistors connected to both of them at the same time. If both pins are pulled Low during reset, the controller has unpredictable behavior. If this happens, remove one or both of the pull-down resistors, and apply RST or power-cycle the part. In addition, it is possible to create a software sequence that prevents the debugger from connecting to the Stellaris® microcontroller. If the program code loaded into flash immediately changes the JTAG pins to their GPIO functionality, the debugger may not have enough time to connect and halt the controller before the JTAG pin functionality switches. This may lock the debugger out of the part. This can be avoided with a software routine that restores JTAG functionality based on an external or software trigger. GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x420 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 AFSEL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 146 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 7:0 Name AFSEL Type R/W Reset - Description GPIO Alternate Function Select The AFSEL values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Software control of corresponding GPIO line (GPIO mode). Hardware control of corresponding GPIO line (alternate hardware function). Note: The default reset value for the GPIOAFSEL register is 0x0000.0000 for all GPIO pins, with the exception of the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). These five pins default to JTAG functionality. Because of this, the default reset value of GPIOAFSEL for GPIO Port B is 0x0000.0080 while the default reset value for Port C is 0x0000.000F. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 147 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 11: GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R), offset 0x500 The GPIODR2R register is the 2-mA drive control register. It allows for each GPIO signal in the port to be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When writing a DRV2 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV4 bit in the GPIODR4R register and the DRV8 bit in the GPIODR8R register are automatically cleared by hardware. GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x500 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DRV2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 2-mA Drive Enable A write of 1 to either GPIODR4[n] or GPIODR8[n] clears the corresponding 2-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write. 7:0 DRV2 R/W 0xFF 148 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 12: GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R), offset 0x504 The GPIODR4R register is the 4-mA drive control register. It allows for each GPIO signal in the port to be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When writing the DRV4 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV2 bit in the GPIODR2R register and the DRV8 bit in the GPIODR8R register are automatically cleared by hardware. GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x504 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DRV4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 4-mA Drive Enable A write of 1 to either GPIODR2[n] or GPIODR8[n] clears the corresponding 4-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write. 7:0 DRV4 R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 149 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 13: GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R), offset 0x508 The GPIODR8R register is the 8-mA drive control register. It allows for each GPIO signal in the port to be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When writing the DRV8 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV2 bit in the GPIODR2R register and the DRV4 bit in the GPIODR4R register are automatically cleared by hardware. GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x508 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DRV8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 8-mA Drive Enable A write of 1 to either GPIODR2[n] or GPIODR4[n] clears the corresponding 8-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write. 7:0 DRV8 R/W 0x00 150 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 14: GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR), offset 0x50C The GPIOODR register is the open drain control register. Setting a bit in this register enables the open drain configuration of the corresponding GPIO pad. When open drain mode is enabled, the corresponding bit should also be set in the GPIO Digital Input Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 155). Corresponding bits in the drive strength registers (GPIODR2R, GPIODR4R, GPIODR8R, and GPIOSLR ) can be set to achieve the desired rise and fall times. The GPIO acts as an open drain input if the corresponding bit in the GPIODIR register is set to 0; and as an open drain output when set to 1. When using the I2C module, the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register bit for PB2 and PB3 should be set to 1 (see examples in “Initialization and Configuration” on page 133). GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x50C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 ODE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad Open Drain Enable The ODE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Open drain configuration is disabled. Open drain configuration is enabled. 7:0 ODE R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 151 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 15: GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR), offset 0x510 The GPIOPUR register is the pull-up control register. When a bit is set to 1, it enables a weak pull-up resistor on the corresponding GPIO signal. Setting a bit in GPIOPUR automatically clears the corresponding bit in the GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 153). GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x510 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PUE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Pad Weak Pull-Up Enable A write of 1 to GPIOPDR[n] clears the corresponding GPIOPUR[n] enables. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write. 7:0 PUE R/W 0xFF 152 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 16: GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR), offset 0x514 The GPIOPDR register is the pull-down control register. When a bit is set to 1, it enables a weak pull-down resistor on the corresponding GPIO signal. Setting a bit in GPIOPDR automatically clears the corresponding bit in the GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 152). GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x514 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PDE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Pad Weak Pull-Down Enable A write of 1 to GPIOPUR[n] clears the corresponding GPIOPDR[n] enables. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write. 7:0 PDE R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 153 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 17: GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR), offset 0x518 The GPIOSLR register is the slew rate control register. Slew rate control is only available when using the 8-mA drive strength option via the GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R) register (see page 150). GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x518 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SRL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Slew Rate Limit Enable (8-mA drive only) The SRL values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Slew rate control disabled. Slew rate control enabled. 7:0 SRL R/W 0x00 154 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 18: GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN), offset 0x51C The GPIODEN register is the digital input enable register. By default, all GPIO signals are configured as digital inputs at reset. If a pin is being used as a GPIO or its Alternate Hardware Function, it should be configured as a digital input. The only time that a pin should not be configured as a digital input is when the GPIO pin is configured to be one of the analog input signals for the analog comparators. GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0x51C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DEN RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Digital Enable The DEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Digital functions disabled. Digital functions enabled. 7:0 DEN R/W 0xFF October 01, 2007 Preliminary 155 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 19: GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[7:0] 7:0 PID4 RO 0x00 156 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 20: GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFD4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[15:8] 7:0 PID5 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 157 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 21: GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFD8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID6 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[23:16] 7:0 PID6 RO 0x00 158 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 22: GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFDC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID7 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[31:24] 7:0 PID7 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 159 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 23: GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0061 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID0 RO 0x61 160 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 24: GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID1 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 161 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 25: GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID2 RO 0x18 162 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 26: GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register[31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID3 RO 0x01 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 163 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 27: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register[7:0] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D 164 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 28: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register[15:8] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 165 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 29: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register[23:16] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 166 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 30: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3), offset 0xFFC The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register[31:24] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 167 General-Purpose Timers 9 General-Purpose Timers Programmable timers can be used to count or time external events that drive the Timer input pins. ® The Stellaris General-Purpose Timer Module (GPTM) contains three GPTM blocks (Timer0, Timer1, and Timer 2). Each GPTM block provides two 16-bit timer/counters (referred to as TimerA and TimerB) that can be configured to operate independently as timers or event counters, or configured to operate as one 32-bit timer or one 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC). Note: Timer2 is an internal timer and can only be used to generate internal interrupts. ® The General-Purpose Timer Module is one timing resource available on the Stellaris microcontrollers. Other timer resources include the System Timer (SysTick) (see “System Timer (SysTick)” on page 37) and the PWM timer in the PWM module (see “PWM Timer” on page 350). The following modes are supported: ■ 32-bit Timer modes – Programmable one-shot timer – Programmable periodic timer – Real-Time Clock using 32.768-KHz input clock – Software-controlled event stalling (excluding RTC mode) ■ 16-bit Timer modes – General-purpose timer function with an 8-bit prescaler (for one-shot and periodic modes only) – Programmable one-shot timer – Programmable periodic timer – Software-controlled event stalling ■ 16-bit Input Capture modes – Input edge count capture – Input edge time capture ■ 16-bit PWM mode – Simple PWM mode with software-programmable output inversion of the PWM signal 168 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 9.1 Block Diagram Figure 9-1. GPTM Module Block Diagram 0x0000 (Down Counter Modes) TimerA Control GPTMTAPMR GPTMTAPR GPTMTAMATCHR Interrupt / Config TimerA Interrupt GPTMCFG GPTMCTL GPTMIMR TimerB Interrupt GPTMRIS GPTMMIS GPTMICR GPTMTBPMR GPTMTBPR GPTMTBMATCHR GPTMTBILR GPTMTBMR TB Comparator TimerB Control GPTMTBR En Clock / Edge Detect CCP (odd) RTC Divider GPTMTAILR GPTMTAMR GPTMAR En Clock / Edge Detect TA Comparator CCP (even) 0x0000 (Down Counter Modes) System Clock 9.2 Functional Description The main components of each GPTM block are two free-running 16-bit up/down counters (referred to as TimerA and TimerB), two 16-bit match registers, two prescaler match registers, and two 16-bit load/initialization registers and their associated control functions. The exact functionality of each GPTM is controlled by software and configured through the register interface. Software configures the GPTM using the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register (see page 180), the GPTM TimerA Mode (GPTMTAMR) register (see page 181), and the GPTM TimerB Mode (GPTMTBMR) register (see page 183). When in one of the 32-bit modes, the timer can only act as a 32-bit timer. However, when configured in 16-bit mode, the GPTM can have its two 16-bit timers configured in any combination of the 16-bit modes. 9.2.1 GPTM Reset Conditions After reset has been applied to the GPTM module, the module is in an inactive state, and all control registers are cleared and in their default states. Counters TimerA and TimerB are initialized to 0xFFFF, along with their corresponding load registers: the GPTM TimerA Interval Load (GPTMTAILR) register (see page 194) and the GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR) register (see page 195). The prescale counters are initialized to 0x00: the GPTM TimerA Prescale (GPTMTAPR) register (see page 198) and the GPTM TimerB Prescale (GPTMTBPR) register (see page 199). 9.2.2 32-Bit Timer Operating Modes Note: Both the odd- and even-numbered CCP pins are used for 16-bit mode. Only the even-numbered CCP pins are used for 32-bit mode. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 169 General-Purpose Timers This section describes the three GPTM 32-bit timer modes (One-Shot, Periodic, and RTC) and their configuration. The GPTM is placed into 32-bit mode by writing a 0 (One-Shot/Periodic 32-bit timer mode) or a 1 (RTC mode) to the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register. In both configurations, certain GPTM registers are concatenated to form pseudo 32-bit registers. These registers include: ■ GPTM TimerA Interval Load (GPTMTAILR) register [15:0], see page 194 ■ GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR) register [15:0], see page 195 ■ GPTM TimerA (GPTMTAR) register [15:0], see page 202 ■ GPTM TimerB (GPTMTBR) register [15:0], see page 203 In the 32-bit modes, the GPTM translates a 32-bit write access to GPTMTAILR into a write access to both GPTMTAILR and GPTMTBILR. The resulting word ordering for such a write operation is: GPTMTBILR[15:0]:GPTMTAILR[15:0] Likewise, a read access to GPTMTAR returns the value: GPTMTBR[15:0]:GPTMTAR[15:0] 9.2.2.1 32-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode In 32-bit one-shot and periodic timer modes, the concatenated versions of the TimerA and TimerB registers are configured as a 32-bit down-counter. The selection of one-shot or periodic mode is determined by the value written to the TAMR field of the GPTM TimerA Mode (GPTMTAMR) register (see page 181), and there is no need to write to the GPTM TimerB Mode (GPTMTBMR) register. When software writes the TAEN bit in the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register (see page 185), the timer begins counting down from its preloaded value. Once the 0x0000.0000 state is reached, the timer reloads its start value from the concatenated GPTMTAILR on the next cycle. If configured to be a one-shot timer, the timer stops counting and clears the TAEN bit in the GPTMCTL register. If configured as a periodic timer, it continues counting. In addition to reloading the count value, the GPTM generates interrupts and output triggers when it reaches the 0x0000000 state. The GPTM sets the TATORIS bit in the GPTM Raw Interrupt Status (GPTMRIS) register (see page 190), and holds it until it is cleared by writing the GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR) register (see page 192). If the time-out interrupt is enabled in the GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTIMR) register (see page 188), the GPTM also sets the TATOMIS bit in the GPTM Masked Interrupt Status (GPTMMIS) register (see page 191). The output trigger is a one-clock-cycle pulse that is asserted when the counter hits the 0x0000.0000 state, and deasserted on the following clock cycle. It is enabled by setting the TAOTE bit in GPTMCTL. If software reloads the GPTMTAILR register while the counter is running, the counter loads the new value on the next clock cycle and continues counting from the new value. If the TASTALL bit in the GPTMCTL register is asserted, the timer freezes counting until the signal is deasserted. 9.2.2.2 32-Bit Real-Time Clock Timer Mode In Real-Time Clock (RTC) mode, the concatenated versions of the TimerA and TimerB registers are configured as a 32-bit up-counter. When RTC mode is selected for the first time, the counter is 170 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller loaded with a value of 0x0000.0001. All subsequent load values must be written to the GPTM TimerA Match (GPTMTAMATCHR) register (see page 196) by the controller. The input clock on the CCP0, CCP2, or CCP4 pins is required to be 32.768 KHz in RTC mode. The clock signal is then divided down to a 1 Hz rate and is passed along to the input of the 32-bit counter. When software writes the TAEN bit inthe GPTMCTL register, the counter starts counting up from its preloaded value of 0x0000.0001. When the current count value matches the preloaded value in the GPTMTAMATCHR register, it rolls over to a value of 0x0000.0000 and continues counting until either a hardware reset, or it is disabled by software (clearing the TAEN bit). When a match occurs, the GPTM asserts the RTCRIS bit in GPTMRIS. If the RTC interrupt is enabled in GPTIMR, the GPTM also sets the RTCMIS bit in GPTMISR and generates a controller interrupt. The status flags are cleared by writing the RTCCINT bit in GPTMICR. If the TASTALL and/or TBSTALL bits in the GPTMCTL register are set, the timer does not freeze if the RTCEN bit is set in GPTMCTL. 9.2.3 16-Bit Timer Operating Modes The GPTM is placed into global 16-bit mode by writing a value of 0x4 to the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register (see page 180). This section describes each of the GPTM 16-bit modes of operation. TimerA and TimerB have identical modes, so a single description is given using an n to reference both. 9.2.3.1 16-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode In 16-bit one-shot and periodic timer modes, the timer is configured as a 16-bit down-counter with an optional 8-bit prescaler that effectively extends the counting range of the timer to 24 bits. The selection of one-shot or periodic mode is determined by the value written to the TnMR field of the GPTMTnMR register. The optional prescaler is loaded into the GPTM Timern Prescale (GPTMTnPR) register. When software writes the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register, the timer begins counting down from its preloaded value. Once the 0x0000 state is reached, the timer reloads its start value from GPTMTnILR and GPTMTnPR on the next cycle. If configured to be a one-shot timer, the timer stops counting and clears the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register. If configured as a periodic timer, it continues counting. In addition to reloading the count value, the timer generates interrupts and output triggers when it reaches the 0x0000 state. The GPTM sets the TnTORIS bit in the GPTMRIS register, and holds it until it is cleared by writing the GPTMICR register. If the time-out interrupt is enabled in GPTIMR, the GPTM also sets the TnTOMIS bit in GPTMISR and generates a controller interrupt. The output trigger is a one-clock-cycle pulse that is asserted when the counter hits the 0x0000 state, and deasserted on the following clock cycle. It is enabled by setting the TnOTE bit in the GPTMCTL register, and can trigger SoC-level events. If software reloads the GPTMTAILR register while the counter is running, the counter loads the new value on the next clock cycle and continues counting from the new value. If the TnSTALL bit in the GPTMCTL register is enabled, the timer freezes counting until the signal is deasserted. The following example shows a variety of configurations for a 16-bit free running timer while using the prescaler. All values assume a 50-MHz clock with Tc=20 ns (clock period). October 01, 2007 Preliminary 171 General-Purpose Timers Table 9-1. 16-Bit Timer With Prescaler Configurations Prescale #Clock (T c) Max Time Units 00000000 00000001 00000010 -----------11111100 11111110 11111111 1 2 3 -254 255 256 1.3107 2.6214 3.9321 -332.9229 334.2336 335.5443 mS mS mS -mS mS mS a a. Tc is the clock period. 9.2.3.2 16-Bit Input Edge Count Mode In Edge Count mode, the timer is configured as a down-counter capable of capturing three types of events: rising edge, falling edge, or both. To place the timer in Edge Count mode, the TnCMR bit of the GPTMTnMR register must be set to 0. The type of edge that the timer counts is determined by the TnEVENT fields of the GPTMCTL register. During initialization, the GPTM Timern Match (GPTMTnMATCHR) register is configured so that the difference between the value in the GPTMTnILR register and the GPTMTnMATCHR register equals the number of edge events that must be counted. When software writes the TnEN bit in the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register, the timer is enabled for event capture. Each input event on the CCP pin decrements the counter by 1 until the event count matches GPTMTnMATCHR. When the counts match, the GPTM asserts the CnMRIS bit in the GPTMRIS register (and the CnMMIS bit, if the interrupt is not masked). The counter is then reloaded using the value in GPTMTnILR, and stopped since the GPTM automatically clears the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register. Once the event count has been reached, all further events are ignored until TnEN is re-enabled by software. Figure 9-2 on page 173 shows how input edge count mode works. In this case, the timer start value is set to GPTMnILR =0x000A and the match value is set to GPTMnMATCHR =0x0006 so that four edge events are counted. The counter is configured to detect both edges of the input signal. Note that the last two edges are not counted since the timer automatically clears the TnEN bit after the current count matches the value in the GPTMnMR register. 172 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 9-2. 16-Bit Input Edge Count Mode Example Timer reload on next cycle Ignored Ignored Count 0x000A 0x0009 0x0008 0x0007 0x0006 Timer stops, flags asserted Input Signal 9.2.3.3 16-Bit Input Edge Time Mode Note: The prescaler is not available in 16-Bit Input Edge Time mode. In Edge Time mode, the timer is configured as a free-running down-counter initialized to the value loaded in the GPTMTnILR register (or 0xFFFF at reset). This mode allows for event capture of both rising and falling edges. The timer is placed into Edge Time mode by setting the TnCMR bit in the GPTMTnMR register, and the type of event that the timer captures is determined by the TnEVENT fields of the GPTMCnTL register. When software writes the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register, the timer is enabled for event capture. When the selected input event is detected, the current Tn counter value is captured in the GPTMTnR register and is available to be read by the controller. The GPTM then asserts the CnERIS bit (and the CnEMIS bit, if the interrupt is not masked). After an event has been captured, the timer does not stop counting. It continues to count until the TnEN bit is cleared. When the timer reaches the 0x0000 state, it is reloaded with the value from the GPTMnILR register. Figure 9-3 on page 174 shows how input edge timing mode works. In the diagram, it is assumed that the start value of the timer is the default value of 0xFFFF, and the timer is configured to capture rising edge events. Each time a rising edge event is detected, the current count value is loaded into the GPTMTnR register, and is held there until another rising edge is detected (at which point the new count value is loaded into GPTMTnR). October 01, 2007 Preliminary 173 General-Purpose Timers Figure 9-3. 16-Bit Input Edge Time Mode Example Count 0xFFFF GPTMTnR=X GPTMTnR=Y GPTMTnR=Z Z X Y Time Input Signal 9.2.3.4 16-Bit PWM Mode The GPTM supports a simple PWM generation mode. In PWM mode, the timer is configured as a down-counter with a start value (and thus period) defined by GPTMTnILR. PWM mode is enabled with the GPTMTnMR register by setting the TnAMS bit to 0x1, the TnCMR bit to 0x0, and the TnMR field to 0x2. When software writes the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register, the counter begins counting down until it reaches the 0x0000 state. On the next counter cycle, the counter reloads its start value from GPTMTnILR (and GPTMTnPR if using a prescaler) and continues counting until disabled by software clearing the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register. No interrupts or status bits are asserted in PWM mode. The output PWM signal asserts when the counter is at the value of the GPTMTnILR register (its start state), and is deasserted when the counter value equals the value in the GPTM Timern Match Register (GPTMnMATCHR). Software has the capability of inverting the output PWM signal by setting the TnPWML bit in the GPTMCTL register. Figure 9-4 on page 175 shows how to generate an output PWM with a 1-ms period and a 66% duty cycle assuming a 50-MHz input clock and TnPWML =0 (duty cycle would be 33% for the TnPWML =1 configuration). For this example, the start value is GPTMnIRL=0xC350 and the match value is GPTMnMR=0x411A. 174 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 9-4. 16-Bit PWM Mode Example Count 0xC350 GPTMTnR=GPTMnMR GPTMTnR=GPTMnMR 0x411A Time TnEN set TnPWML = 0 Output Signal TnPWML = 1 9.3 Initialization and Configuration To use the general-purpose timers, the peripheral clock must be enabled by setting the TIMER0, TIMER1, and TIMER2 bits in the RCGC1 register. This section shows module initialization and configuration examples for each of the supported timer modes. 9.3.1 32-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode The GPTM is configured for 32-bit One-Shot and Periodic modes by the following sequence: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TAEN bit in the GPTMCTL register is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration Register (GPTMCFG) with a value of 0x0. 3. Set the TAMR field in the GPTM TimerA Mode Register (GPTMTAMR): a. Write a value of 0x1 for One-Shot mode. b. Write a value of 0x2 for Periodic mode. 4. Load the start value into the GPTM TimerA Interval Load Register (GPTMTAILR). 5. If interrupts are required, set the TATOIM bit in the GPTM Interrupt Mask Register (GPTMIMR). 6. Set the TAEN bit in the GPTMCTL register to enable the timer and start counting. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 175 General-Purpose Timers 7. Poll the TATORIS bit in the GPTMRIS register or wait for the interrupt to be generated (if enabled). In both cases, the status flags are cleared by writing a 1 to the TATOCINT bit of the GPTM Interrupt Clear Register (GPTMICR). In One-Shot mode, the timer stops counting after step 7 on page 176. To re-enable the timer, repeat the sequence. A timer configured in Periodic mode does not stop counting after it times out. 9.3.2 32-Bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) Mode To use the RTC mode, the timer must have a 32.768-KHz input signal on its CCP0, CCP2, or CCP4 pins. To enable the RTC feature, follow these steps: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TAEN bit is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration Register (GPTMCFG) with a value of 0x1. 3. Write the desired match value to the GPTM TimerA Match Register (GPTMTAMATCHR). 4. Set/clear the RTCEN bit in the GPTM Control Register (GPTMCTL) as desired. 5. If interrupts are required, set the RTCIM bit in the GPTM Interrupt Mask Register (GPTMIMR). 6. Set the TAEN bit in the GPTMCTL register to enable the timer and start counting. When the timer count equals the value in the GPTMTAMATCHR register, the counter is re-loaded with 0x0000.0000 and begins counting. If an interrupt is enabled, it does not have to be cleared. 9.3.3 16-Bit One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode A timer is configured for 16-bit One-Shot and Periodic modes by the following sequence: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TnEN bit is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration Register (GPTMCFG) with a value of 0x4. 3. Set the TnMR field in the GPTM Timer Mode (GPTMTnMR) register: a. Write a value of 0x1 for One-Shot mode. b. Write a value of 0x2 for Periodic mode. 4. If a prescaler is to be used, write the prescale value to the GPTM Timern Prescale Register (GPTMTnPR). 5. Load the start value into the GPTM Timer Interval Load Register (GPTMTnILR). 6. If interrupts are required, set the TnTOIM bit in the GPTM Interrupt Mask Register (GPTMIMR). 7. Set the TnEN bit in the GPTM Control Register (GPTMCTL) to enable the timer and start counting. 8. Poll the TnTORIS bit in the GPTMRIS register or wait for the interrupt to be generated (if enabled). In both cases, the status flags are cleared by writing a 1 to the TnTOCINT bit of the GPTM Interrupt Clear Register (GPTMICR). 176 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller In One-Shot mode, the timer stops counting after step 8 on page 176. To re-enable the timer, repeat the sequence. A timer configured in Periodic mode does not stop counting after it times out. 9.3.4 16-Bit Input Edge Count Mode A timer is configured to Input Edge Count mode by the following sequence: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TnEN bit is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register with a value of 0x4. 3. In the GPTM Timer Mode (GPTMTnMR) register, write the TnCMR field to 0x0 and the TnMR field to 0x3. 4. Configure the type of event(s) that the timer captures by writing the TnEVENT field of the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register. 5. Load the timer start value into the GPTM Timern Interval Load (GPTMTnILR) register. 6. Load the desired event count into the GPTM Timern Match (GPTMTnMATCHR) register. 7. If interrupts are required, set the CnMIM bit in the GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR) register. 8. Set the TnEN bit in the GPTMCTL register to enable the timer and begin waiting for edge events. 9. Poll the CnMRIS bit in the GPTMRIS register or wait for the interrupt to be generated (if enabled). In both cases, the status flags are cleared by writing a 1 to the CnMCINT bit of the GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR) register. In Input Edge Count Mode, the timer stops after the desired number of edge events has been detected. To re-enable the timer, ensure that the TnEN bit is cleared and repeat step 4 on page 177-step 9 on page 177. 9.3.5 16-Bit Input Edge Timing Mode A timer is configured to Input Edge Timing mode by the following sequence: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TnEN bit is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register with a value of 0x4. 3. In the GPTM Timer Mode (GPTMTnMR) register, write the TnCMR field to 0x1 and the TnMR field to 0x3. 4. Configure the type of event that the timer captures by writing the TnEVENT field of the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register. 5. Load the timer start value into the GPTM Timern Interval Load (GPTMTnILR) register. 6. If interrupts are required, set the CnEIM bit in the GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR) register. 7. Set the TnEN bit in the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register to enable the timer and start counting. 8. Poll the CnERIS bit in the GPTMRIS register or wait for the interrupt to be generated (if enabled). In both cases, the status flags are cleared by writing a 1 to the CnECINT bit of the GPTM October 01, 2007 Preliminary 177 General-Purpose Timers Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR) register. The time at which the event happened can be obtained by reading the GPTM Timern (GPTMTnR) register. In Input Edge Timing mode, the timer continues running after an edge event has been detected, but the timer interval can be changed at any time by writing the GPTMTnILR register. The change takes effect at the next cycle after the write. 9.3.6 16-Bit PWM Mode A timer is configured to PWM mode using the following sequence: 1. Ensure the timer is disabled (the TnEN bit is cleared) before making any changes. 2. Write the GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) register with a value of 0x4. 3. In the GPTM Timer Mode (GPTMTnMR) register, set the TnAMS bit to 0x1, the TnCMR bit to 0x0, and the TnMR field to 0x2. 4. Configure the output state of the PWM signal (whether or not it is inverted) in the TnEVENT field of the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register. 5. Load the timer start value into the GPTM Timern Interval Load (GPTMTnILR) register. 6. Load the GPTM Timern Match (GPTMTnMATCHR) register with the desired value. 7. If a prescaler is going to be used, configure the GPTM Timern Prescale (GPTMTnPR) register and the GPTM Timern Prescale Match (GPTMTnPMR) register. 8. Set the TnEN bit in the GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) register to enable the timer and begin generation of the output PWM signal. In PWM Timing mode, the timer continues running after the PWM signal has been generated. The PWM period can be adjusted at any time by writing the GPTMTnILR register, and the change takes effect at the next cycle after the write. 9.4 Register Map Table 9-2 on page 178 lists the GPTM registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to that timer ’s base address: ■ Timer0: 0x4003.0000 ■ Timer1: 0x4003.1000 ■ Timer2: 0x4003.2000 Table 9-2. Timers Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 Name GPTMCFG GPTMTAMR GPTMTBMR Type R/W R/W R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description GPTM Configuration GPTM TimerA Mode GPTM TimerB Mode See page 180 181 183 178 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Offset 0x00C 0x018 0x01C 0x020 0x024 Name GPTMCTL GPTMIMR GPTMRIS GPTMMIS GPTMICR Type R/W R/W RO RO W1C Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 0x0000.FFFF 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 0x0000.FFFF 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 0x0000.FFFF Description GPTM Control GPTM Interrupt Mask GPTM Raw Interrupt Status GPTM Masked Interrupt Status GPTM Interrupt Clear See page 185 188 190 191 192 0x028 GPTMTAILR R/W GPTM TimerA Interval Load 194 0x02C GPTMTBILR R/W GPTM TimerB Interval Load 195 0x030 GPTMTAMATCHR R/W GPTM TimerA Match 196 0x034 0x038 0x03C 0x040 0x044 GPTMTBMATCHR GPTMTAPR GPTMTBPR GPTMTAPMR GPTMTBPMR R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W GPTM TimerB Match GPTM TimerA Prescale GPTM TimerB Prescale GPTM TimerA Prescale Match GPTM TimerB Prescale Match 197 198 199 200 201 0x048 GPTMTAR RO GPTM TimerA 202 0x04C GPTMTBR RO GPTM TimerB 203 9.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the GPTM registers, in numerical order by address offset. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 179 General-Purpose Timers Register 1: GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG), offset 0x000 This register configures the global operation of the GPTM module. The value written to this register determines whether the GPTM is in 32- or 16-bit mode. GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 GPTMCFG R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM Configuration The GPTMCFG values are defined as follows: Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Description 32-bit timer configuration. 32-bit real-time clock (RTC) counter configuration. Reserved. Reserved. 2:0 GPTMCFG R/W 0x0 0x4-0x7 16-bit timer configuration, function is controlled by bits 1:0 of GPTMTAMR and GPTMTBMR. 180 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: GPTM TimerA Mode (GPTMTAMR), offset 0x004 This register configures the GPTM based on the configuration selected in the GPTMCFG register. When in 16-bit PWM mode, set the TAAMS bit to 0x1, the TACMR bit to 0x0, and the TAMR field to 0x2. GPTM TimerA Mode (GPTMTAMR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 TAAMS R/W 0 RO 0 2 TACMR R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 1 TAMR R/W 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerA Alternate Mode Select The TAAMS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Capture mode is enabled. PWM mode is enabled. Note: To enable PWM mode, you must also clear the TACMR bit and set the TAMR field to 0x2. 3 TAAMS R/W 0 2 TACMR R/W 0 GPTM TimerA Capture Mode The TACMR values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Edge-Count mode. Edge-Time mode. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 181 General-Purpose Timers Bit/Field 1:0 Name TAMR Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description GPTM TimerA Mode The TAMR values are defined as follows: Value Description 0x0 Reserved. 0x1 One-Shot Timer mode. 0x2 Periodic Timer mode. 0x3 Capture mode. The Timer mode is based on the timer configuration defined by bits 2:0 in the GPTMCFG register (16-or 32-bit). In 16-bit timer configuration, TAMR controls the 16-bit timer modes for TimerA. In 32-bit timer configuration, this register controls the mode and the contents of GPTMTBMR are ignored. 182 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: GPTM TimerB Mode (GPTMTBMR), offset 0x008 This register configures the GPTM based on the configuration selected in the GPTMCFG register. When in 16-bit PWM mode, set the TBAMS bit to 0x1, the TBCMR bit to 0x0, and the TBMR field to 0x2. GPTM TimerB Mode (GPTMTBMR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 TBAMS R/W 0 RO 0 2 TBCMR R/W 0 RO 0 1 TBMR R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Alternate Mode Select The TBAMS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Capture mode is enabled. PWM mode is enabled. Note: To enable PWM mode, you must also clear the TBCMR bit and set the TBMR field to 0x2. 3 TBAMS R/W 0 2 TBCMR R/W 0 GPTM TimerB Capture Mode The TBCMR values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Edge-Count mode. Edge-Time mode. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 183 General-Purpose Timers Bit/Field 1:0 Name TBMR Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description GPTM TimerB Mode The TBMR values are defined as follows: Value Description 0x0 Reserved. 0x1 One-Shot Timer mode. 0x2 Periodic Timer mode. 0x3 Capture mode. The timer mode is based on the timer configuration defined by bits 2:0 in the GPTMCFG register. In 16-bit timer configuration, these bits control the 16-bit timer modes for TimerB. In 32-bit timer configuration, this register ’s contents are ignored and GPTMTAMR is used. 184 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: GPTM Control (GPTMCTL), offset 0x00C This register is used alongside the GPTMCFG and GMTMTnMR registers to fine-tune the timer configuration, and to enable other features such as timer stall and the output trigger. GPTM Control (GPTMCTL) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 reserved RO 0 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 TBSTALL R/W 0 RO 0 8 TBEN R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 TAOTE R/W 0 RO 0 4 RTCEN R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 TASTALL R/W 0 RO 0 0 TAEN R/W 0 reserved TBPWML TBOTE Type Reset RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 TBEVENT R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved TAPWML RO 0 R/W 0 TAEVENT R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:15 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB PWM Output Level The TBPWML values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Output is unaffected. Output is inverted. 14 TBPWML R/W 0 13 TBOTE R/W 0 GPTM TimerB Output Trigger Enable The TBOTE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The output TimerB trigger is disabled. The output TimerB trigger is enabled. 12 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Event Mode The TBEVENT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0x0 Positive edge. 0x1 Negative edge. 0x2 Reserved 0x3 Both edges. 11:10 TBEVENT R/W 0x0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 185 General-Purpose Timers Bit/Field 9 Name TBSTALL Type R/W Reset 0 Description GPTM TimerB Stall Enable The TBSTALL values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 TimerB stalling is disabled. TimerB stalling is enabled. 8 TBEN R/W 0 GPTM TimerB Enable The TBEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 TimerB is disabled. TimerB is enabled and begins counting or the capture logic is enabled based on the GPTMCFG register. 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerA PWM Output Level The TAPWML values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Output is unaffected. Output is inverted. 6 TAPWML R/W 0 5 TAOTE R/W 0 GPTM TimerA Output Trigger Enable The TAOTE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The output TimerA trigger is disabled. The output TimerA trigger is enabled. 4 RTCEN R/W 0 GPTM RTC Enable The RTCEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 RTC counting is disabled. RTC counting is enabled. 186 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 3:2 Name TAEVENT Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description GPTM TimerA Event Mode The TAEVENT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0x0 Positive edge. 0x1 Negative edge. 0x2 Reserved 0x3 Both edges. 1 TASTALL R/W 0 GPTM TimerA Stall Enable The TASTALL values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 TimerA stalling is disabled. TimerA stalling is enabled. 0 TAEN R/W 0 GPTM TimerA Enable The TAEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 TimerA is disabled. TimerA is enabled and begins counting or the capture logic is enabled based on the GPTMCFG register. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 187 General-Purpose Timers Register 5: GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR), offset 0x018 This register allows software to enable/disable GPTM controller-level interrupts. Writing a 1 enables the interrupt, while writing a 0 disables it. GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x018 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 CBEIM R/W 0 RO 0 9 CBMIM R/W 0 RO 0 8 TBTOIM R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RTCIM R/W 0 RO 0 2 CAEIM R/W 0 RO 0 1 CAMIM R/W 0 RO 0 0 TATOIM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM CaptureB Event Interrupt Mask The CBEIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 10 CBEIM R/W 0 9 CBMIM R/W 0 GPTM CaptureB Match Interrupt Mask The CBMIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 8 TBTOIM R/W 0 GPTM TimerB Time-Out Interrupt Mask The TBTOIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 7:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 188 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 3 Name RTCIM Type R/W Reset 0 Description GPTM RTC Interrupt Mask The RTCIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 2 CAEIM R/W 0 GPTM CaptureA Event Interrupt Mask The CAEIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 1 CAMIM R/W 0 GPTM CaptureA Match Interrupt Mask The CAMIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. 0 TATOIM R/W 0 GPTM TimerA Time-Out Interrupt Mask The TATOIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt is disabled. Interrupt is enabled. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 189 General-Purpose Timers Register 6: GPTM Raw Interrupt Status (GPTMRIS), offset 0x01C This register shows the state of the GPTM's internal interrupt signal. These bits are set whether or not the interrupt is masked in the GPTMIMR register. Each bit can be cleared by writing a 1 to its corresponding bit in GPTMICR. GPTM Raw Interrupt Status (GPTMRIS) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RTCRIS RO 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 CBERIS CBMRIS TBTORIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CAERIS CAMRIS TATORIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM CaptureB Event Raw Interrupt This is the CaptureB Event interrupt status prior to masking. 10 CBERIS RO 0 9 CBMRIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureB Match Raw Interrupt This is the CaptureB Match interrupt status prior to masking. 8 TBTORIS RO 0 GPTM TimerB Time-Out Raw Interrupt This is the TimerB time-out interrupt status prior to masking. 7:4 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM RTC Raw Interrupt This is the RTC Event interrupt status prior to masking. 3 RTCRIS RO 0 2 CAERIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureA Event Raw Interrupt This is the CaptureA Event interrupt status prior to masking. 1 CAMRIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureA Match Raw Interrupt This is the CaptureA Match interrupt status prior to masking. 0 TATORIS RO 0 GPTM TimerA Time-Out Raw Interrupt This the TimerA time-out interrupt status prior to masking. 190 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: GPTM Masked Interrupt Status (GPTMMIS), offset 0x020 This register show the state of the GPTM's controller-level interrupt. If an interrupt is unmasked in GPTMIMR, and there is an event that causes the interrupt to be asserted, the corresponding bit is set in this register. All bits are cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in GPTMICR. GPTM Masked Interrupt Status (GPTMMIS) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x020 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 CBEMIS CBMMIS TBTOMIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RTCMIS CAEMIS CAMMIS TATOMIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM CaptureB Event Masked Interrupt This is the CaptureB event interrupt status after masking. 10 CBEMIS RO 0 9 CBMMIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureB Match Masked Interrupt This is the CaptureB match interrupt status after masking. 8 TBTOMIS RO 0 GPTM TimerB Time-Out Masked Interrupt This is the TimerB time-out interrupt status after masking. 7:4 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM RTC Masked Interrupt This is the RTC event interrupt status after masking. 3 RTCMIS RO 0 2 CAEMIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureA Event Masked Interrupt This is the CaptureA event interrupt status after masking. 1 CAMMIS RO 0 GPTM CaptureA Match Masked Interrupt This is the CaptureA match interrupt status after masking. 0 TATOMIS RO 0 GPTM TimerA Time-Out Masked Interrupt This is the TimerA time-out interrupt status after masking. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 191 General-Purpose Timers Register 8: GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR), offset 0x024 This register is used to clear the status bits in the GPTMRIS and GPTMMIS registers. Writing a 1 to a bit clears the corresponding bit in the GPTMRIS and GPTMMIS registers. GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x024 Type W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 CBECINT CBMCINT TBTOCINT W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 RTCCINT CAECINT CAMCINT TATOCINT W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM CaptureB Event Interrupt Clear The CBECINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. 10 CBECINT W1C 0 9 CBMCINT W1C 0 GPTM CaptureB Match Interrupt Clear The CBMCINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. 8 TBTOCINT W1C 0 GPTM TimerB Time-Out Interrupt Clear The TBTOCINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. 7:4 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 192 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 3 Name RTCCINT Type W1C Reset 0 Description GPTM RTC Interrupt Clear The RTCCINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. 2 CAECINT W1C 0 GPTM CaptureA Event Interrupt Clear The CAECINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. 1 CAMCINT W1C 0 GPTM CaptureA Match Raw Interrupt This is the CaptureA match interrupt status after masking. 0 TATOCINT W1C 0 GPTM TimerA Time-Out Raw Interrupt The TATOCINT values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 The interrupt is unaffected. The interrupt is cleared. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 193 General-Purpose Timers Register 9: GPTM TimerA Interval Load (GPTMTAILR), offset 0x028 This register is used to load the starting count value into the timer. When GPTM is configured to one of the 32-bit modes, GPTMTAILR appears as a 32-bit register (the upper 16-bits correspond to the contents of the GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR) register). In 16-bit mode, the upper 16 bits of this register read as 0s and have no effect on the state of GPTMTBILR. GPTM TimerA Interval Load (GPTMTAILR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x028 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 TAILRH Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 1 14 R/W 1 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 1 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 1 9 R/W 1 8 TAILRL Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 R/W 1 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 1 4 R/W 1 3 R/W 1 2 R/W 1 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:16 Name TAILRH Type R/W Reset Description 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Interval Load Register High (32-bit mode) 0x0000 (16-bit When configured for 32-bit mode via the GPTMCFG register, the GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR) register loads this value on a mode) write. A read returns the current value of GPTMTBILR. In 16-bit mode, this field reads as 0 and does not have an effect on the state of GPTMTBILR. 15:0 TAILRL R/W 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Interval Load Register Low For both 16- and 32-bit modes, writing this field loads the counter for TimerA. A read returns the current value of GPTMTAILR. 194 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 10: GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR), offset 0x02C This register is used to load the starting count value into TimerB. When the GPTM is configured to a 32-bit mode, GPTMTBILR returns the current value of TimerB and ignores writes. GPTM TimerB Interval Load (GPTMTBILR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x02C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 TBILRL Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0000 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Interval Load Register When the GPTM is not configured as a 32-bit timer, a write to this field updates GPTMTBILR. In 32-bit mode, writes are ignored, and reads return the current value of GPTMTBILR. 15:0 TBILRL R/W 0xFFFF October 01, 2007 Preliminary 195 General-Purpose Timers Register 11: GPTM TimerA Match (GPTMTAMATCHR), offset 0x030 This register is used in 32-bit Real-Time Clock mode and 16-bit PWM and Input Edge Count modes. GPTM TimerA Match (GPTMTAMATCHR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 TAMRH Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 1 14 R/W 1 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 1 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 1 9 R/W 1 8 TAMRL Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 R/W 1 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 1 4 R/W 1 3 R/W 1 2 R/W 1 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:16 Name TAMRH Type R/W Reset Description 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Match Register High (32-bit mode) 0x0000 (16-bit When configured for 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) mode via the GPTMCFG register, this value is compared to the upper half of mode) GPTMTAR, to determine match events. In 16-bit mode, this field reads as 0 and does not have an effect on the state of GPTMTBMATCHR. 15:0 TAMRL R/W 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Match Register Low When configured for 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) mode via the GPTMCFG register, this value is compared to the lower half of GPTMTAR, to determine match events. When configured for PWM mode, this value along with GPTMTAILR, determines the duty cycle of the output PWM signal. When configured for Edge Count mode, this value along with GPTMTAILR, determines how many edge events are counted. The total number of edge events counted is equal to the value in GPTMTAILR minus this value. 196 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 12: GPTM TimerB Match (GPTMTBMATCHR), offset 0x034 This register is used in 32-bit Real-Time Clock mode and 16-bit PWM and Input Edge Count modes. GPTM TimerB Match (GPTMTBMATCHR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x034 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 TBMRL Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0000 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Match Register Low When configured for PWM mode, this value along with GPTMTBILR, determines the duty cycle of the output PWM signal. When configured for Edge Count mode, this value along with GPTMTBILR, determines how many edge events are counted. The total number of edge events counted is equal to the value in GPTMTBILR minus this value. 15:0 TBMRL R/W 0xFFFF October 01, 2007 Preliminary 197 General-Purpose Timers Register 13: GPTM TimerA Prescale (GPTMTAPR), offset 0x038 This register allows software to extend the range of the 16-bit timers when operating in one-shot or periodic mode. GPTM TimerA Prescale (GPTMTAPR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x038 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 TAPSR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerA Prescale The register loads this value on a write. A read returns the current value of the register. Refer to Table 9-1 on page 172 for more details and an example. 7:0 TAPSR R/W 0x00 198 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 14: GPTM TimerB Prescale (GPTMTBPR), offset 0x03C This register allows software to extend the range of the 16-bit timers when operating in one-shot or periodic mode. GPTM TimerB Prescale (GPTMTBPR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x03C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 TBPSR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Prescale The register loads this value on a write. A read returns the current value of this register. Refer to Table 9-1 on page 172 for more details and an example. 7:0 TBPSR R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 199 General-Purpose Timers Register 15: GPTM TimerA Prescale Match (GPTMTAPMR), offset 0x040 This register effectively extends the range of GPTMTAMATCHR to 24 bits when operating in 16-bit one-shot or periodic mode. GPTM TimerA Prescale Match (GPTMTAPMR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x040 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 TAPSMR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerA Prescale Match This value is used alongside GPTMTAMATCHR to detect timer match events while using a prescaler. 7:0 TAPSMR R/W 0x00 200 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 16: GPTM TimerB Prescale Match (GPTMTBPMR), offset 0x044 This register effectively extends the range of GPTMTBMATCHR to 24 bits when operating in 16-bit one-shot or periodic mode. GPTM TimerB Prescale Match (GPTMTBPMR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x044 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 TBPSMR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB Prescale Match This value is used alongside GPTMTBMATCHR to detect timer match events while using a prescaler. 7:0 TBPSMR R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 201 General-Purpose Timers Register 17: GPTM TimerA (GPTMTAR), offset 0x048 This register shows the current value of the TimerA counter in all cases except for Input Edge Count mode. When in this mode, this register contains the time at which the last edge event took place. GPTM TimerA (GPTMTAR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x048 Type RO, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 TARH Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 1 14 RO 1 13 RO 0 12 RO 1 11 RO 0 10 RO 1 9 RO 1 8 TARL Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 7 RO 1 6 RO 0 5 RO 1 4 RO 1 3 RO 1 2 RO 1 1 RO 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:16 Name TARH Type RO Reset Description 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Register High (32-bit mode) 0x0000 (16-bit If the GPTMCFG is in a 32-bit mode, TimerB value is read. If the GPTMCFG is in a 16-bit mode, this is read as zero. mode) 0xFFFF GPTM TimerA Register Low A read returns the current value of the GPTM TimerA Count Register, except in Input Edge Count mode, when it returns the timestamp from the last edge event. 15:0 TARL RO 202 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 18: GPTM TimerB (GPTMTBR), offset 0x04C This register shows the current value of the TimerB counter in all cases except for Input Edge Count mode. When in this mode, this register contains the time at which the last edge event took place. GPTM TimerB (GPTMTBR) Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 Offset 0x04C Type RO, reset 0x0000.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 TBRL Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0000 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPTM TimerB A read returns the current value of the GPTM TimerB Count Register, except in Input Edge Count mode, when it returns the timestamp from the last edge event. 15:0 TBRL RO 0xFFFF October 01, 2007 Preliminary 203 Watchdog Timer 10 Watchdog Timer A watchdog timer can generate nonmaskable interrupts (NMIs) or a reset when a time-out value is reached. The watchdog timer is used to regain control when a system has failed due to a software error or due to the failure of an external device to respond in the expected way. The Stellaris Watchdog Timer module consists of a 32-bit down counter, a programmable load register, interrupt generation logic, a locking register, and user-enabled stalling. The Watchdog Timer can be configured to generate an interrupt to the controller on its first time-out, and to generate a reset signal on its second time-out. Once the Watchdog Timer has been configured, the lock register can be written to prevent the timer configuration from being inadvertently altered. ® 10.1 Block Diagram Figure 10-1. WDT Module Block Diagram Control / Clock / Interrupt Generation WDTCTL WDTICR Interrupt WDTRIS WDTMIS WDTLOCK System Clock WDTTEST Comparator WDTVALUE 32-Bit Down Counter 0x00000000 WDTLOAD Identification Registers WDTPCellID0 WDTPCellID1 WDTPCellID2 WDTPCellID3 WDTPeriphID0 WDTPeriphID1 WDTPeriphID2 WDTPeriphID3 WDTPeriphID4 WDTPeriphID5 WDTPeriphID6 WDTPeriphID7 10.2 Functional Description The Watchdog Timer module generates the first time-out signal when the 32-bit counter reaches the zero state after being enabled; enabling the counter also enables the watchdog timer interrupt. After the first time-out event, the 32-bit counter is re-loaded with the value of the Watchdog Timer Load (WDTLOAD) register, and the timer resumes counting down from that value. Once the 204 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Watchdog Timer has been configured, the Watchdog Timer Lock (WDTLOCK) register is written, which prevents the timer configuration from being inadvertently altered by software. If the timer counts down to its zero state again before the first time-out interrupt is cleared, and the reset signal has been enabled (via the WatchdogResetEnable function), the Watchdog timer asserts its reset signal to the system. If the interrupt is cleared before the 32-bit counter reaches its second time-out, the 32-bit counter is loaded with the value in the WDTLOAD register, and counting resumes from that value. If WDTLOAD is written with a new value while the Watchdog Timer counter is counting, then the counter is loaded with the new value and continues counting. Writing to WDTLOAD does not clear an active interrupt. An interrupt must be specifically cleared by writing to the Watchdog Interrupt Clear (WDTICR) register. The Watchdog module interrupt and reset generation can be enabled or disabled as required. When the interrupt is re-enabled, the 32-bit counter is preloaded with the load register value and not its last state. 10.3 Initialization and Configuration To use the WDT, its peripheral clock must be enabled by setting the WDT bit in the RCGC0 register. The Watchdog Timer is configured using the following sequence: 1. Load the WDTLOAD register with the desired timer load value. 2. If the Watchdog is configured to trigger system resets, set the RESEN bit in the WDTCTL register. 3. Set the INTEN bit in the WDTCTL register to enable the Watchdog and lock the control register. If software requires that all of the watchdog registers are locked, the Watchdog Timer module can be fully locked by writing any value to the WDTLOCK register. To unlock the Watchdog Timer, write a value of 0x1ACC.E551. 10.4 Register Map Table 10-1 on page 205 lists the Watchdog registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to the Watchdog Timer base address of 0x4000.0000. Table 10-1. Watchdog Timer Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 0x418 0xC00 Name WDTLOAD WDTVALUE WDTCTL WDTICR WDTRIS WDTMIS WDTTEST WDTLOCK Type R/W RO R/W WO RO RO R/W R/W Reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 0xFFFF.FFFF 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description Watchdog Load Watchdog Value Watchdog Control Watchdog Interrupt Clear Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status Watchdog Test Watchdog Lock See page 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 205 Watchdog Timer Offset 0xFD0 0xFD4 0xFD8 0xFDC 0xFE0 0xFE4 0xFE8 0xFEC 0xFF0 0xFF4 0xFF8 0xFFC Name WDTPeriphID4 WDTPeriphID5 WDTPeriphID6 WDTPeriphID7 WDTPeriphID0 WDTPeriphID1 WDTPeriphID2 WDTPeriphID3 WDTPCellID0 WDTPCellID1 WDTPCellID2 WDTPCellID3 Type RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0005 0x0000.0018 0x0000.0018 0x0000.0001 0x0000.000D 0x0000.00F0 0x0000.0005 0x0000.00B1 Description Watchdog Peripheral Identification 4 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 5 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 6 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 7 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 0 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 1 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 2 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 3 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 0 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 1 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 2 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 3 See page 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 10.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the WDT registers, in numerical order by address offset. 206 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: Watchdog Load (WDTLOAD), offset 0x000 This register is the 32-bit interval value used by the 32-bit counter. When this register is written, the value is immediately loaded and the counter restarts counting down from the new value. If the WDTLOAD register is loaded with 0x0000.0000, an interrupt is immediately generated. Watchdog Load (WDTLOAD) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WDTLoad Type Reset R/W 1 15 R/W 1 14 R/W 1 13 R/W 1 12 R/W 1 11 R/W 1 10 R/W 1 9 R/W 1 8 R/W 1 7 R/W 1 6 R/W 1 5 R/W 1 4 R/W 1 3 R/W 1 2 R/W 1 1 R/W 1 0 WDTLoad Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field 31:0 Name WDTLoad Type R/W Reset Description 0xFFFF.FFFF Watchdog Load Value October 01, 2007 Preliminary 207 Watchdog Timer Register 2: Watchdog Value (WDTVALUE), offset 0x004 This register contains the current count value of the timer. Watchdog Value (WDTVALUE) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WDTValue Type Reset RO 1 15 RO 1 14 RO 1 13 RO 1 12 RO 1 11 RO 1 10 RO 1 9 RO 1 8 RO 1 7 RO 1 6 RO 1 5 RO 1 4 RO 1 3 RO 1 2 RO 1 1 RO 1 0 WDTValue Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field 31:0 Name WDTValue Type RO Reset Description 0xFFFF.FFFF Watchdog Value Current value of the 32-bit down counter. 208 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: Watchdog Control (WDTCTL), offset 0x008 This register is the watchdog control register. The watchdog timer can be configured to generate a reset signal (on second time-out) or an interrupt on time-out. When the watchdog interrupt has been enabled, all subsequent writes to the control register are ignored. The only mechanism that can re-enable writes is a hardware reset. Watchdog Control (WDTCTL) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RESEN R/W 0 RO 0 0 INTEN R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Reset Enable The RESEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Disabled. Enable the Watchdog module reset output. 1 RESEN R/W 0 0 INTEN R/W 0 Watchdog Interrupt Enable The INTEN values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Interrupt event disabled (once this bit is set, it can only be cleared by a hardware reset). Interrupt event enabled. Once enabled, all writes are ignored. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 209 Watchdog Timer Register 4: Watchdog Interrupt Clear (WDTICR), offset 0x00C This register is the interrupt clear register. A write of any value to this register clears the Watchdog interrupt and reloads the 32-bit counter from the WDTLOAD register. Value for a read or reset is indeterminate. Watchdog Interrupt Clear (WDTICR) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x00C Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WDTIntClr Type Reset WO 15 WO 14 WO 13 WO 12 WO 11 WO 10 WO 9 WO 8 WO 7 WO 6 WO 5 WO 4 WO 3 WO 2 WO 1 WO 0 WDTIntClr Type Reset WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO WO - Bit/Field 31:0 Name WDTIntClr Type WO Reset - Description Watchdog Interrupt Clear 210 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 5: Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status (WDTRIS), offset 0x010 This register is the raw interrupt status register. Watchdog interrupt events can be monitored via this register if the controller interrupt is masked. Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status (WDTRIS) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x010 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 WDTRIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of WDTINTR. 0 WDTRIS RO 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 211 Watchdog Timer Register 6: Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status (WDTMIS), offset 0x014 This register is the masked interrupt status register. The value of this register is the logical AND of the raw interrupt bit and the Watchdog interrupt enable bit. Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status (WDTMIS) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 WDTMIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state (after masking) of the WDTINTR interrupt. 0 WDTMIS RO 0 212 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: Watchdog Test (WDTTEST), offset 0x418 This register provides user-enabled stalling when the microcontroller asserts the CPU halt flag during debug. Watchdog Test (WDTTEST) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0x418 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 STALL R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:9 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Stall Enable When set to 1, if the Stellaris microcontroller is stopped with a debugger, the watchdog timer stops counting. Once the microcontroller is restarted, the watchdog timer resumes counting. ® 8 STALL R/W 0 7:0 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 213 Watchdog Timer Register 8: Watchdog Lock (WDTLOCK), offset 0xC00 Writing 0x1ACC.E551 to the WDTLOCK register enables write access to all other registers. Writing any other value to the WDTLOCK register re-enables the locked state for register writes to all the other registers. Reading the WDTLOCK register returns the lock status rather than the 32-bit value written. Therefore, when write accesses are disabled, reading the WDTLOCK register returns 0x0000.0001 (when locked; otherwise, the returned value is 0x0000.0000 (unlocked)). Watchdog Lock (WDTLOCK) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xC00 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WDTLock Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 WDTLock Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:0 Name WDTLock Type R/W Reset 0x0000 Description Watchdog Lock A write of the value 0x1ACC.E551 unlocks the watchdog registers for write access. A write of any other value reapplies the lock, preventing any register updates. A read of this register returns the following values: Value Description 0x0000.0001 Locked 0x0000.0000 Unlocked 214 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 4 (WDTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 4 (WDTPeriphID4) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Peripheral ID Register[7:0] 7:0 PID4 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 215 Watchdog Timer Register 10: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 5 (WDTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 5 (WDTPeriphID5) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFD4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Peripheral ID Register[15:8] 7:0 PID5 RO 0x00 216 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 11: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 6 (WDTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 6 (WDTPeriphID6) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFD8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID6 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Peripheral ID Register[23:16] 7:0 PID6 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 217 Watchdog Timer Register 12: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 7 (WDTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 7 (WDTPeriphID7) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFDC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID7 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. WDT Peripheral ID Register[31:24] 7:0 PID7 RO 0x00 218 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 0 (WDTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 0 (WDTPeriphID0) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Peripheral ID Register[7:0] 7:0 PID0 RO 0x05 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 219 Watchdog Timer Register 14: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 1 (WDTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 1 (WDTPeriphID1) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Peripheral ID Register[15:8] 7:0 PID1 RO 0x18 220 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 15: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 2 (WDTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 2 (WDTPeriphID2) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Peripheral ID Register[23:16] 7:0 PID2 RO 0x18 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 221 Watchdog Timer Register 16: Watchdog Peripheral Identification 3 (WDTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The WDTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog Peripheral Identification 3 (WDTPeriphID3) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Peripheral ID Register[31:24] 7:0 PID3 RO 0x01 222 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 17: Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 0 (WDTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The WDTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 0 (WDTPCellID0) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog PrimeCell ID Register[7:0] 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D October 01, 2007 Preliminary 223 Watchdog Timer Register 18: Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 1 (WDTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The WDTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 1 (WDTPCellID1) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog PrimeCell ID Register[15:8] 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 224 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 19: Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 2 (WDTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The WDTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 2 (WDTPCellID2) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog PrimeCell ID Register[23:16] 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 225 Watchdog Timer Register 20: Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 3 (WDTPCellID3 ), offset 0xFFC The WDTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 3 (WDTPCellID3) Base 0x4000.0000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog PrimeCell ID Register[31:24] 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 226 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 11 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) The Stellaris Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) provides fully programmable, 16C550-type serial interface characteristics. The LM3S601 controller is equipped with two UART modules. Each UART has the following features: ■ Separate transmit and receive FIFOs ■ Programmable FIFO length, including 1-byte deep operation providing conventional double-buffered interface ■ FIFO trigger levels of 1/8, 1/4, 1/2, 3/4, and 7/8 ■ Programmable baud-rate generator allowing rates up to 3.125 Mbps ■ Standard asynchronous communication bits for start, stop, and parity ■ False start bit detection ■ Line-break generation and detection ■ Fully programmable serial interface characteristics: – 5, 6, 7, or 8 data bits – Even, odd, stick, or no-parity bit generation/detection – 1 or 2 stop bit generation ® October 01, 2007 Preliminary 227 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) 11.1 Block Diagram Figure 11-1. UART Module Block Diagram System Clock Interrupt Interrupt Control UARTIFLS UARTIM UARTMIS TXFIFO 16x8 . . . Transmitter Baud Rate Generator UARTIBRD UARTFBRD Receiver UnRx UnTx Identification Registers UARTPCellID0 UARTPCellID1 UARTPCellID2 UARTPCellID3 UARTPeriphID0 UARTPeriphID1 UARTPeriphID2 UARTPeriphID3 UART PeriphID4 UARTRIS UARTICR UARTDR Control / Status UARTRSR/ECR RXFIFO 16x8 UARTPeriphID5 UARTFR UARTPeriphID6 UARTLCRH UARTPeriphID7 UARTCTL UARTILPR . . . 11.2 Functional Description Each Stellaris UART performs the functions of parallel-to-serial and serial-to-parallel conversions. It is similar in functionality to a 16C550 UART, but is not register compatible. The UART is configured for transmit and/or receive via the TXE and RXE bits of the UART Control (UARTCTL) register (see page 244). Transmit and receive are both enabled out of reset. Before any control registers are programmed, the UART must be disabled by clearing the UARTEN bit in UARTCTL. If the UART is disabled during a TX or RX operation, the current transaction is completed prior to the UART stopping. ® 11.2.1 Transmit/Receive Logic The transmit logic performs parallel-to-serial conversion on the data read from the transmit FIFO. The control logic outputs the serial bit stream beginning with a start bit, and followed by the data bits (LSB first), parity bit, and the stop bits according to the programmed configuration in the control registers. See Figure 11-2 on page 229 for details. 228 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller The receive logic performs serial-to-parallel conversion on the received bit stream after a valid start pulse has been detected. Overrun, parity, frame error checking, and line-break detection are also performed, and their status accompanies the data that is written to the receive FIFO. Figure 11-2. UART Character Frame UnTX 1 0 n Star t LSB 5-8 data bits Parity bit if enabled MSB 1-2 stop bits 11.2.2 Baud-Rate Generation The baud-rate divisor is a 22-bit number consisting of a 16-bit integer and a 6-bit fractional part. The number formed by these two values is used by the baud-rate generator to determine the bit period. Having a fractional baud-rate divider allows the UART to generate all the standard baud rates. The 16-bit integer is loaded through the UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTIBRD) register (see page 240) and the 6-bit fractional part is loaded with the UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTFBRD) register (see page 241). The baud-rate divisor (BRD) has the following relationship to the system clock (where BRDI is the integer part of the BRD and BRDF is the fractional part, separated by a decimal place.): BRD = BRDI + BRDF = SysClk / (16 * Baud Rate) The 6-bit fractional number (that is to be loaded into the DIVFRAC bit field in the UARTFBRD register) can be calculated by taking the fractional part of the baud-rate divisor, multiplying it by 64, and adding 0.5 to account for rounding errors: UARTFBRD[DIVFRAC] = integer(BRDF * 64 + 0.5) The UART generates an internal baud-rate reference clock at 16x the baud-rate (referred to as Baud16). This reference clock is divided by 16 to generate the transmit clock, and is used for error detection during receive operations. Along with the UART Line Control, High Byte (UARTLCRH) register (see page 242), the UARTIBRD and UARTFBRD registers form an internal 30-bit register. This internal register is only updated when a write operation to UARTLCRH is performed, so any changes to the baud-rate divisor must be followed by a write to the UARTLCRH register for the changes to take effect. To update the baud-rate registers, there are four possible sequences: ■ UARTIBRD write, UARTFBRD write, and UARTLCRH write ■ UARTFBRD write, UARTIBRD write, and UARTLCRH write ■ UARTIBRD write and UARTLCRH write ■ UARTFBRD write and UARTLCRH write October 01, 2007 Preliminary 229 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) 11.2.3 Data Transmission Data received or transmitted is stored in two 16-byte FIFOs, though the receive FIFO has an extra four bits per character for status information. For transmission, data is written into the transmit FIFO. If the UART is enabled, it causes a data frame to start transmitting with the parameters indicated in the UARTLCRH register. Data continues to be transmitted until there is no data left in the transmit FIFO. The BUSY bit in the UART Flag (UARTFR) register (see page 238) is asserted as soon as data is written to the transmit FIFO (that is, if the FIFO is non-empty) and remains asserted while data is being transmitted. The BUSY bit is negated only when the transmit FIFO is empty, and the last character has been transmitted from the shift register, including the stop bits. The UART can indicate that it is busy even though the UART may no longer be enabled. When the receiver is idle (the UnRx is continuously 1) and the data input goes Low (a start bit has been received), the receive counter begins running and data is sampled on the eighth cycle of Baud16 (described in “Transmit/Receive Logic” on page 228). The start bit is valid if UnRx is still low on the eighth cycle of Baud16, otherwise a false start bit is detected and it is ignored. Start bit errors can be viewed in the UART Receive Status (UARTRSR) register (see page 236). If the start bit was valid, successive data bits are sampled on every 16th cycle of Baud16 (that is, one bit period later) according to the programmed length of the data characters. The parity bit is then checked if parity mode was enabled. Data length and parity are defined in the UARTLCRH register. Lastly, a valid stop bit is confirmed if UnRx is High, otherwise a framing error has occurred. When a full word is received, the data is stored in the receive FIFO, with any error bits associated with that word. 11.2.4 FIFO Operation The UART has two 16-entry FIFOs; one for transmit and one for receive. Both FIFOs are accessed via the UART Data (UARTDR) register (see page 234). Read operations of the UARTDR register return a 12-bit value consisting of 8 data bits and 4 error flags while write operations place 8-bit data in the transmit FIFO. Out of reset, both FIFOs are disabled and act as 1-byte-deep holding registers. The FIFOs are enabled by setting the FEN bit in UARTLCRH (page 242). FIFO status can be monitored via the UART Flag (UARTFR) register (see page 238) and the UART Receive Status (UARTRSR) register. Hardware monitors empty, full and overrun conditions. The UARTFR register contains empty and full flags (TXFE, TXFF, RXFE, and RXFF bits) and the UARTRSR register shows overrun status via the OE bit. The trigger points at which the FIFOs generate interrupts is controlled via the UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select (UARTIFLS) register (see page 245). Both FIFOs can be individually configured to trigger interrupts at different levels. Available configurations include 1/8, ¼, ½, ¾, and 7/8. For example, if the ¼ option is selected for the receive FIFO, the UART generates a receive interrupt after 4 data bytes are received. Out of reset, both FIFOs are configured to trigger an interrupt at the ½ mark. 11.2.5 Interrupts The UART can generate interrupts when the following conditions are observed: ■ Overrun Error ■ Break Error 230 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller ■ Parity Error ■ Framing Error ■ Receive Timeout ■ Transmit (when condition defined in the TXIFLSEL bit in the UARTIFLS register is met) ■ Receive (when condition defined in the RXIFLSEL bit in the UARTIFLS register is met) All of the interrupt events are ORed together before being sent to the interrupt controller, so the UART can only generate a single interrupt request to the controller at any given time. Software can service multiple interrupt events in a single interrupt service routine by reading the UART Masked Interrupt Status (UARTMIS) register (see page 250). The interrupt events that can trigger a controller-level interrupt are defined in the UART Interrupt Mask (UARTIM ) register (see page 247) by setting the corresponding IM bit to 1. If interrupts are not used, the raw interrupt status is always visible via the UART Raw Interrupt Status (UARTRIS) register (see page 249). Interrupts are always cleared (for both the UARTMIS and UARTRIS registers) by setting the corresponding bit in the UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR) register (see page 251). The receive timeout interrupt is asserted when the receive FIFO is not empty, and no further data is received over a 32-bit period. The receive timeout interrupt is cleared either when the FIFO becomes empty through reading all the data (or by reading the holding register), or when a 1 is written to the corresponding bit in the UARTICR register. 11.2.6 Loopback Operation The UART can be placed into an internal loopback mode for diagnostic or debug work. This is accomplished by setting the LBE bit in the UARTCTL register (see page 244). In loopback mode, data transmitted on UnTx is received on the UnRx input. 11.3 Initialization and Configuration To use the UARTs, the peripheral clock must be enabled by setting the UART0 or UART1 bits in the RCGC1 register. This section discusses the steps that are required for using a UART module. For this example, the system clock is assumed to be 20 MHz and the desired UART configuration is: ■ 115200 baud rate ■ Data length of 8 bits ■ One stop bit ■ No parity ■ FIFOs disabled ■ No interrupts The first thing to consider when programming the UART is the baud-rate divisor (BRD), since the UARTIBRD and UARTFBRD registers must be written before the UARTLCRH register. Using the equation described in “Baud-Rate Generation” on page 229, the BRD can be calculated: October 01, 2007 Preliminary 231 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) BRD = 20,000,000 / (16 * 115,200) = 10.8507 which means that the DIVINT field of the UARTIBRD register (see page 240) should be set to 10. The value to be loaded into the UARTFBRD register (see page 241) is calculated by the equation: UARTFBRD[DIVFRAC] = integer(0.8507 * 64 + 0.5) = 54 With the BRD values in hand, the UART configuration is written to the module in the following order: 1. Disable the UART by clearing the UARTEN bit in the UARTCTL register. 2. Write the integer portion of the BRD to the UARTIBRD register. 3. Write the fractional portion of the BRD to the UARTFBRD register. 4. Write the desired serial parameters to the UARTLCRH register (in this case, a value of 0x0000.0060). 5. Enable the UART by setting the UARTEN bit in the UARTCTL register. 11.4 Register Map Table 11-1 on page 232 lists the UART registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to that UART’s base address: ■ UART0: 0x4000.C000 ■ UART1: 0x4000.D000 Note: The UART must be disabled (see the UARTEN bit in the UARTCTL register on page 244) before any of the control registers are reprogrammed. When the UART is disabled during a TX or RX operation, the current transaction is completed prior to the UART stopping. Table 11-1. UART Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x018 0x024 0x028 0x02C 0x030 0x034 0x038 0x03C 0x040 Name UARTDR UARTRSR/UARTECR UARTFR UARTIBRD UARTFBRD UARTLCRH UARTCTL UARTIFLS UARTIM UARTRIS UARTMIS Type R/W R/W RO R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0090 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0300 0x0000.0012 0x0000.0000 0x0000.000F 0x0000.0000 Description UART Data UART Receive Status/Error Clear UART Flag UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor UART Line Control UART Control UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select UART Interrupt Mask UART Raw Interrupt Status UART Masked Interrupt Status See page 234 236 238 240 241 242 244 245 247 249 250 232 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Offset 0x044 0xFD0 0xFD4 0xFD8 0xFDC 0xFE0 0xFE4 0xFE8 0xFEC 0xFF0 0xFF4 0xFF8 0xFFC Name UARTICR UARTPeriphID4 UARTPeriphID5 UARTPeriphID6 UARTPeriphID7 UARTPeriphID0 UARTPeriphID1 UARTPeriphID2 UARTPeriphID3 UARTPCellID0 UARTPCellID1 UARTPCellID2 UARTPCellID3 Type W1C RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0011 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0018 0x0000.0001 0x0000.000D 0x0000.00F0 0x0000.0005 0x0000.00B1 Description UART Interrupt Clear UART Peripheral Identification 4 UART Peripheral Identification 5 UART Peripheral Identification 6 UART Peripheral Identification 7 UART Peripheral Identification 0 UART Peripheral Identification 1 UART Peripheral Identification 2 UART Peripheral Identification 3 UART PrimeCell Identification 0 UART PrimeCell Identification 1 UART PrimeCell Identification 2 UART PrimeCell Identification 3 See page 251 253 254 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 11.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the UART registers, in numerical order by address offset. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 233 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 1: UART Data (UARTDR), offset 0x000 This register is the data register (the interface to the FIFOs). When FIFOs are enabled, data written to this location is pushed onto the transmit FIFO. If FIFOs are disabled, data is stored in the transmitter holding register (the bottom word of the transmit FIFO). A write to this register initiates a transmission from the UART. For received data, if the FIFO is enabled, the data byte and the 4-bit status (break, frame, parity, and overrun) is pushed onto the 12-bit wide receive FIFO. If FIFOs are disabled, the data byte and status are stored in the receiving holding register (the bottom word of the receive FIFO). The received data can be retrieved by reading this register. UART Data (UARTDR) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 OE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 BE RO 0 RO 0 9 PE RO 0 RO 0 8 FE RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DATA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:12 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Overrun Error The OE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 There has been no data loss due to a FIFO overrun. New data was received when the FIFO was full, resulting in data loss. 11 OE RO 0 10 BE RO 0 UART Break Error This bit is set to 1 when a break condition is detected, indicating that the receive data input was held Low for longer than a full-word transmission time (defined as start, data, parity, and stop bits). In FIFO mode, this error is associated with the character at the top of the FIFO. When a break occurs, only one 0 character is loaded into the FIFO. The next character is only enabled after the received data input goes to a 1 (marking state) and the next valid start bit is received. 234 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 9 Name PE Type RO Reset 0 Description UART Parity Error This bit is set to 1 when the parity of the received data character does not match the parity defined by bits 2 and 7 of the UARTLCRH register. In FIFO mode, this error is associated with the character at the top of the FIFO. 8 FE RO 0 UART Framing Error This bit is set to 1 when the received character does not have a valid stop bit (a valid stop bit is 1). 7:0 DATA R/W 0 Data Transmitted or Received When written, the data that is to be transmitted via the UART. When read, the data that was received by the UART. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 235 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 2: UART Receive Status/Error Clear (UARTRSR/UARTECR), offset 0x004 The UARTRSR/UARTECR register is the receive status register/error clear register. In addition to the UARTDR register, receive status can also be read from the UARTRSR register. If the status is read from this register, then the status information corresponds to the entry read from UARTDR prior to reading UARTRSR. The status information for overrun is set immediately when an overrun condition occurs. A write of any value to the UARTECR register clears the framing, parity, break, and overrun errors. All the bits are cleared to 0 on reset. Read-Only Receive Status (UARTRSR) Register UART Receive Status/Error Clear (UARTRSR/UARTECR) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 OE RO 0 RO 0 2 BE RO 0 RO 0 1 PE RO 0 RO 0 0 FE RO 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. The UARTRSR register cannot be written. 3 OE RO 0 UART Overrun Error When this bit is set to 1, data is received and the FIFO is already full. This bit is cleared to 0 by a write to UARTECR. The FIFO contents remain valid since no further data is written when the FIFO is full, only the contents of the shift register are overwritten. The CPU must now read the data in order to empty the FIFO. 2 BE RO 0 UART Break Error This bit is set to 1 when a break condition is detected, indicating that the received data input was held Low for longer than a full-word transmission time (defined as start, data, parity, and stop bits). This bit is cleared to 0 by a write to UARTECR. In FIFO mode, this error is associated with the character at the top of the FIFO. When a break occurs, only one 0 character is loaded into the FIFO. The next character is only enabled after the receive data input goes to a 1 (marking state) and the next valid start bit is received. 236 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 1 Name PE Type RO Reset 0 Description UART Parity Error This bit is set to 1 when the parity of the received data character does not match the parity defined by bits 2 and 7 of the UARTLCRH register. This bit is cleared to 0 by a write to UARTECR. 0 FE RO 0 UART Framing Error This bit is set to 1 when the received character does not have a valid stop bit (a valid stop bit is 1). This bit is cleared to 0 by a write to UARTECR. In FIFO mode, this error is associated with the character at the top of the FIFO. Write-Only Error Clear (UARTECR) Register UART Receive Status/Error Clear (UARTRSR/UARTECR) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x004 Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset WO 0 15 WO 0 14 WO 0 13 WO 0 12 WO 0 11 WO 0 10 WO 0 9 WO 0 8 WO 0 7 WO 0 6 WO 0 5 WO 0 4 DATA WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 3 WO 0 2 WO 0 1 WO 0 0 reserved Type Reset WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type WO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Error Clear A write to this register of any data clears the framing, parity, break, and overrun flags. 7:0 DATA WO 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 237 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 3: UART Flag (UARTFR), offset 0x018 The UARTFR register is the flag register. After reset, the TXFF, RXFF, and BUSY bits are 0, and TXFE and RXFE bits are 1. UART Flag (UARTFR) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0090 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 TXFE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 6 RXFF RO 0 RO 0 5 TXFF RO 0 RO 0 4 RXFE RO 1 RO 0 3 BUSY RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Transmit FIFO Empty The meaning of this bit depends on the state of the FEN bit in the UARTLCRH register. If the FIFO is disabled (FEN is 0), this bit is set when the transmit holding register is empty. If the FIFO is enabled (FEN is 1), this bit is set when the transmit FIFO is empty. 7 TXFE RO 1 6 RXFF RO 0 UART Receive FIFO Full The meaning of this bit depends on the state of the FEN bit in the UARTLCRH register. If the FIFO is disabled, this bit is set when the receive holding register is full. If the FIFO is enabled, this bit is set when the receive FIFO is full. 5 TXFF RO 0 UART Transmit FIFO Full The meaning of this bit depends on the state of the FEN bit in the UARTLCRH register. If the FIFO is disabled, this bit is set when the transmit holding register is full. If the FIFO is enabled, this bit is set when the transmit FIFO is full. 238 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 4 Name RXFE Type RO Reset 1 Description UART Receive FIFO Empty The meaning of this bit depends on the state of the FEN bit in the UARTLCRH register. If the FIFO is disabled, this bit is set when the receive holding register is empty. If the FIFO is enabled, this bit is set when the receive FIFO is empty. 3 BUSY RO 0 UART Busy When this bit is 1, the UART is busy transmitting data. This bit remains set until the complete byte, including all stop bits, has been sent from the shift register. This bit is set as soon as the transmit FIFO becomes non-empty (regardless of whether UART is enabled). 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 239 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 4: UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTIBRD), offset 0x024 The UARTIBRD register is the integer part of the baud-rate divisor value. All the bits are cleared on reset. The minimum possible divide ratio is 1 (when UARTIBRD=0), in which case the UARTFBRD register is ignored. When changing the UARTIBRD register, the new value does not take effect until transmission/reception of the current character is complete. Any changes to the baud-rate divisor must be followed by a write to the UARTLCRH register. See “Baud-Rate Generation” on page 229 for configuration details. UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTIBRD) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x024 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 DIVINT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Integer Baud-Rate Divisor 15:0 DIVINT R/W 0x0000 240 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 5: UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTFBRD), offset 0x028 The UARTFBRD register is the fractional part of the baud-rate divisor value. All the bits are cleared on reset. When changing the UARTFBRD register, the new value does not take effect until transmission/reception of the current character is complete. Any changes to the baud-rate divisor must be followed by a write to the UARTLCRH register. See “Baud-Rate Generation” on page 229 for configuration details. UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTFBRD) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x028 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 DIVFRAC R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor 5:0 DIVFRAC R/W 0x000 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 241 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 6: UART Line Control (UARTLCRH), offset 0x02C The UARTLCRH register is the line control register. Serial parameters such as data length, parity, and stop bit selection are implemented in this register. When updating the baud-rate divisor (UARTIBRD and/or UARTIFRD), the UARTLCRH register must also be written. The write strobe for the baud-rate divisor registers is tied to the UARTLCRH register. UART Line Control (UARTLCRH) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x02C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 SPS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 6 WLEN R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 FEN R/W 0 RO 0 3 STP2 R/W 0 RO 0 2 EPS R/W 0 RO 0 1 PEN R/W 0 RO 0 0 BRK R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Stick Parity Select When bits 1, 2, and 7 of UARTLCRH are set, the parity bit is transmitted and checked as a 0. When bits 1 and 7 are set and 2 is cleared, the parity bit is transmitted and checked as a 1. When this bit is cleared, stick parity is disabled. 7 SPS R/W 0 6:5 WLEN R/W 0 UART Word Length The bits indicate the number of data bits transmitted or received in a frame as follows: Value Description 0x3 8 bits 0x2 7 bits 0x1 6 bits 0x0 5 bits (default) 4 FEN R/W 0 UART Enable FIFOs If this bit is set to 1, transmit and receive FIFO buffers are enabled (FIFO mode). When cleared to 0, FIFOs are disabled (Character mode). The FIFOs become 1-byte-deep holding registers. 242 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 3 Name STP2 Type R/W Reset 0 Description UART Two Stop Bits Select If this bit is set to 1, two stop bits are transmitted at the end of a frame. The receive logic does not check for two stop bits being received. 2 EPS R/W 0 UART Even Parity Select If this bit is set to 1, even parity generation and checking is performed during transmission and reception, which checks for an even number of 1s in data and parity bits. When cleared to 0, then odd parity is performed, which checks for an odd number of 1s. This bit has no effect when parity is disabled by the PEN bit. 1 PEN R/W 0 UART Parity Enable If this bit is set to 1, parity checking and generation is enabled; otherwise, parity is disabled and no parity bit is added to the data frame. 0 BRK R/W 0 UART Send Break If this bit is set to 1, a Low level is continually output on the UnTX output, after completing transmission of the current character. For the proper execution of the break command, the software must set this bit for at least two frames (character periods). For normal use, this bit must be cleared to 0. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 243 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 7: UART Control (UARTCTL), offset 0x030 The UARTCTL register is the control register. All the bits are cleared on reset except for the Transmit Enable (TXE) and Receive Enable (RXE) bits, which are set to 1. To enable the UART module, the UARTEN bit must be set to 1. If software requires a configuration change in the module, the UARTEN bit must be cleared before the configuration changes are written. If the UART is disabled during a transmit or receive operation, the current transaction is completed prior to the UART stopping. UART Control (UARTCTL) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0300 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RXE RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 RO 0 8 TXE R/W 1 RO 0 7 LBE R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 UARTEN R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:10 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Receive Enable If this bit is set to 1, the receive section of the UART is enabled. When the UART is disabled in the middle of a receive, it completes the current character before stopping. Note: To enable reception, the UARTEN bit must also be set. 9 RXE R/W 1 8 TXE R/W 1 UART Transmit Enable If this bit is set to 1, the transmit section of the UART is enabled. When the UART is disabled in the middle of a transmission, it completes the current character before stopping. Note: To enable transmission, the UARTEN bit must also be set. 7 LBE R/W 0 UART Loop Back Enable If this bit is set to 1, the UnTX path is fed through the UnRX path. 6:1 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Enable If this bit is set to 1, the UART is enabled. When the UART is disabled in the middle of transmission or reception, it completes the current character before stopping. 0 UARTEN R/W 0 244 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 8: UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select (UARTIFLS), offset 0x034 The UARTIFLS register is the interrupt FIFO level select register. You can use this register to define the FIFO level at which the TXRIS and RXRIS bits in the UARTRIS register are triggered. The interrupts are generated based on a transition through a level rather than being based on the level. That is, the interrupts are generated when the fill level progresses through the trigger level. For example, if the receive trigger level is set to the half-way mark, the interrupt is triggered as the module is receiving the 9th character. Out of reset, the TXIFLSEL and RXIFLSEL bits are configured so that the FIFOs trigger an interrupt at the half-way mark. UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select (UARTIFLS) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x034 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0012 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RXIFLSEL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 TXIFLSEL R/W 1 R/W 0 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Receive Interrupt FIFO Level Select The trigger points for the receive interrupt are as follows: Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 Description RX FIFO ≥ 1/8 full RX FIFO ≥ ¼ full RX FIFO ≥ ½ full (default) RX FIFO ≥ ¾ full RX FIFO ≥ 7/8 full 5:3 RXIFLSEL R/W 0x2 0x5-0x7 Reserved October 01, 2007 Preliminary 245 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Bit/Field 2:0 Name TXIFLSEL Type R/W Reset 0x2 Description UART Transmit Interrupt FIFO Level Select The trigger points for the transmit interrupt are as follows: Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 Description TX FIFO ≤ 1/8 full TX FIFO ≤ ¼ full TX FIFO ≤ ½ full (default) TX FIFO ≤ ¾ full TX FIFO ≤ 7/8 full 0x5-0x7 Reserved 246 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: UART Interrupt Mask (UARTIM), offset 0x038 The UARTIM register is the interrupt mask set/clear register. On a read, this register gives the current value of the mask on the relevant interrupt. Writing a 1 to a bit allows the corresponding raw interrupt signal to be routed to the interrupt controller. Writing a 0 prevents the raw interrupt signal from being sent to the interrupt controller. UART Interrupt Mask (UARTIM) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x038 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 OEIM R/W 0 RO 0 9 BEIM R/W 0 RO 0 8 PEIM R/W 0 RO 0 7 FEIM R/W 0 RO 0 6 RTIM R/W 0 RO 0 5 TXIM R/W 0 RO 0 4 RXIM R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Overrun Error Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the OEIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the OEIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 10 OEIM R/W 0 9 BEIM R/W 0 UART Break Error Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the BEIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the BEIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 8 PEIM R/W 0 UART Parity Error Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the PEIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the PEIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 7 FEIM R/W 0 UART Framing Error Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the FEIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the FEIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 6 RTIM R/W 0 UART Receive Time-Out Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the RTIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the RTIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 5 TXIM R/W 0 UART Transmit Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the TXIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the TXIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 247 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Bit/Field 4 Name RXIM Type R/W Reset 0 Description UART Receive Interrupt Mask On a read, the current mask for the RXIM interrupt is returned. Setting this bit to 1 promotes the RXIM interrupt to the interrupt controller. 3:0 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 248 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 10: UART Raw Interrupt Status (UARTRIS), offset 0x03C The UARTRIS register is the raw interrupt status register. On a read, this register gives the current raw status value of the corresponding interrupt. A write has no effect. UART Raw Interrupt Status (UARTRIS) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x03C Type RO, reset 0x0000.000F 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 OERIS RO 0 RO 0 9 BERIS RO 0 RO 0 8 PERIS RO 0 RO 0 7 FERIS RO 0 RO 0 6 RTRIS RO 0 RO 0 5 TXRIS RO 0 RO 0 4 RXRIS RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 reserved RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Overrun Error Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 10 OERIS RO 0 9 BERIS RO 0 UART Break Error Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 8 PERIS RO 0 UART Parity Error Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 7 FERIS RO 0 UART Framing Error Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 6 RTRIS RO 0 UART Receive Time-Out Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 5 TXRIS RO 0 UART Transmit Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 4 RXRIS RO 0 UART Receive Raw Interrupt Status Gives the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of this interrupt. 3:0 reserved RO 0xF Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 249 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 11: UART Masked Interrupt Status (UARTMIS), offset 0x040 The UARTMIS register is the masked interrupt status register. On a read, this register gives the current masked status value of the corresponding interrupt. A write has no effect. UART Masked Interrupt Status (UARTMIS) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x040 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 OEMIS RO 0 RO 0 9 BEMIS RO 0 RO 0 8 PEMIS RO 0 RO 0 7 FEMIS RO 0 RO 0 6 RTMIS RO 0 RO 0 5 TXMIS RO 0 RO 0 4 RXMIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Overrun Error Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 10 OEMIS RO 0 9 BEMIS RO 0 UART Break Error Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 8 PEMIS RO 0 UART Parity Error Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 7 FEMIS RO 0 UART Framing Error Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 6 RTMIS RO 0 UART Receive Time-Out Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 5 TXMIS RO 0 UART Transmit Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 4 RXMIS RO 0 UART Receive Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. 3:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 250 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 12: UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR), offset 0x044 The UARTICR register is the interrupt clear register. On a write of 1, the corresponding interrupt (both raw interrupt and masked interrupt, if enabled) is cleared. A write of 0 has no effect. UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0x044 Type W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 OEIC W1C 0 RO 0 9 BEIC W1C 0 RO 0 8 PEIC W1C 0 RO 0 7 FEIC W1C 0 RO 0 6 RTIC W1C 0 RO 0 5 TXIC W1C 0 RO 0 4 RXIC W1C 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Overrun Error Interrupt Clear The OEIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 10 OEIC W1C 0 9 BEIC W1C 0 Break Error Interrupt Clear The BEIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 8 PEIC W1C 0 Parity Error Interrupt Clear The PEIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 251 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Bit/Field 7 Name FEIC Type W1C Reset 0 Description Framing Error Interrupt Clear The FEIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 6 RTIC W1C 0 Receive Time-Out Interrupt Clear The RTIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 5 TXIC W1C 0 Transmit Interrupt Clear The TXIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 4 RXIC W1C 0 Receive Interrupt Clear The RXIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on the interrupt. Clears interrupt. 3:0 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 252 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: UART Peripheral Identification 4 (UARTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 4 (UARTPeriphID4) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID4 RO 0x0000 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 253 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 14: UART Peripheral Identification 5 (UARTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 5 (UARTPeriphID5) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFD4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID5 RO 0x0000 254 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 15: UART Peripheral Identification 6 (UARTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 6 (UARTPeriphID6) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFD8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID6 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID6 RO 0x0000 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 255 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 16: UART Peripheral Identification 7 (UARTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 7 (UARTPeriphID7) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFDC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID7 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID7 RO 0x0000 256 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 17: UART Peripheral Identification 0 (UARTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 0 (UARTPeriphID0) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0011 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID0 RO 0x11 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 257 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 18: UART Peripheral Identification 1 (UARTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 1 (UARTPeriphID1) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID1 RO 0x00 258 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 19: UART Peripheral Identification 2 (UARTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 2 (UARTPeriphID2) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID2 RO 0x18 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 259 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 20: UART Peripheral Identification 3 (UARTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The UARTPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART Peripheral Identification 3 (UARTPeriphID3) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART Peripheral ID Register[31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID3 RO 0x01 260 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 21: UART PrimeCell Identification 0 (UARTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The UARTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART PrimeCell Identification 0 (UARTPCellID0) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART PrimeCell ID Register[7:0] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D October 01, 2007 Preliminary 261 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 22: UART PrimeCell Identification 1 (UARTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The UARTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART PrimeCell Identification 1 (UARTPCellID1) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART PrimeCell ID Register[15:8] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 262 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 23: UART PrimeCell Identification 2 (UARTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The UARTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART PrimeCell Identification 2 (UARTPCellID2) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART PrimeCell ID Register[23:16] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 263 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) Register 24: UART PrimeCell Identification 3 (UARTPCellID3), offset 0xFFC The UARTPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. UART PrimeCell Identification 3 (UARTPCellID3) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. UART PrimeCell ID Register[31:24] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 264 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 12 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) The Stellaris Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) is a master or slave interface for synchronous serial communication with peripheral devices that have either Freescale SPI, MICROWIRE, or Texas Instruments synchronous serial interfaces. The Stellaris SSI module has the following features: ■ Master or slave operation ■ Programmable clock bit rate and prescale ■ Separate transmit and receive FIFOs, 16 bits wide, 8 locations deep ■ Programmable interface operation for Freescale SPI, MICROWIRE, or Texas Instruments synchronous serial interfaces ■ Programmable data frame size from 4 to 16 bits ■ Internal loopback test mode for diagnostic/debug testing ® ® 12.1 Block Diagram Figure 12-1. SSI Module Block Diagram Interrupt Interrupt Control SSIIM SSIMIS Control / Status SSICR0 SSICR1 SSISR SSIDR RxFIFO 8 x 16 System Clock Clock Prescaler Identification Registers SSIPCellID0 SSIPCellID1 SSIPCellID2 SSIPCellID3 SSIPeriphID0 SSIPeriphID1 SSIPeriphID2 SSIPeriphID3 SSIPeriphID4 SSIPeriphID5 SSIPeriphID6 SSIPeriphID7 SSICPSR Transmit / Receive Logic SSIRIS SSIICR TxFIFO 8 x 16 . . . SSITx SSIRx SSIClk SSIFss . . . 12.2 Functional Description The SSI performs serial-to-parallel conversion on data received from a peripheral device. The CPU accesses data, control, and status information. The transmit and receive paths are buffered with October 01, 2007 Preliminary 265 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) internal FIFO memories allowing up to eight 16-bit values to be stored independently in both transmit and receive modes. 12.2.1 Bit Rate Generation The SSI includes a programmable bit rate clock divider and prescaler to generate the serial output clock. Bit rates are supported to 2 MHz and higher, although maximum bit rate is determined by peripheral devices. The serial bit rate is derived by dividing down the 50-MHz input clock. The clock is first divided by an even prescale value CPSDVSR from 2 to 254, which is programmed in the SSI Clock Prescale (SSICPSR) register (see page 284). The clock is further divided by a value from 1 to 256, which is 1 + SCR, where SCR is the value programmed in the SSI Control0 (SSICR0) register (see page 277). The frequency of the output clock SSIClk is defined by: FSSIClk = FSysClk / (CPSDVSR * (1 + SCR)) Note that although the SSIClk transmit clock can theoretically be 25 MHz, the module may not be able to operate at that speed. For master mode, the system clock must be at least two times faster than the SSIClk. For slave mode, the system clock must be at least 12 times faster than the SSIClk. See “Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI)” on page 417 to view SSI timing parameters. 12.2.2 FIFO Operation 12.2.2.1 Transmit FIFO The common transmit FIFO is a 16-bit wide, 8-locations deep, first-in, first-out memory buffer. The CPU writes data to the FIFO by writing the SSI Data (SSIDR) register (see page 281), and data is stored in the FIFO until it is read out by the transmission logic. When configured as a master or a slave, parallel data is written into the transmit FIFO prior to serial conversion and transmission to the attached slave or master, respectively, through the SSITx pin. 12.2.2.2 Receive FIFO The common receive FIFO is a 16-bit wide, 8-locations deep, first-in, first-out memory buffer. Received data from the serial interface is stored in the buffer until read out by the CPU, which accesses the read FIFO by reading the SSIDR register. When configured as a master or slave, serial data received through the SSIRx pin is registered prior to parallel loading into the attached slave or master receive FIFO, respectively. 12.2.3 Interrupts The SSI can generate interrupts when the following conditions are observed: ■ Transmit FIFO service ■ Receive FIFO service ■ Receive FIFO time-out ■ Receive FIFO overrun All of the interrupt events are ORed together before being sent to the interrupt controller, so the SSI can only generate a single interrupt request to the controller at any given time. You can mask each 266 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller of the four individual maskable interrupts by setting the appropriate bits in the SSI Interrupt Mask (SSIIM) register (see page 285). Setting the appropriate mask bit to 1 enables the interrupt. Provision of the individual outputs, as well as a combined interrupt output, allows use of either a global interrupt service routine, or modular device drivers to handle interrupts. The transmit and receive dynamic dataflow interrupts have been separated from the status interrupts so that data can be read or written in response to the FIFO trigger levels. The status of the individual interrupt sources can be read from the SSI Raw Interrupt Status (SSIRIS) and SSI Masked Interrupt Status (SSIMIS) registers (see page 287 and page 288, respectively). 12.2.4 Frame Formats Each data frame is between 4 and 16 bits long, depending on the size of data programmed, and is transmitted starting with the MSB. There are three basic frame types that can be selected: ■ Texas Instruments synchronous serial ■ Freescale SPI ■ MICROWIRE For all three formats, the serial clock (SSIClk) is held inactive while the SSI is idle, and SSIClk transitions at the programmed frequency only during active transmission or reception of data. The idle state of SSIClk is utilized to provide a receive timeout indication that occurs when the receive FIFO still contains data after a timeout period. For Freescale SPI and MICROWIRE frame formats, the serial frame (SSIFss ) pin is active Low, and is asserted (pulled down) during the entire transmission of the frame. For Texas Instruments synchronous serial frame format, the SSIFss pin is pulsed for one serial clock period starting at its rising edge, prior to the transmission of each frame. For this frame format, both the SSI and the off-chip slave device drive their output data on the rising edge of SSIClk, and latch data from the other device on the falling edge. Unlike the full-duplex transmission of the other two frame formats, the MICROWIRE format uses a special master-slave messaging technique, which operates at half-duplex. In this mode, when a frame begins, an 8-bit control message is transmitted to the off-chip slave. During this transmit, no incoming data is received by the SSI. After the message has been sent, the off-chip slave decodes it and, after waiting one serial clock after the last bit of the 8-bit control message has been sent, responds with the requested data. The returned data can be 4 to 16 bits in length, making the total frame length anywhere from 13 to 25 bits. 12.2.4.1 Texas Instruments Synchronous Serial Frame Format Figure 12-2 on page 267 shows the Texas Instruments synchronous serial frame format for a single transmitted frame. Figure 12-2. TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Single Transfer) SSIClk SSIFss SSITx/SSIRx MSB 4 to 16 bits LSB October 01, 2007 Preliminary 267 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) In this mode, SSIClk and SSIFss are forced Low, and the transmit data line SSITx is tristated whenever the SSI is idle. Once the bottom entry of the transmit FIFO contains data, SSIFss is pulsed High for one SSIClk period. The value to be transmitted is also transferred from the transmit FIFO to the serial shift register of the transmit logic. On the next rising edge of SSIClk, the MSB of the 4 to 16-bit data frame is shifted out on the SSITx pin. Likewise, the MSB of the received data is shifted onto the SSIRx pin by the off-chip serial slave device. Both the SSI and the off-chip serial slave device then clock each data bit into their serial shifter on the falling edge of each SSIClk. The received data is transferred from the serial shifter to the receive FIFO on the first rising edge of SSIClk after the LSB has been latched. Figure 12-3 on page 268 shows the Texas Instruments synchronous serial frame format when back-to-back frames are transmitted. Figure 12-3. TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) SSIClk SSIFss SSITx/SSIRx MSB 4 to 16 bits LSB 12.2.4.2 Freescale SPI Frame Format The Freescale SPI interface is a four-wire interface where the SSIFss signal behaves as a slave select. The main feature of the Freescale SPI format is that the inactive state and phase of the SSIClk signal are programmable through the SPO and SPH bits within the SSISCR0 control register. SPO Clock Polarity Bit When the SPO clock polarity control bit is Low, it produces a steady state Low value on the SSIClk pin. If the SPO bit is High, a steady state High value is placed on the SSIClk pin when data is not being transferred. SPH Phase Control Bit The SPH phase control bit selects the clock edge that captures data and allows it to change state. It has the most impact on the first bit transmitted by either allowing or not allowing a clock transition before the first data capture edge. When the SPH phase control bit is Low, data is captured on the first clock edge transition. If the SPH bit is High, data is captured on the second clock edge transition. 12.2.4.3 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=0 and SPH=0 Single and continuous transmission signal sequences for Freescale SPI format with SPO=0 and SPH=0 are shown in Figure 12-4 on page 269 and Figure 12-5 on page 269. 268 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 12-4. Freescale SPI Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx MSB 4 to 16 bits SSITx MSB LSB LSB Q Note: Q is undefined. Figure 12-5. Freescale SPI Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx LSB MSB 4 to 16 bits SSITx LSB MSB LSB MSB LSB MSB In this configuration, during idle periods: ■ SSIClk is forced Low ■ SSIFss is forced High ■ The transmit data line SSITx is arbitrarily forced Low ■ When the SSI is configured as a master, it enables the SSIClk pad ■ When the SSI is configured as a slave, it disables the SSIClk pad If the SSI is enabled and there is valid data within the transmit FIFO, the start of transmission is signified by the SSIFss master signal being driven Low. This causes slave data to be enabled onto the SSIRx input line of the master. The master SSITx output pad is enabled. One half SSIClk period later, valid master data is transferred to the SSITx pin. Now that both the master and slave data have been set, the SSIClk master clock pin goes High after one further half SSIClk period. The data is now captured on the rising and propagated on the falling edges of the SSIClk signal. In the case of a single word transmission, after all bits of the data word have been transferred, the SSIFss line is returned to its idle High state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. However, in the case of continuous back-to-back transmissions, the SSIFss signal must be pulsed High between each data word transfer. This is because the slave select pin freezes the data in its serial peripheral register and does not allow it to be altered if the SPH bit is logic zero. Therefore, the master device must raise the SSIFss pin of the slave device between each data transfer to enable the serial peripheral data write. On completion of the continuous transfer, the SSIFss pin is returned to its idle state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 269 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) 12.2.4.4 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=0 and SPH=1 The transfer signal sequence for Freescale SPI format with SPO=0 and SPH=1 is shown in Figure 12-6 on page 270, which covers both single and continuous transfers. Figure 12-6. Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=0 and SPH=1 SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx Q MSB 4 to 16 bits SSITx MSB LSB LSB Q Note: Q is undefined. In this configuration, during idle periods: ■ SSIClk is forced Low ■ SSIFss is forced High ■ The transmit data line SSITx is arbitrarily forced Low ■ When the SSI is configured as a master, it enables the SSIClk pad ■ When the SSI is configured as a slave, it disables the SSIClk pad If the SSI is enabled and there is valid data within the transmit FIFO, the start of transmission is signified by the SSIFss master signal being driven Low. The master SSITx output is enabled. After a further one half SSIClk period, both master and slave valid data is enabled onto their respective transmission lines. At the same time, the SSIClk is enabled with a rising edge transition. Data is then captured on the falling edges and propagated on the rising edges of the SSIClk signal. In the case of a single word transfer, after all bits have been transferred, the SSIFss line is returned to its idle High state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. For continuous back-to-back transfers, the SSIFss pin is held Low between successive data words and termination is the same as that of the single word transfer. 12.2.4.5 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=1 and SPH=0 Single and continuous transmission signal sequences for Freescale SPI format with SPO=1 and SPH=0 are shown in Figure 12-7 on page 271 and Figure 12-8 on page 271. 270 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 12-7. Freescale SPI Frame Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx MSB 4 to 16 bits SSITx MSB LSB LSB Q Note: Q is undefined. Figure 12-8. Freescale SPI Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 SSIClk SSIFss SSITx/SSIRxLSB MSB 4 to 16 bits LSB MSB In this configuration, during idle periods: ■ SSIClk is forced High ■ SSIFss is forced High ■ The transmit data line SSITx is arbitrarily forced Low ■ When the SSI is configured as a master, it enables the SSIClk pad ■ When the SSI is configured as a slave, it disables the SSIClk pad If the SSI is enabled and there is valid data within the transmit FIFO, the start of transmission is signified by the SSIFss master signal being driven Low, which causes slave data to be immediately transferred onto the SSIRx line of the master. The master SSITx output pad is enabled. One half period later, valid master data is transferred to the SSITx line. Now that both the master and slave data have been set, the SSIClk master clock pin becomes Low after one further half SSIClk period. This means that data is captured on the falling edges and propagated on the rising edges of the SSIClk signal. In the case of a single word transmission, after all bits of the data word are transferred, the SSIFss line is returned to its idle High state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. However, in the case of continuous back-to-back transmissions, the SSIFss signal must be pulsed High between each data word transfer. This is because the slave select pin freezes the data in its serial peripheral register and does not allow it to be altered if the SPH bit is logic zero. Therefore, the master device must raise the SSIFss pin of the slave device between each data transfer to enable the serial peripheral data write. On completion of the continuous transfer, the SSIFss pin is returned to its idle state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 271 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) 12.2.4.6 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=1 and SPH=1 The transfer signal sequence for Freescale SPI format with SPO=1 and SPH=1 is shown in Figure 12-9 on page 272, which covers both single and continuous transfers. Figure 12-9. Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=1 and SPH=1 SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx Q MSB 4 to 16 bits SSITx MSB LSB LSB Q Note: Q is undefined. In this configuration, during idle periods: ■ SSIClk is forced High ■ SSIFss is forced High ■ The transmit data line SSITx is arbitrarily forced Low ■ When the SSI is configured as a master, it enables the SSIClk pad ■ When the SSI is configured as a slave, it disables the SSIClk pad If the SSI is enabled and there is valid data within the transmit FIFO, the start of transmission is signified by the SSIFss master signal being driven Low. The master SSITx output pad is enabled. After a further one-half SSIClk period, both master and slave data are enabled onto their respective transmission lines. At the same time, SSIClk is enabled with a falling edge transition. Data is then captured on the rising edges and propagated on the falling edges of the SSIClk signal. After all bits have been transferred, in the case of a single word transmission, the SSIFss line is returned to its idle high state one SSIClk period after the last bit has been captured. For continuous back-to-back transmissions, the SSIFss pin remains in its active Low state, until the final bit of the last word has been captured, and then returns to its idle state as described above. For continuous back-to-back transfers, the SSIFss pin is held Low between successive data words and termination is the same as that of the single word transfer. 12.2.4.7 MICROWIRE Frame Format Figure 12-10 on page 273 shows the MICROWIRE frame format, again for a single frame. Figure 12-11 on page 274 shows the same format when back-to-back frames are transmitted. 272 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 12-10. MICROWIRE Frame Format (Single Frame) SSIClk SSIFss SSITx SSIRx MSB LSB 8-bit control 0 MSB LSB 4 to 16 bits output data MICROWIRE format is very similar to SPI format, except that transmission is half-duplex instead of full-duplex, using a master-slave message passing technique. Each serial transmission begins with an 8-bit control word that is transmitted from the SSI to the off-chip slave device. During this transmission, no incoming data is received by the SSI. After the message has been sent, the off-chip slave decodes it and, after waiting one serial clock after the last bit of the 8-bit control message has been sent, responds with the required data. The returned data is 4 to 16 bits in length, making the total frame length anywhere from 13 to 25 bits. In this configuration, during idle periods: ■ SSIClk is forced Low ■ SSIFss is forced High ■ The transmit data line SSITx is arbitrarily forced Low A transmission is triggered by writing a control byte to the transmit FIFO. The falling edge of SSIFss causes the value contained in the bottom entry of the transmit FIFO to be transferred to the serial shift register of the transmit logic, and the MSB of the 8-bit control frame to be shifted out onto the SSITx pin. SSIFss remains Low for the duration of the frame transmission. The SSIRx pin remains tristated during this transmission. The off-chip serial slave device latches each control bit into its serial shifter on the rising edge of each SSIClk. After the last bit is latched by the slave device, the control byte is decoded during a one clock wait-state, and the slave responds by transmitting data back to the SSI. Each bit is driven onto the SSIRx line on the falling edge of SSIClk. The SSI in turn latches each bit on the rising edge of SSIClk. At the end of the frame, for single transfers, the SSIFss signal is pulled High one clock period after the last bit has been latched in the receive serial shifter, which causes the data to be transferred to the receive FIFO. Note: The off-chip slave device can tristate the receive line either on the falling edge of SSIClk after the LSB has been latched by the receive shifter, or when the SSIFss pin goes High. For continuous transfers, data transmission begins and ends in the same manner as a single transfer. However, the SSIFss line is continuously asserted (held Low) and transmission of data occurs back-to-back. The control byte of the next frame follows directly after the LSB of the received data from the current frame. Each of the received values is transferred from the receive shifter on the falling edge of SSIClk, after the LSB of the frame has been latched into the SSI. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 273 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Figure 12-11. MICROWIRE Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) SSIClk SSIFss SSITx LSB MSB LSB 8-bit control SSIRx 0 MSB LSB MSB 4 to 16 bits output data In the MICROWIRE mode, the SSI slave samples the first bit of receive data on the rising edge of SSIClk after SSIFss has gone Low. Masters that drive a free-running SSIClk must ensure that the SSIFss signal has sufficient setup and hold margins with respect to the rising edge of SSIClk. Figure 12-12 on page 274 illustrates these setup and hold time requirements. With respect to the SSIClk rising edge on which the first bit of receive data is to be sampled by the SSI slave, SSIFss must have a setup of at least two times the period of SSIClk on which the SSI operates. With respect to the SSIClk rising edge previous to this edge, SSIFss must have a hold of at least one SSIClk period. Figure 12-12. MICROWIRE Frame Format, SSIFss Input Setup and Hold Requirements tSetup=(2*tSSIClk ) tHold=tSSIClk SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx First RX data to be sampled by SSI slave 12.3 Initialization and Configuration To use the SSI, its peripheral clock must be enabled by setting the SSI bit in the RCGC1 register. For each of the frame formats, the SSI is configured using the following steps: 1. Ensure that the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register is disabled before making any configuration changes. 2. Select whether the SSI is a master or slave: a. For master operations, set the SSICR1 register to 0x0000.0000. b. For slave mode (output enabled), set the SSICR1 register to 0x0000.0004. c. For slave mode (output disabled), set the SSICR1 register to 0x0000.000C. 3. Configure the clock prescale divisor by writing the SSICPSR register. 274 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 4. Write the SSICR0 register with the following configuration: ■ Serial clock rate (SCR) ■ Desired clock phase/polarity, if using Freescale SPI mode (SPH and SPO) ■ The protocol mode: Freescale SPI, TI SSF, MICROWIRE (FRF) ■ The data size (DSS) 5. Enable the SSI by setting the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register. As an example, assume the SSI must be configured to operate with the following parameters: ■ Master operation ■ Freescale SPI mode (SPO=1, SPH=1) ■ 1 Mbps bit rate ■ 8 data bits Assuming the system clock is 20 MHz, the bit rate calculation would be: FSSIClk = FSysClk / (CPSDVSR * (1 + SCR)) 1x106 = 20x106 / (CPSDVSR * (1 + SCR)) In this case, if CPSDVSR=2, SCR must be 9. The configuration sequence would be as follows: 1. Ensure that the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register is disabled. 2. Write the SSICR1 register with a value of 0x0000.0000. 3. Write the SSICPSR register with a value of 0x0000.0002. 4. Write the SSICR0 register with a value of 0x0000.09C7. 5. The SSI is then enabled by setting the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register to 1. 12.4 Register Map Table 12-1 on page 275 lists the SSI registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to that SSI module’s base address: ■ SSI0: 0x4000.8000 Note: The SSI must be disabled (see the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register) before any of the control registers are reprogrammed. Table 12-1. SSI Register Map Offset 0x000 Name SSICR0 Type R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 Description SSI Control 0 See page 277 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 275 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Offset 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 0x018 0x01C 0x020 0xFD0 0xFD4 0xFD8 0xFDC 0xFE0 0xFE4 0xFE8 0xFEC 0xFF0 0xFF4 0xFF8 0xFFC Name SSICR1 SSIDR SSISR SSICPSR SSIIM SSIRIS SSIMIS SSIICR SSIPeriphID4 SSIPeriphID5 SSIPeriphID6 SSIPeriphID7 SSIPeriphID0 SSIPeriphID1 SSIPeriphID2 SSIPeriphID3 SSIPCellID0 SSIPCellID1 SSIPCellID2 SSIPCellID3 Type R/W R/W RO R/W R/W RO RO W1C RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0003 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0008 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0022 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0018 0x0000.0001 0x0000.000D 0x0000.00F0 0x0000.0005 0x0000.00B1 Description SSI Control 1 SSI Data SSI Status SSI Clock Prescale SSI Interrupt Mask SSI Raw Interrupt Status SSI Masked Interrupt Status SSI Interrupt Clear SSI Peripheral Identification 4 SSI Peripheral Identification 5 SSI Peripheral Identification 6 SSI Peripheral Identification 7 SSI Peripheral Identification 0 SSI Peripheral Identification 1 SSI Peripheral Identification 2 SSI Peripheral Identification 3 SSI PrimeCell Identification 0 SSI PrimeCell Identification 1 SSI PrimeCell Identification 2 SSI PrimeCell Identification 3 See page 279 281 282 284 285 287 288 289 290 291 292 293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 12.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the SSI registers, in numerical order by address offset. 276 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: SSI Control 0 (SSICR0), offset 0x000 SSICR0 is control register 0 and contains bit fields that control various functions within the SSI module. Functionality such as protocol mode, clock rate, and data size are configured in this register. SSI Control 0 (SSICR0) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 SCR Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 SPH R/W 0 RO 0 6 SPO R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 5 FRF R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 DSS R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Serial Clock Rate The value SCR is used to generate the transmit and receive bit rate of the SSI. The bit rate is: BR=FSSIClk/(CPSDVSR * (1 + SCR)) where CPSDVSR is an even value from 2-254 programmed in the SSICPSR register, and SCR is a value from 0-255. 15:8 SCR R/W 0x0000 7 SPH R/W 0 SSI Serial Clock Phase This bit is only applicable to the Freescale SPI Format. The SPH control bit selects the clock edge that captures data and allows it to change state. It has the most impact on the first bit transmitted by either allowing or not allowing a clock transition before the first data capture edge. When the SPH bit is 0, data is captured on the first clock edge transition. If SPH is 1, data is captured on the second clock edge transition. 6 SPO R/W 0 SSI Serial Clock Polarity This bit is only applicable to the Freescale SPI Format. When the SPO bit is 0, it produces a steady state Low value on the SSIClk pin. If SPO is 1, a steady state High value is placed on the SSIClk pin when data is not being transferred. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 277 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Bit/Field 5:4 Name FRF Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description SSI Frame Format Select The FRF values are defined as follows: Value Frame Format 0x0 Freescale SPI Frame Format 0x1 Texas Intruments Synchronous Serial Frame Format 0x2 MICROWIRE Frame Format 0x3 Reserved 3:0 DSS R/W 0x00 SSI Data Size Select The DSS values are defined as follows: Value Data Size 0x0-0x2 Reserved 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 0xC 0xD 0xE 0xF 4-bit data 5-bit data 6-bit data 7-bit data 8-bit data 9-bit data 10-bit data 11-bit data 12-bit data 13-bit data 14-bit data 15-bit data 16-bit data 278 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: SSI Control 1 (SSICR1), offset 0x004 SSICR1 is control register 1 and contains bit fields that control various functions within the SSI module. Master and slave mode functionality is controlled by this register. SSI Control 1 (SSICR1) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 SOD R/W 0 RO 0 2 MS R/W 0 RO 0 1 SSE R/W 0 RO 0 0 LBM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Slave Mode Output Disable This bit is relevant only in the Slave mode (MS=1). In multiple-slave systems, it is possible for the SSI master to broadcast a message to all slaves in the system while ensuring that only one slave drives data onto the serial output line. In such systems, the TXD lines from multiple slaves could be tied together. To operate in such a system, the SOD bit can be configured so that the SSI slave does not drive the SSITx pin. The SOD values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 SSI can drive SSITx output in Slave Output mode. SSI must not drive the SSITx output in Slave mode. 3 SOD R/W 0 2 MS R/W 0 SSI Master/Slave Select This bit selects Master or Slave mode and can be modified only when SSI is disabled (SSE=0). The MS values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Device configured as a master. Device configured as a slave. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 279 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Bit/Field 1 Name SSE Type R/W Reset 0 Description SSI Synchronous Serial Port Enable Setting this bit enables SSI operation. The SSE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 SSI operation disabled. SSI operation enabled. Note: This bit must be set to 0 before any control registers are reprogrammed. 0 LBM R/W 0 SSI Loopback Mode Setting this bit enables Loopback Test mode. The LBM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Normal serial port operation enabled. Output of the transmit serial shift register is connected internally to the input of the receive serial shift register. 280 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: SSI Data (SSIDR), offset 0x008 SSIDR is the data register and is 16-bits wide. When SSIDR is read, the entry in the receive FIFO (pointed to by the current FIFO read pointer) is accessed. As data values are removed by the SSI receive logic from the incoming data frame, they are placed into the entry in the receive FIFO (pointed to by the current FIFO write pointer). When SSIDR is written to, the entry in the transmit FIFO (pointed to by the write pointer) is written to. Data values are removed from the transmit FIFO one value at a time by the transmit logic. It is loaded into the transmit serial shifter, then serially shifted out onto the SSITx pin at the programmed bit rate. When a data size of less than 16 bits is selected, the user must right-justify data written to the transmit FIFO. The transmit logic ignores the unused bits. Received data less than 16 bits is automatically right-justified in the receive buffer. When the SSI is programmed for MICROWIRE frame format, the default size for transmit data is eight bits (the most significant byte is ignored). The receive data size is controlled by the programmer. The transmit FIFO and the receive FIFO are not cleared even when the SSE bit in the SSICR1 register is set to zero. This allows the software to fill the transmit FIFO before enabling the SSI. SSI Data (SSIDR) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x0000 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Receive/Transmit Data A read operation reads the receive FIFO. A write operation writes the transmit FIFO. Software must right-justify data when the SSI is programmed for a data size that is less than 16 bits. Unused bits at the top are ignored by the transmit logic. The receive logic automatically right-justifies the data. 15:0 DATA R/W 0x0000 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 281 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 4: SSI Status (SSISR), offset 0x00C SSISR is a status register that contains bits that indicate the FIFO fill status and the SSI busy status. SSI Status (SSISR) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x00C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0003 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 BSY RO 0 RO 0 3 RFF RO 0 RO 0 2 RNE RO 0 RO 0 1 TNF RO 1 RO 0 0 TFE R0 1 Bit/Field 31:5 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Busy Bit The BSY values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 SSI is idle. SSI is currently transmitting and/or receiving a frame, or the transmit FIFO is not empty. 4 BSY RO 0 3 RFF RO 0 SSI Receive FIFO Full The RFF values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Receive FIFO is not full. Receive FIFO is full. 2 RNE RO 0 SSI Receive FIFO Not Empty The RNE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Receive FIFO is empty. Receive FIFO is not empty. 1 TNF RO 1 SSI Transmit FIFO Not Full The TNF values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Transmit FIFO is full. Transmit FIFO is not full. 282 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 0 Name TFE Type R0 Reset 1 Description SSI Transmit FIFO Empty The TFE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Transmit FIFO is not empty. Transmit FIFO is empty. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 283 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 5: SSI Clock Prescale (SSICPSR), offset 0x010 SSICPSR is the clock prescale register and specifies the division factor by which the system clock must be internally divided before further use. The value programmed into this register must be an even number between 2 and 254. The least-significant bit of the programmed number is hard-coded to zero. If an odd number is written to this register, data read back from this register has the least-significant bit as zero. SSI Clock Prescale (SSICPSR) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 CPSDVSR R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Clock Prescale Divisor This value must be an even number from 2 to 254, depending on the frequency of SSIClk. The LSB always returns 0 on reads. 7:0 CPSDVSR R/W 0x00 284 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 6: SSI Interrupt Mask (SSIIM), offset 0x014 The SSIIM register is the interrupt mask set or clear register. It is a read/write register and all bits are cleared to 0 on reset. On a read, this register gives the current value of the mask on the relevant interrupt. A write of 1 to the particular bit sets the mask, enabling the interrupt to be read. A write of 0 clears the corresponding mask. SSI Interrupt Mask (SSIIM) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 TXIM R/W 0 RO 0 2 RXIM R/W 0 RO 0 1 RTIM R/W 0 RO 0 0 RORIM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Transmit FIFO Interrupt Mask The TXIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 TX FIFO half-full or less condition interrupt is masked. TX FIFO half-full or less condition interrupt is not masked. 3 TXIM R/W 0 2 RXIM R/W 0 SSI Receive FIFO Interrupt Mask The TFE values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 RX FIFO half-full or more condition interrupt is masked. RX FIFO half-full or more condition interrupt is not masked. 1 RTIM R/W 0 SSI Receive Time-Out Interrupt Mask The RTIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 RX FIFO time-out interrupt is masked. RX FIFO time-out interrupt is not masked. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 285 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Bit/Field 0 Name RORIM Type R/W Reset 0 Description SSI Receive Overrun Interrupt Mask The RORIM values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 RX FIFO overrun interrupt is masked. RX FIFO overrun interrupt is not masked. 286 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: SSI Raw Interrupt Status (SSIRIS), offset 0x018 The SSIRIS register is the raw interrupt status register. On a read, this register gives the current raw status value of the corresponding interrupt prior to masking. A write has no effect. SSI Raw Interrupt Status (SSIRIS) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0008 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 TXRIS RO 1 RO 0 2 RXRIS RO 0 RO 0 1 RTRIS RO 0 RO 0 0 RORRIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Transmit FIFO Raw Interrupt Status Indicates that the transmit FIFO is half full or less, when set. 3 TXRIS RO 1 2 RXRIS RO 0 SSI Receive FIFO Raw Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive FIFO is half full or more, when set. 1 RTRIS RO 0 SSI Receive Time-Out Raw Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive time-out has occurred, when set. 0 RORRIS RO 0 SSI Receive Overrun Raw Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive FIFO has overflowed, when set. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 287 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 8: SSI Masked Interrupt Status (SSIMIS), offset 0x01C The SSIMIS register is the masked interrupt status register. On a read, this register gives the current masked status value of the corresponding interrupt. A write has no effect. SSI Masked Interrupt Status (SSIMIS) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 TXMIS RO 0 RO 0 2 RXMIS RO 0 RO 0 1 RTMIS RO 0 RO 0 0 RORMIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Transmit FIFO Masked Interrupt Status Indicates that the transmit FIFO is half full or less, when set. 3 TXMIS RO 0 2 RXMIS RO 0 SSI Receive FIFO Masked Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive FIFO is half full or more, when set. 1 RTMIS RO 0 SSI Receive Time-Out Masked Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive time-out has occurred, when set. 0 RORMIS RO 0 SSI Receive Overrun Masked Interrupt Status Indicates that the receive FIFO has overflowed, when set. 288 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: SSI Interrupt Clear (SSIICR), offset 0x020 The SSIICR register is the interrupt clear register. On a write of 1, the corresponding interrupt is cleared. A write of 0 has no effect. SSI Interrupt Clear (SSIICR) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0x020 Type W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RTIC W1C 0 RO 0 0 RORIC W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Receive Time-Out Interrupt Clear The RTIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on interrupt. Clears interrupt. 1 RTIC W1C 0 0 RORIC W1C 0 SSI Receive Overrun Interrupt Clear The RORIC values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 No effect on interrupt. Clears interrupt. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 289 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 10: SSI Peripheral Identification 4 (SSIPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 4 (SSIPeriphID4) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register[7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID4 RO 0x00 290 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 11: SSI Peripheral Identification 5 (SSIPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 5 (SSIPeriphID5) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFD4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register[15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID5 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 291 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 12: SSI Peripheral Identification 6 (SSIPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 6 (SSIPeriphID6) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFD8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID6 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register[23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID6 RO 0x00 292 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: SSI Peripheral Identification 7 (SSIPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 7 (SSIPeriphID7) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFDC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID7 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register[31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID7 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 293 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 14: SSI Peripheral Identification 0 (SSIPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 0 (SSIPeriphID0) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0022 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register[7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID0 RO 0x22 294 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 15: SSI Peripheral Identification 1 (SSIPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 1 (SSIPeriphID1) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register [15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID1 RO 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 295 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 16: SSI Peripheral Identification 2 (SSIPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 2 (SSIPeriphID2) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register [23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID2 RO 0x18 296 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 17: SSI Peripheral Identification 3 (SSIPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The SSIPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI Peripheral Identification 3 (SSIPeriphID3) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 PID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI Peripheral ID Register [31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 7:0 PID3 RO 0x01 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 297 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 18: SSI PrimeCell Identification 0 (SSIPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The SSIPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI PrimeCell Identification 0 (SSIPCellID0) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI PrimeCell ID Register [7:0] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D 298 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 19: SSI PrimeCell Identification 1 (SSIPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The SSIPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI PrimeCell Identification 1 (SSIPCellID1) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI PrimeCell ID Register [15:8] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 299 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Register 20: SSI PrimeCell Identification 2 (SSIPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The SSIPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI PrimeCell Identification 2 (SSIPCellID2) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI PrimeCell ID Register [23:16] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 300 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 21: SSI PrimeCell Identification 3 (SSIPCellID3), offset 0xFFC The SSIPCellIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the register determine the reset value. SSI PrimeCell Identification 3 (SSIPCellID3) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 CID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SSI PrimeCell ID Register [31:24] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 301 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface 13 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) bus provides bi-directional data transfer through a two-wire design (a serial data line SDA and a serial clock line SCL), and interfaces to external I2C devices such as serial memory (RAMs and ROMs), networking devices, LCDs, tone generators, and so on. The I2C bus may also be used for system testing and diagnostic purposes in product development and manufacture. The LM3S601 microcontroller includes one I2C module, providing the ability to interact (both send and receive) with other I2C devices on the bus. Devices on the I2C bus can be designated as either a master or a slave. The Stellaris I2C module supports both sending and receiving data as either a master or a slave, and also supports the simultaneous operation as both a master and a slave. There are a total of four I2C modes: Master ® Transmit, Master Receive, Slave Transmit, and Slave Receive. The Stellaris I2C module can operate at two speeds: Standard (100 Kbps) and Fast (400 Kbps). Both the I2C master and slave can generate interrupts; the I2C master generates interrupts when a transmit or receive operation completes (or aborts due to an error) and the I2C slave generates interrupts when data has been sent or requested by a master. ® 13.1 Block Diagram Figure 13-1. I2C Block Diagram I2C Control I2CMSA I2CMCS I2CMDR Interrupt I2CMTPR I2CMIMR I2CMRIS I2CMMIS I2CMICR I2CMCR I2CSOAR I2CSCSR I2CSDR I2CSIM I2CSRIS I2CSMIS I2CSICR I2C Slave Core I C Master Core 2 I2CSCL I2CSDA I2CSCL I C I/O Select I2CSDA I2CSCL 2 I2CSDA 13.2 Functional Description I2C module is comprised of both master and slave functions which are implemented as separate peripherals. For proper operation, the SDA and SCL pins must be connected to bi-directional open-drain pads. A typical I2C bus configuration is shown in Figure 13-2 on page 303. See “I2C” on page 416 for I2C timing diagrams. 302 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 13-2. I2C Bus Configuration SCL SDA I2CSCL I2CSDA RPUP RPUP I2C Bus SCL SDA SCL SDA StellarisTM 3rd Par ty Device with I2C Interface 3rd Par ty Device with I2C Interface 13.2.1 I2C Bus Functional Overview The I2C bus uses only two signals: SDA and SCL, named I2CSDA and I2CSCL on Stellaris microcontrollers. SDA is the bi-directional serial data line and SCL is the bi-directional serial clock line. The bus is considered idle when both lines are high. Every transaction on the I2C bus is nine bits long, consisting of eight data bits and a single acknowledge bit. The number of bytes per transfer (defined as the time between a valid START and STOP condition, described in “START and STOP Conditions” on page 303) is unrestricted, but each byte has to be followed by an acknowledge bit, and data must be transferred MSB first. When a receiver cannot receive another complete byte, it can hold the clock line SCL Low and force the transmitter into a wait state. The data transfer continues when the receiver releases the clock SCL. ® 13.2.1.1 START and STOP Conditions The protocol of the I2C bus defines two states to begin and end a transaction: START and STOP. A high-to-low transition on the SDA line while the SCL is high is defined as a START condition, and a low-to-high transition on the SDA line while SCL is high is defined as a STOP condition. The bus is considered busy after a START condition and free after a STOP condition. See Figure 13-3 on page 303. Figure 13-3. START and STOP Conditions SDA SCL START condition STOP condition SDA SCL 13.2.1.2 Data Format with 7-Bit Address Data transfers follow the format shown in Figure 13-4 on page 304. After the START condition, a slave address is sent. This address is 7-bits long followed by an eighth bit, which is a data direction bit (R/S bit in the I2CMSA register). A zero indicates a transmit operation (send), and a one indicates a request for data (receive). A data transfer is always terminated by a STOP condition generated by the master, however, a master can initiate communications with another device on the bus by generating a repeated START condition and addressing another slave without first generating a STOP condition. Various combinations of receive/send formats are then possible within a single transfer. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 303 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Figure 13-4. Complete Data Transfer with a 7-Bit Address SDA MSB LSB R/S ACK MSB LSB ACK SCL 1 2 Slave add ress 7 8 9 1 2 Data 7 8 9 The first seven bits of the first byte make up the slave address (see Figure 13-5 on page 304). The eighth bit determines the direction of the message. A zero in the R/S position of the first byte means that the master will write (send) data to the selected slave, and a one in this position means that the master will receive data from the slave. Figure 13-5. R/S Bit in First Byte MSB LSB R/S Slave address 13.2.1.3 Data Validity The data on the SDA line must be stable during the high period of the clock, and the data line can only change when SCL is low (see Figure 13-6 on page 304). Figure 13-6. Data Validity During Bit Transfer on the I2C Bus SDA SCL g Data line Chan e stable of data allowed 13.2.1.4 Acknowledge All bus transactions have a required acknowledge clock cycle that is generated by the master. During the acknowledge cycle, the transmitter (which can be the master or slave) releases the SDA line. To acknowledge the transaction, the receiver must pull down SDA during the acknowledge clock cycle. The data sent out by the receiver during the acknowledge cycle must comply with the data validity requirements described in “Data Validity” on page 304. When a slave receiver does not acknowledge the slave address, SDA must be left high by the slave so that the master can generate a STOP condition and abort the current transfer. If the master device is acting as a receiver during a transfer, it is responsible for acknowledging each transfer made by the slave. Since the master controls the number of bytes in the transfer, it signals the end of data to the slave transmitter by not generating an acknowledge on the last data byte. The slave transmitter must then release SDA to allow the master to generate the STOP or a repeated START condition. 304 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 13.2.1.5 Arbitration A master may start a transfer only if the bus is idle. It's possible for two or more masters to generate a START condition within minimum hold time of the START condition. In these situations, an arbitration scheme takes place on the SDA line, while SCL is high. During arbitration, the first of the competing master devices to place a '1' (high) on SDA while another master transmits a '0' (low) will switch off its data output stage and retire until the bus is idle again. Arbitration can take place over several bits. Its first stage is a comparison of address bits, and if both masters are trying to address the same device, arbitration continues on to the comparison of data bits. 13.2.2 Available Speed Modes The I2C clock rate is determined by the parameters: CLK_PRD, TIMER_PRD, SCL_LP, and SCL_HP. where: CLK_PRD is the system clock period SCL_LP is the low phase of SCL (fixed at 6) SCL_HP is the high phase of SCL (fixed at 4) TIMER_PRD is the programmed value in the I2C Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR) register (see page 322). The I2C clock period is calculated as follows: SCL_PERIOD = 2*(1 + TIMER_PRD)*(SCL_LP + SCL_HP)*CLK_PRD For example: CLK_PRD = 50 ns TIMER_PRD = 2 SCL_LP=6 SCL_HP=4 yields a SCL frequency of: 1/T = 333 Khz Table 13-1 on page 305 gives examples of timer period, system clock, and speed mode (Standard or Fast). Table 13-1. Examples of I2C Master Timer Period versus Speed Mode System Clock Timer Period Standard Mode Timer Period Fast Mode 4 Mhz 6 Mhz 12.5 Mhz 16.7 Mhz 20 Mhz 25 Mhz 33Mhz 40Mhz 0x01 0x02 0x06 0x08 0x09 0x0C 0x10 0x13 100 Kbps 100 Kbps 89 Kbps 93 Kbps 100 Kbps 96.2 Kbps 97.1 Kbps 100 Kbps 0x01 0x02 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x04 312 Kbps 278 Kbps 333 Kbps 312 Kbps 330 Kbps 400 Kbps October 01, 2007 Preliminary 305 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface System Clock Timer Period Standard Mode Timer Period Fast Mode 50Mhz 0x18 100 Kbps 0x06 357 Kbps 13.2.3 Interrupts The I2C can generate interrupts when the following conditions are observed: ■ Master transaction completed ■ Master transaction error ■ Slave transaction received ■ Slave transaction requested There is a separate interrupt signal for the I2C master and I2C modules. While both modules can generate interrupts for multiple conditions, only a single interrupt signal is sent to the interrupt controller. 13.2.3.1 I2C Master Interrupts The I2C master module generates an interrupt when a transaction completes (either transmit or receive), or when an error occurs during a transaction. To enable the I2C master interrupt, software must write a '1' to the I2C Master Interrupt Mask (I2CMIMR) register. When an interrupt condition is met, software must check the ERROR bit in the I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS) register to verify that an error didn't occur during the last transaction. An error condition is asserted if the last transaction wasn't acknowledge by the slave or if the master was forced to give up ownership of the bus due to a lost arbitration round with another master. If an error is not detected, the application can proceed with the transfer. The interrupt is cleared by writing a '1' to the I2C Master Interrupt Clear (I2CMICR) register. If the application doesn't require the use of interrupts, the raw interrupt status is always visible via the I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status (I2CMRIS) register. 13.2.3.2 I2C Slave Interrupts The slave module generates interrupts as it receives requests from an I2C master. To enable the I2C slave interrupt, write a '1' to the I2C Slave Interrupt Mask (I2CSIMR) register. Software determines whether the module should write (transmit) or read (receive) data from the I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR) register, by checking the RREQ and TREQ bits of the I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR) register. If the slave module is in receive mode and the first byte of a transfer is received, the FBR bit is set along with the RREQ bit. The interrupt is cleared by writing a '1' to the I2C Slave Interrupt Clear (I2CSICR) register. If the application doesn't require the use of interrupts, the raw interrupt status is always visible via the I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status (I2CSRIS) register. 13.2.4 Loopback Operation The I2C modules can be placed into an internal loopback mode for diagnostic or debug work. This is accomplished by setting the LPBK bit in the I2C Master Configuration (I2CMCR) register. In loopback mode, the SDA and SCL signals from the master and slave modules are tied together. 306 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 13.2.5 Command Sequence Flow Charts This section details the steps required to perform the various I2C transfer types in both master and slave mode. 13.2.5.1 I2C Master Command Sequences The figures that follow show the command sequences available for the I2C master. Figure 13-7. Master Single SEND Idle Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Sequence may be omitted in a Single Master system Write data to I2CMDR Read I2CMCS NO BUSBSY bit=0? YES Write ---0-111 to I2CMCS Read I2CMCS NO BUSY bit=0? YES Error Service NO ERROR bit=0? YES Idle October 01, 2007 Preliminary 307 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Figure 13-8. Master Single RECEIVE Idle Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Sequence may be omitted in a Single Master system Read I2CMCS NO BUSBSY bit=0? YES Write ---00111 to I2CMCS Read I2CMCS NO BUSY bit=0? YES Error Service NO ERROR bit=0? YES Read data from I2CMDR Idle 308 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 13-9. Master Burst SEND Idle Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Sequence may be omitted in a Single Master system Read I2CMCS Write data to I2CMDR BUSY bit=0? NO Read I2CMCS YES ERROR bit=0? NO NO BUSBSY bit=0? YES YES Write data to I2CMDR NO ARBLST bit=1? Write ---0-011 to I2CMCS Write ---0-001 to I2CMCS NO YES Index=n? Write ---0-100 to I2CMCS YES Error Service Write ---0-101 to I2CMCS Idle Read I2CMCS NO BUSY bit=0? YES Error Service NO ERROR bit=0? YES Idle October 01, 2007 Preliminary 309 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Figure 13-10. Master Burst RECEIVE Idle Sequence may be omitted in a Single Master system Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Read I2CMCS Read I2CMCS BUSY bit=0? NO YES NO BUSBSY bit=0? ERROR bit=0? YES NO Write ---01011 to I2CMCS Read data from I2CMDR NO ARBLST bit=1? YES Write ---01001 to I2CMCS NO Write ---0-100 to I2CMCS Index=m-1? Error Service YES Write ---00101 to I2CMCS Idle Read I2CMCS BUSY bit=0? NO YES NO ERROR bit=0? YES Error Service Read data from I2CMDR Idle 310 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 13-11. Master Burst RECEIVE after Burst SEND Idle Master operates in Master Transmit mode STOP condition is not generated Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Write ---01011 to I2CMCS Repeated START condition is generated with changing data direction Master operates in Master Receive mode Idle October 01, 2007 Preliminary 311 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Figure 13-12. Master Burst SEND after Burst RECEIVE Idle Master operates in Master Receive mode STOP condition is not generated Write Slave Address to I2CMSA Write ---0-011 to I2CMCS Repeated START condition is generated with changing data direction Master operates in Master Transmit mode Idle 13.2.5.2 I2C Slave Command Sequences Figure 13-13 on page 313 presents the command sequence available for the I2C slave. 312 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 13-13. Slave Command Sequence Idle Write OWN Slave Address to I2CSOAR Write -------1 to I2CSCSR Read I2CSCSR NO TREQ bit=1? NO RREQ bit=1? YES FBR is also valid YES Write data to I2CSDR Read data from I2CSDR 13.3 Initialization and Configuration The following example shows how to configure the I2C module to send a single byte as a master. This assumes the system clock is 20 MHz. 1. Enable the I2C clock by writing a value of 0x0000.1000 to the RCGC1 register in the System Control module. 2. Enable the clock to the appropriate GPIO module via the RCGC2 register in the System Control module. 3. In the GPIO module, enable the appropriate pins for their alternate function using the GPIOAFSEL register. Also, be sure to enable the same pins for Open Drain operation. 4. Initialize the I2C Master by writing the I2CMCR register with a value of 0x0000.0020. 5. Set the desired SCL clock speed of 100 Kbps by writing the I2CMTPR register with the correct value. The value written to the I2CMTPR register represents the number of system clock periods in one SCL clock period. The TPR value is determined by the following equation: October 01, 2007 Preliminary 313 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface TPR = (System Clock / (2 * (SCL_LP + SCL_HP) * SCL_CLK)) - 1; TPR = (20MHz / (2 * (6 + 4) * 100000)) - 1; TPR = 9 Write the I2CMTPR register with the value of 0x0000.0009. 6. Specify the slave address of the master and that the next operation will be a Send by writing the I2CMSA register with a value of 0x0000.0076. This sets the slave address to 0x3B. 7. Place data (byte) to be sent in the data register by writing the I2CMDR register with the desired data. 8. Initiate a single byte send of the data from Master to Slave by writing the I2CMCS register with a value of 0x0000.0007 (STOP, START, RUN). 9. Wait until the transmission completes by polling the I2CMCS register ’s BUSBSY bit until it has been cleared. 13.4 I2C Register Map Table 13-2 on page 314 lists the I2C registers. All addresses given are relative to the I2C base addresses for the master and slave: ■ I2C Master 0: 0x4002.0000 ■ I2C Slave 0: 0x4002.0800 Table 13-2. Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register Map Offset I2C Master 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 0x018 0x01C 0x020 I2C Slave 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C I2CSOAR I2CSCSR I2CSDR I2CSIMR R/W RO R/W R/W 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 I2C Slave Own Address I2C Slave Control/Status I2C Slave Data I2C Slave Interrupt Mask 329 330 332 333 I2CMSA I2CMCS I2CMDR I2CMTPR I2CMIMR I2CMRIS I2CMMIS I2CMICR I2CMCR R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO RO WO R/W 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0001 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 I2C Master Slave Address I2C Master Control/Status I2C Master Data I2C Master Timer Period I2C Master Interrupt Mask I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status I2C Master Masked Interrupt Status I2C Master Interrupt Clear I2C Master Configuration 316 317 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 Name Type Reset Description See page 314 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Offset 0x010 0x014 0x018 Name I2CSRIS I2CSMIS I2CSICR Type RO RO WO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status I2C Slave Masked Interrupt Status I2C Slave Interrupt Clear See page 334 335 336 13.5 Register Descriptions (I2C Master) The remainder of this section lists and describes the I2C master registers, in numerical order by address offset. See also “Register Descriptions (I2C Slave)” on page 328. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 315 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 1: I2C Master Slave Address (I2CMSA), offset 0x000 This register consists of eight bits: seven address bits (A6-A0), and a Receive/Send bit, which determines if the next operation is a Receive (High), or Send (Low). I2C Master Slave Address (I2CMSA) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 SA RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 R/S R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C Slave Address This field specifies bits A6 through A0 of the slave address. 7:1 SA R/W 0 0 R/S R/W 0 Receive/Send The R/S bit specifies if the next operation is a Receive (High) or Send (Low). 0: Send 1: Receive 316 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS), offset 0x004 This register accesses four control bits when written, and accesses seven status bits when read. The status register consists of seven bits, which when read determine the state of the I2C bus controller. The control register consists of four bits: the RUN, START, STOP, and ACK bits. The START bit causes the generation of the START, or REPEATED START condition. The STOP bit determines if the cycle stops at the end of the data cycle, or continues on to a burst. To generate a single send cycle, the I2C Master Slave Address (I2CMSA) register is written with the desired address, the R/S bit is set to 0, and the Control register is written with ACK=X (0 or 1), STOP=1, START=1, and RUN=1 to perform the operation and stop. When the operation is completed (or aborted due an error), the interrupt pin becomes active and the data may be read from the I2CMDR register. When the I2C module operates in Master receiver mode, the ACK bit must be set normally to logic 1. This causes the I2C bus controller to send an acknowledge automatically after each byte. This bit must be reset when the I2C bus controller requires no further data to be sent from the slave transmitter. Read-Only Status Register I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 BUSBSY RO 0 RO 0 5 IDLE RO 0 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 BUSY RO 0 ARBLST DATACK ADRACK ERROR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:7 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Bus Busy This bit specifies the state of the I2C bus. If set, the bus is busy; otherwise, the bus is idle. The bit changes based on the START and STOP conditions. 6 BUSBSY RO 0 5 IDLE RO 0 I2C Idle This bit specifies the I2C controller state. If set, the controller is idle; otherwise the controller is not idle. 4 ARBLST RO 0 Arbitration Lost This bit specifies the result of bus arbitration. If set, the controller lost arbitration; otherwise, the controller won arbitration. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 317 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Bit/Field 3 Name DATACK Type RO Reset 0 Description Acknowledge Data This bit specifies the result of the last data operation. If set, the transmitted data was not acknowledged; otherwise, the data was acknowledged. 2 ADRACK RO 0 Acknowledge Address This bit specifies the result of the last address operation. If set, the transmitted address was not acknowledged; otherwise, the address was acknowledged. 1 ERROR RO 0 Error This bit specifies the result of the last bus operation. If set, an error occurred on the last operation; otherwise, no error was detected. The error can be from the slave address not being acknowledged, the transmit data not being acknowledged, or because the controller lost arbitration. 0 BUSY RO 0 I2C Busy This bit specifies the state of the controller. If set, the controller is busy; otherwise, the controller is idle. When the BUSY bit is set, the other status bits are not valid. Write-Only Control Register I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x004 Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset WO 0 15 WO 0 14 WO 0 13 WO 0 12 WO 0 11 WO 0 10 reserved Type Reset WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 9 WO 0 8 WO 0 7 WO 0 6 WO 0 5 WO 0 4 WO 0 3 ACK WO 0 WO 0 2 STOP WO 0 WO 0 1 START WO 0 WO 0 0 RUN WO 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type WO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Data Acknowledge Enable When set, causes received data byte to be acknowledged automatically by the master. See field decoding in Table 13-3 on page 319. 3 ACK WO 0 2 STOP WO 0 Generate STOP When set, causes the generation of the STOP condition. See field decoding in Table 13-3 on page 319. 318 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 1 Name START Type WO Reset 0 Description Generate START When set, causes the generation of a START or repeated START condition. See field decoding in Table 13-3 on page 319. 0 RUN WO 0 I2C Master Enable When set, allows the master to send or receive data. See field decoding in Table 13-3 on page 319. Table 13-3. Write Field Decoding for I2CMCS[3:0] Field (Sheet 1 of 3) Current I2CMSA[0] State R/S Idle 0 0 1 1 1 1 I2CMCS[3:0] ACK X a Description RUN 1 1 1 1 1 1 START condition followed by SEND (master goes to the Master Transmit state). START condition followed by a SEND and STOP condition (master remains in Idle state). START condition followed by RECEIVE operation with negative ACK (master goes to the Master Receive state). START condition followed by RECEIVE and STOP condition (master remains in Idle state). START condition followed by RECEIVE (master goes to the Master Receive state). Illegal. STOP 0 1 0 1 0 1 START 1 1 1 1 1 1 X 0 0 1 1 All other combinations not listed are non-operations. NOP. Master Transmit X X X 0 0 1 X X X X X 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 SEND operation (master remains in Master Transmit state). STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). SEND followed by STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). Repeated START condition followed by a SEND (master remains in Master Transmit state). Repeated START condition followed by SEND and STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). Repeated START condition followed by a RECEIVE operation with a negative ACK (master goes to Master Receive state). Repeated START condition followed by a SEND and STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). Repeated START condition followed by RECEIVE (master goes to Master Receive state). Illegal. 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 All other combinations not listed are non-operations. NOP. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 319 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Current I2CMSA[0] State R/S Master Receive X X X X X 1 I2CMCS[3:0] ACK 0 X 0 1 1 0 STOP 0 1 1 0 1 0 START 0 0 0 0 0 1 RUN 1 0 1 1 1 1 Description RECEIVE operation with negative ACK (master remains in Master Receive state). STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). b RECEIVE followed by STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). RECEIVE operation (master remains in Master Receive state). Illegal. Repeated START condition followed by RECEIVE operation with a negative ACK (master remains in Master Receive state). Repeated START condition followed by RECEIVE and STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). Repeated START condition followed by RECEIVE (master remains in Master Receive state). Repeated START condition followed by SEND (master goes to Master Transmit state). Repeated START condition followed by SEND and STOP condition (master goes to Idle state). 1 1 0 0 0 1 X X 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 All other combinations not listed are non-operations. NOP. a. An X in a table cell indicates the bit can be 0 or 1. b. In Master Receive mode, a STOP condition should be generated only after a Data Negative Acknowledge executed by the master or an Address Negative Acknowledge executed by the slave. 320 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: I2C Master Data (I2CMDR), offset 0x008 This register contains the data to be transmitted when in the Master Transmit state, and the data received when in the Master Receive state. I2C Master Data (I2CMDR) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DATA RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Data Transferred Data transferred during transaction. 7:0 DATA R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 321 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 4: I2C Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR), offset 0x00C This register specifies the period of the SCL clock. I2C Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 TPR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. SCL Clock Period This field specifies the period of the SCL clock. SCL_PRD = 2*(1 + TPR)*(SCL_LP + SCL_HP)*CLK_PRD where: SCL_PRD is the SCL line period (I2C clock). TPR is the Timer Period register value (range of 1 to 255). SCL_LP is the SCL Low period (fixed at 6). SCL_HP is the SCL High period (fixed at 4). 7:0 TPR R/W 0x1 322 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 5: I2C Master Interrupt Mask (I2CMIMR), offset 0x010 This register controls whether a raw interrupt is promoted to a controller interrupt. I2C Master Interrupt Mask (I2CMIMR) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 IM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt Mask This bit controls whether a raw interrupt is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, the interrupt is not masked and the interrupt is promoted; otherwise, the interrupt is masked. 0 IM R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 323 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 6: I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status (I2CMRIS), offset 0x014 This register specifies whether an interrupt is pending. I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status (I2CMRIS) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 RIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Raw Interrupt Status This bit specifies the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of the I2C master block. If set, an interrupt is pending; otherwise, an interrupt is not pending. 0 RIS RO 0 324 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 7: I2C Master Masked Interrupt Status (I2CMMIS), offset 0x018 This register specifies whether an interrupt was signaled. I2C Master Masked Interrupt Status (I2CMMIS) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 MIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Masked Interrupt Status This bit specifies the raw interrupt state (after masking) of the I2C master block. If set, an interrupt was signaled; otherwise, an interrupt has not been generated since the bit was last cleared. 0 MIS RO 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 325 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 8: I2C Master Interrupt Clear (I2CMICR), offset 0x01C This register clears the raw interrupt. I2C Master Interrupt Clear (I2CMICR) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x01C Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 IC WO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt Clear This bit controls the clearing of the raw interrupt. A write of 1 clears the interrupt; otherwise, a write of 0 has no affect on the interrupt state. A read of this register returns no meaningful data. 0 IC WO 0 326 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 9: I2C Master Configuration (I2CMCR), offset 0x020 This register configures the mode (Master or Slave) and sets the interface for test mode loopback. I2C Master Configuration (I2CMCR) I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 Offset 0x020 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 SFE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 4 MFE R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 LPBK R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C Slave Function Enable This bit specifies whether the interface may operate in Slave mode. If set, Slave mode is enabled; otherwise, Slave mode is disabled. 5 SFE R/W 0 4 MFE R/W 0 I2C Master Function Enable This bit specifies whether the interface may operate in Master mode. If set, Master mode is enabled; otherwise, Master mode is disabled and the interface clock is disabled. 3:1 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C Loopback This bit specifies whether the interface is operating normally or in Loopback mode. If set, the device is put in a test mode loopback configuration; otherwise, the device operates normally. 0 LPBK R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 327 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface 13.6 Register Descriptions (I2C Slave) The remainder of this section lists and describes the I2C slave registers, in numerical order by address offset. See also “Register Descriptions (I2C Master)” on page 315. 328 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 10: I2C Slave Own Address (I2CSOAR), offset 0x000 This register consists of seven address bits that identify the Stellaris I2C device on the I2C bus. I2C Slave Own Address (I2CSOAR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 ® reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 OAR R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:7 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. I2C Slave Own Address This field specifies bits A6 through A0 of the slave address. 6:0 OAR R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 329 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 11: I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR), offset 0x004 This register accesses one control bit when written, and three status bits when read. The read-only Status register consists of three bits: the FBR, RREQ, and TREQ bits. The First ® Byte Received (FBR) bit is set only after the Stellaris device detects its own slave address and receives the first data byte from the I2C master. The Receive Request (RREQ) bit indicates ® that the Stellaris I2C device has received a data byte from an I2C master. Read one data byte from the I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR) register to clear the RREQ bit. The Transmit Request (TREQ) bit ® indicates that the Stellaris I2C device is addressed as a Slave Transmitter. Write one data byte 2C Slave Data (I2CSDR) register to clear the TREQ bit. into the I The write-only Control register consists of one bit: the DA bit. The DA bit enables and disables the ® Stellaris I2C slave operation. Read-Only Status Register I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 FBR RO 0 RO 0 1 TREQ RO 0 RO 0 0 RREQ RO 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. First Byte Received Indicates that the first byte following the slave’s own address is received. This bit is only valid when the RREQ bit is set, and is automatically cleared when data has been read from the I2CSDR register. Note: This bit is not used for slave transmit operations. 2 FBR RO 0 1 TREQ RO 0 Transmit Request This bit specifies the state of the I2C slave with regards to outstanding transmit requests. If set, the I2C unit has been addressed as a slave transmitter and uses clock stretching to delay the master until data has been written to the I2CSDR register. Otherwise, there is no outstanding transmit request. 0 RREQ RO 0 Receive Request This bit specifies the status of the I2C slave with regards to outstanding receive requests. If set, the I2C unit has outstanding receive data from the I2C master and uses clock stretching to delay the master until the data has been read from the I2CSDR register. Otherwise, no receive data is outstanding. 330 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Write-Only Control Register I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x004 Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 DA WO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Device Active 1=Enables the I2C slave operation. 0=Disables the I2C slave operation. 0 DA WO 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 331 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 12: I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR), offset 0x008 This register contains the data to be transmitted when in the Slave Transmit state, and the data received when in the Slave Receive state. I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 DATA RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:8 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Data for Transfer This field contains the data for transfer during a slave receive or transmit operation. 7:0 DATA R/W 0x0 332 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: I2C Slave Interrupt Mask (I2CSIMR), offset 0x00C This register controls whether a raw interrupt is promoted to a controller interrupt. I2C Slave Interrupt Mask (I2CSIMR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 IM R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt Mask This bit controls whether a raw interrupt is promoted to a controller interrupt. If set, the interrupt is not masked and the interrupt is promoted; otherwise, the interrupt is masked. 0 IM R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 333 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 14: I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status (I2CSRIS), offset 0x010 This register specifies whether an interrupt is pending. I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status (I2CSRIS) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x010 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 RIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Raw Interrupt Status This bit specifies the raw interrupt state (prior to masking) of the I2C slave block. If set, an interrupt is pending; otherwise, an interrupt is not pending. 0 RIS RO 0 334 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 15: I2C Slave Masked Interrupt Status (I2CSMIS), offset 0x014 This register specifies whether an interrupt was signaled. I2C Slave Masked Interrupt Status (I2CSMIS) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 MIS RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Masked Interrupt Status This bit specifies the raw interrupt state (after masking) of the I2C slave block. If set, an interrupt was signaled; otherwise, an interrupt has not been generated since the bit was last cleared. 0 MIS RO 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 335 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register 16: I2C Slave Interrupt Clear (I2CSICR), offset 0x018 This register clears the raw interrupt. I2C Slave Interrupt Clear (I2CSICR) I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 Offset 0x018 Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 IC WO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Clear Interrupt This bit controls the clearing of the raw interrupt. A write of 1 clears the interrupt; otherwise a write of 0 has no affect on the interrupt state. A read of this register returns no meaningful data. 0 IC WO 0 336 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 14 Analog Comparators An analog comparator is a peripheral that compares two analog voltages, and provides a logical output that signals the comparison result. The LM3S601 controller provides three independent integrated analog comparators that can be configured to drive an output or generate an interrupt. Note: Not all comparators have the option to drive an output pin. See the Comparator Operating Mode tables for more information. A comparator can compare a test voltage against any one of these voltages: ■ An individual external reference voltage ■ A shared single external reference voltage ■ A shared internal reference voltage The comparator can provide its output to a device pin, acting as a replacement for an analog comparator on the board, or it can be used to signal the application via interrupts to cause it to start capturing a sample sequence. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 337 Analog Comparators 14.1 Block Diagram Figure 14-1. Analog Comparator Module Block Diagram C2C2+ -ve input +ve input Comparator 2 output +ve input (alternate) ACCTL2 ACSTAT2 interrupt reference input C1C1+ -ve input +ve input interrupt Comparator 1 output +ve input (alternate) ACCTL1 ACSTAT1 interrupt reference input C0C0+ -ve input +ve input interrupt Comparator 0 output C0o +ve input (alternate) ACCTL0 ACSTAT0 interrupt reference input interrupt Voltage Ref internal bus ACREFCTL 14.2 Functional Description Important: It is recommended that the Digital-Input enable (the GPIODEN bit in the GPIO module) for the analog input pin be disabled to prevent excessive current draw from the I/O pads. The comparator compares the VIN- and VIN+ inputs to produce an output, VOUT. VIN- < VIN+, VOUT = 1 VIN- > VIN+, VOUT = 0 As shown in Figure 14-2 on page 339, the input source for VIN- is an external input. In addition to an external input, input sources for VIN+ can be the +ve input of comparator 0 or an internal reference. 338 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 14-2. Structure of Comparator Unit -ve input +ve input 0 output CINV IntGen +ve input (alternate) 1 reference input 2 ACCTL ACSTAT internal bus A comparator is configured through two status/control registers (ACCTL and ACSTAT ). The internal reference is configured through one control register (ACREFCTL). Interrupt status and control is configured through three registers (ACMIS, ACRIS, and ACINTEN). The operating modes of the comparators are shown in the Comparator Operating Mode tables. Typically, the comparator output is used internally to generate controller interrupts. It may also be used to drive an external pin. Important: Certain register bit values must be set before using the analog comparators. The proper pad configuration for the comparator input and output pins are described in the Comparator Operating Mode tables. Table 14-1. Comparator 0 Operating Modes ACCNTL0 Comparator 0 ASRCP 00 01 10 11 VIN- VIN+ C0C0C0C0+ C0+ Vref Output C0o/C1+ C0o/C1+ C0o/C1+ Interrupt yes yes yes yes C0- reserved C0o/C1+ Table 14-2. Comparator 1 Operating Modes ACCNTL1 Comparator 1 ASRCP 00 01 10 11 VIN- VIN+ C1- C0o/C1+ C1C1C0+ Vref a Output Interrupt n/a n/a n/a n/a yes yes yes yes C1- reserved a. C0o and C1+ signals share a single pin and may only be used as one or the other. October 01, 2007 Preliminary interrupt 339 Analog Comparators Table 14-3. Comparator 2 Operating Modes ACCNTL2 Comparator 2 ASRCP 00 01 10 11 VIN- VIN+ C2C2C2C2+ C0+ Vref Output Interrupt n/a n/a n/a n/a yes yes yes yes C2- reserved 14.2.1 Internal Reference Programming The structure of the internal reference is shown in Figure 14-3 on page 340. This is controlled by a single configuration register (ACREFCTL). Table 14-4 on page 340 shows the programming options to develop specific internal reference values, to compare an external voltage against a particular voltage generated internally. Figure 14-3. Comparator Internal Reference Structure AVDD 8R R R ••• EN 15 VREF RNG 14 ••• Decoder 1 0 internal reference R R 8R Table 14-4. Internal Reference Voltage and ACREFCTL Field Values ACREFCTL Register EN Bit Value RNG Bit Value EN=0 RNG=X 0 V (GND) for any value of VREF; however, it is recommended that RNG=1 and VREF=0 for the least noisy ground reference. Output Reference Voltage Based on VREF Field Value 340 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller ACREFCTL Register EN Bit Value RNG Bit Value EN=1 RNG=0 Output Reference Voltage Based on VREF Field Value Total resistance in ladder is 32 R. V RE F = AV DD R --- -- --F - -E × ---V-R--R T V V RE F = AV DD V F + 8) (---RE---------× ---------------32 R EF = 0 .8 25 + 0 .10 3 V R E F The range of internal reference in this mode is 0.825-2.37 V. RNG=1 Total resistance in ladder is 24 R. V RE F = AV DD R --- -- --F - -E × ---V-R--R T V RE F = AV DD V (---RE-F-) --- × ----------24 VREF = 0.1375 x VREF The range of internal reference for this mode is 0.0-2.0625 V. 14.3 Initialization and Configuration The following example shows how to configure an analog comparator to read back its output value from an internal register. 1. Enable the analog comparator 0 clock by writing a value of 0x0010.0000 to the RCGC1 register in the System Control module. 2. In the GPIO module, enable the GPIO port/pin associated with C0- as a GPIO input. 3. Configure the internal voltage reference to 1.65 V by writing the ACREFCTL register with the value 0x0000.030C. 4. Configure comparator 0 to use the internal voltage reference and to not invert the output on the C0o pin by writing the ACCTL0 register with the value of 0x0000.040C. 5. Delay for some time. 6. Read the comparator output value by reading the ACSTAT0 register ’s OVAL value. Change the level of the signal input on C0- to see the OVAL value change. 14.4 Register Map Table 14-5 on page 342 lists the comparator registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to the Analog Comparator base address of 0x4003.C000. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 341 Analog Comparators Table 14-5. Analog Comparators Register Map Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x10 0x20 0x24 0x40 0x44 0x60 0x64 Name ACMIS ACRIS ACINTEN ACREFCTL ACSTAT0 ACCTL0 ACSTAT1 ACCTL1 ACSTAT2 ACCTL2 Type R/W1C RO R/W R/W RO R/W RO R/W RO R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description Analog Comparator Masked Interrupt Status Analog Comparator Raw Interrupt Status Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable Analog Comparator Reference Voltage Control Analog Comparator Status 0 Analog Comparator Control 0 Analog Comparator Status 1 Analog Comparator Control 1 Analog Comparator Status 2 Analog Comparator Control 2 See page 343 344 345 346 347 348 347 348 347 348 14.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the Analog Comparator registers, in numerical order by address offset. 342 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: Analog Comparator Masked Interrupt Status (ACMIS), offset 0x00 This register provides a summary of the interrupt status (masked) of the comparator. Analog Comparator Masked Interrupt Status (ACMIS) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x00 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 IN2 R/W1C 0 RO 0 1 IN1 R/W1C 0 RO 0 0 IN0 R/W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator 2 Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. Write 1 to this bit to clear the pending interrupt. 2 IN2 R/W1C 0 1 IN1 R/W1C 0 Comparator 1 Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. Write 1 to this bit to clear the pending interrupt. 0 IN0 R/W1C 0 Comparator 0 Masked Interrupt Status Gives the masked interrupt state of this interrupt. Write 1 to this bit to clear the pending interrupt. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 343 Analog Comparators Register 2: Analog Comparator Raw Interrupt Status (ACRIS), offset 0x04 This register provides a summary of the interrupt status (raw) of the comparator. Analog Comparator Raw Interrupt Status (ACRIS) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x04 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 IN2 RO 0 RO 0 1 IN1 RO 0 RO 0 0 IN0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator 2 Interrupt Status When set, indicates that an interrupt has been generated by comparator 2. 2 IN2 RO 0 1 IN1 RO 0 Comparator 1 Interrupt Status When set, indicates that an interrupt has been generated by comparator 1. 0 IN0 RO 0 Comparator 0 Interrupt Status When set, indicates that an interrupt has been generated by comparator 0. 344 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 3: Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable (ACINTEN), offset 0x08 This register provides the interrupt enable for the comparator. Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable (ACINTEN) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x08 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 IN2 R/W 0 RO 0 1 IN1 R/W 0 RO 0 0 IN0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator 2 Interrupt Enable When set, enables the controller interrupt from the comparator 2 output 2 IN2 R/W 0 1 IN1 R/W 0 Comparator 1 Interrupt Enable When set, enables the controller interrupt from the comparator 1 output. 0 IN0 R/W 0 Comparator 0 Interrupt Enable When set, enables the controller interrupt from the comparator 0 output. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 345 Analog Comparators Register 4: Analog Comparator Reference Voltage Control (ACREFCTL), offset 0x10 This register specifies whether the resistor ladder is powered on as well as the range and tap. Analog Comparator Reference Voltage Control (ACREFCTL) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x10 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 EN RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 8 RNG R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 VREF R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:10 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Resistor Ladder Enable The EN bit specifies whether the resistor ladder is powered on. If 0, the resistor ladder is unpowered. If 1, the resistor ladder is connected to the analog VDD. This bit is reset to 0 so that the internal reference consumes the least amount of power if not used and programmed. 9 EN R/W 0 8 RNG R/W 0 Resistor Ladder Range The RNG bit specifies the range of the resistor ladder. If 0, the resistor ladder has a total resistance of 32 R. If 1, the resistor ladder has a total resistance of 24 R. 7:4 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Resistor Ladder Voltage Ref The VREF bit field specifies the resistor ladder tap that is passed through an analog multiplexer. The voltage corresponding to the tap position is the internal reference voltage available for comparison. See Table 14-4 on page 340 for some output reference voltage examples. 3:0 VREF R/W 0x00 346 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 5: Analog Comparator Status 0 (ACSTAT0), offset 0x20 Register 6: Analog Comparator Status 1 (ACSTAT1), offset 0x40 Register 7: Analog Comparator Status 2 (ACSTAT2), offset 0x60 These registers specify the current output value of the comparator. Analog Comparator Status 0 (ACSTAT0) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x20 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 OVAL RO 0 RO 0 0 reserved RO 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator Output Value The OVAL bit specifies the current output value of the comparator. 1 OVAL RO 0 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 347 Analog Comparators Register 8: Analog Comparator Control 0 (ACCTL0), offset 0x24 Register 9: Analog Comparator Control 1 (ACCTL1), offset 0x44 Register 10: Analog Comparator Control 2 (ACCTL2), offset 0x64 These registers configure the comparator ’s input and output. Analog Comparator Control 0 (ACCTL0) Base 0x4003.C000 Offset 0x24 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 ASRCP R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 ISLVAL R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 3 ISEN R/W 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 CINV R/W 0 RO 0 0 reserved RO 0 Bit/Field 31:11 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Analog Source Positive The ASRCP field specifies the source of input voltage to the VIN+ terminal of the comparator. The encodings for this field are as follows: Value Function 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Pin value Pin value of C0+ Internal voltage reference Reserved 10:9 ASRCP R/W 0x00 8:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt Sense Level Value The ISLVAL bit specifies the sense value of the input that generates an interrupt if in Level Sense mode. If 0, an interrupt is generated if the comparator output is Low. Otherwise, an interrupt is generated if the comparator output is High. 4 ISLVAL R/W 0 348 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 3:2 Name ISEN Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Interrupt Sense The ISEN field specifies the sense of the comparator output that generates an interrupt. The sense conditioning is as follows: Value Function 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Level sense, see ISLVAL Falling edge Rising edge Either edge 1 CINV R/W 0 Comparator Output Invert The CINV bit conditionally inverts the output of the comparator. If 0, the output of the comparator is unchanged. If 1, the output of the comparator is inverted prior to being processed by hardware. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 349 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) 15 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Pulse width modulation (PWM) is a powerful technique for digitally encoding analog signal levels. High-resolution counters are used to generate a square wave, and the duty cycle of the square wave is modulated to encode an analog signal. Typical applications include switching power supplies and motor control. The Stellaris PWM module consists of three PWM generator blocks and a control block. Each PWM generator block contains one timer (16-bit down or up/down counter), two PWM comparators, a PWM signal generator, a dead-band generator, and an interrupt selector. The control block determines the polarity of the PWM signals, and which signals are passed through to the pins. Each PWM generator block produces two PWM signals that can either be independent signals (other than being based on the same timer and therefore having the same frequency) or a single pair of complementary signals with dead-band delays inserted. The output of the PWM generation blocks are managed by the output control block before being passed to the device pins. The Stellaris PWM module provides a great deal of flexibility. It can generate simple PWM signals, such as those required by a simple charge pump. It can also generate paired PWM signals with dead-band delays, such as those required by a half-H bridge driver. The three generator blocks can also generate the full six channels of gate controls required by a 3-phase inverter bridge. ® ® 15.1 Block Diagram Figure 15-1 on page 350 provides a block diagram of a Stellaris PWM module. The LM3S601 controller contains three generator blocks (PWM0, PWM1, and PWM2) and generates six independent PWM signals or three paired PWM signals with dead-band delays inserted. Figure 15-1. PWM Module Block Diagram PWMnLOAD ® zero load dir PWM Generator Block PWMnGENA PWMnGENB PWM Clock Timer PWMnCOUNT 16 Fault PWMnCMPA cmpA Comparator A PWMnCMPB PWM Generator pwma pwmb PWMnDBCTL PWMnDBRISE PWMnDBFALL PWMENABLE PWMINVERT PWMFAULT cmpB Comparator B PWMnINTEN Dead-Band Generator PWM Output Control Interrupt and Trigger Generate PWMnRIS PWMnISC Interrupt 15.2 15.2.1 Functional Description PWM Timer The timer in each PWM generator runs in one of two modes: Count-Down mode or Count-Up/Down mode. In Count-Down mode, the timer counts from the load value to zero, goes back to the load value, and continues counting down. In Count-Up/Down mode, the timer counts from zero up to the 350 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller load value, back down to zero, back up to the load value, and so on. Generally, Count-Down mode is used for generating left- or right-aligned PWM signals, while the Count-Up/Down mode is used for generating center-aligned PWM signals. The timers output three signals that are used in the PWM generation process: the direction signal (this is always Low in Count-Down mode, but alternates between Low and High in Count-Up/Down mode), a single-clock-cycle-width High pulse when the counter is zero, and a single-clock-cycle-width High pulse when the counter is equal to the load value. Note that in Count-Down mode, the zero pulse is immediately followed by the load pulse. 15.2.2 PWM Comparators There are two comparators in each PWM generator that monitor the value of the counter; when either match the counter, they output a single-clock-cycle-width High pulse. When in Count-Up/Down mode, these comparators match both when counting up and when counting down; they are therefore qualified by the counter direction signal. These qualified pulses are used in the PWM generation process. If either comparator match value is greater than the counter load value, then that comparator never outputs a High pulse. Figure 15-2 on page 351 shows the behavior of the counter and the relationship of these pulses when the counter is in Count-Down mode. Figure 15-3 on page 352 shows the behavior of the counter and the relationship of these pulses when the counter is in Count-Up/Down mode. Figure 15-2. PWM Count-Down Mode Load CompA CompB Zero Load Zero A B Dir BDown ADown October 01, 2007 Preliminary 351 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Figure 15-3. PWM Count-Up/Down Mode Load CompA CompB Zero Load Zero A B Dir BUp AUp BDown ADown 15.2.3 PWM Signal Generator The PWM generator takes these pulses (qualified by the direction signal), and generates two PWM signals. In Count-Down mode, there are four events that can affect the PWM signal: zero, load, match A down, and match B down. In Count-Up/Down mode, there are six events that can affect the PWM signal: zero, load, match A down, match A up, match B down, and match B up. The match A or match B events are ignored when they coincide with the zero or load events. If the match A and match B events coincide, the first signal, PWMA, is generated based only on the match A event, and the second signal, PWMB, is generated based only on the match B event. For each event, the effect on each output PWM signal is programmable: it can be left alone (ignoring the event), it can be toggled, it can be driven Low, or it can be driven High. These actions can be used to generate a pair of PWM signals of various positions and duty cycles, which do or do not overlap. Figure 15-4 on page 352 shows the use of Count-Up/Down mode to generate a pair of center-aligned, overlapped PWM signals that have different duty cycles. Figure 15-4. PWM Generation Example In Count-Up/Down Mode Load CompA CompB Zero PWMA PWMB In this example, the first generator is set to drive High on match A up, drive Low on match A down, and ignore the other four events. The second generator is set to drive High on match B up, drive Low on match B down, and ignore the other four events. Changing the value of comparator A 352 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller changes the duty cycle of the PWMA signal, and changing the value of comparator B changes the duty cycle of the PWMB signal. 15.2.4 Dead-Band Generator The two PWM signals produced by the PWM generator are passed to the dead-band generator. If disabled, the PWM signals simply pass through unmodified. If enabled, the second PWM signal is lost and two PWM signals are generated based on the first PWM signal. The first output PWM signal is the input signal with the rising edge delayed by a programmable amount. The second output PWM signal is the inversion of the input signal with a programmable delay added between the falling edge of the input signal and the rising edge of this new signal. This is therefore a pair of active High signals where one is always High, except for a programmable amount of time at transitions where both are Low. These signals are therefore suitable for driving a half-H bridge, with the dead-band delays preventing shoot-through current from damaging the power electronics. Figure 15-5 on page 353 shows the effect of the dead-band generator on an input PWM signal. Figure 15-5. PWM Dead-Band Generator Input PWMA PWMB Rising Edge Delay Falling Edge Delay 15.2.5 Interrupt Selector The PWM generator also takes the same four (or six) counter events and uses them to generate an interrupt. Any of these events or a set of these events can be selected as a source for an interrupt; when any of the selected events occur, an interrupt is generated. The selection of events allows the interrupt to occur at a specific position within the PWM signal. Note that interrupts are based on the raw events; delays in the PWM signal edges caused by the dead-band generator are not taken into account. 15.2.6 Synchronization Methods There is a global reset capability that can synchronously reset any or all of the counters in the PWM generators. If multiple PWM generators are configured with the same counter load value, this can be used to guarantee that they also have the same count value (this does imply that the PWM generators must be configured before they are synchronized). With this, more than two PWM signals can be produced with a known relationship between the edges of those signals since the counters always have the same values. The counter load values and comparator match values of the PWM generator can be updated in two ways. The first is immediate update mode, where a new value is used as soon as the counter reaches zero. By waiting for the counter to reach zero, a guaranteed behavior is defined, and overly short or overly long output PWM pulses are prevented. The other update method is synchronous, where the new value is not used until a global synchronized update signal is asserted, at which point the new value is used as soon as the counter reaches zero. This second mode allows multiple items in multiple PWM generators to be updated simultaneously without odd effects during the update; everything runs from the old values until a point at which they all run from the new values. The Update mode of the load and comparator match October 01, 2007 Preliminary 353 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) values can be individually configured in each PWM generator block. It typically makes sense to use the synchronous update mechanism across PWM generator blocks when the timers in those blocks are synchronized, though this is not required in order for this mechanism to function properly. 15.2.7 Fault Conditions There are two external conditions that affect the PWM block; the signal input on the Fault pin and the stalling of the controller by a debugger. There are two mechanisms available to handle such conditions: the output signals can be forced into an inactive state and/or the PWM timers can be stopped. Each output signal has a fault bit. If set, a fault input signal causes the corresponding output signal to go into the inactive state. If the inactive state is a safe condition for the signal to be in for an extended period of time, this keeps the output signal from driving the outside world in a dangerous manner during the fault condition. A fault condition can also generate a controller interrupt. Each PWM generator can also be configured to stop counting during a stall condition. The user can select for the counters to run until they reach zero then stop, or to continue counting and reloading. A stall condition does not generate a controller interrupt. 15.2.8 Output Control Block With each PWM generator block producing two raw PWM signals, the output control block takes care of the final conditioning of the PWM signals before they go to the pins. Via a single register, the set of PWM signals that are actually enabled to the pins can be modified; this can be used, for example, to perform commutation of a brushless DC motor with a single register write (and without modifying the individual PWM generators, which are modified by the feedback control loop). Similarly, fault control can disable any of the PWM signals as well. A final inversion can be applied to any of the PWM signals, making them active Low instead of the default active High. 15.3 Initialization and Configuration The following example shows how to initialize the PWM Generator 0 with a 25-KHz frequency, and with a 25% duty cycle on the PWM0 pin and a 75% duty cycle on the PWM1 pin. This example assumes the system clock is 20 MHz. 1. Enable the PWM clock by writing a value of 0x0010.0000 to the RCGC0 register in the System Control module. 2. In the GPIO module, enable the appropriate pins for their alternate function using the GPIOAFSEL register. 3. Configure the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register in the System Control module to use the PWM divide (USEPWMDIV) and set the divider (PWMDIV) to divide by 2 (000). 4. Configure the PWM generator for countdown mode with immediate updates to the parameters. ■ Write the PWM0CTL register with a value of 0x0000.0000. ■ Write the PWM0GENA register with a value of 0x0000.008C. ■ Write the PWM0GENB register with a value of 0x0000.080C. 5. Set the period. For a 25-KHz frequency, the period = 1/25,000, or 40 microseconds. The PWM clock source is 10 MHz; the system clock divided by 2. This translates to 400 clock ticks per 354 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller period. Use this value to set the PWM0LOAD register. In Count-Down mode, set the Load field in the PWM0LOAD register to the requested period minus one. ■ Write the PWM0LOAD register with a value of 0x0000.018F. 6. Set the pulse width of the PWM0 pin for a 25% duty cycle. ■ Write the PWM0CMPA register with a value of 0x0000.012B. 7. Set the pulse width of the PWM1 pin for a 75% duty cycle. ■ Write the PWM0CMPB register with a value of 0x0000.0063. 8. Start the timers in PWM generator 0. ■ Write the PWM0CTL register with a value of 0x0000.0001. 9. Enable PWM outputs. ■ Write the PWMENABLE register with a value of 0x0000.0003. 15.4 Register Map Table 15-1 on page 355 lists the PWM registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to the PWM base address of 0x4002.8000. Table 15-1. PWM Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 0x018 0x01C 0x020 0x040 0x044 0x048 0x04C 0x050 0x054 0x058 Name PWMCTL PWMSYNC PWMENABLE PWMINVERT PWMFAULT PWMINTEN PWMRIS PWMISC PWMSTATUS PWM0CTL PWM0INTEN PWM0RIS PWM0ISC PWM0LOAD PWM0COUNT PWM0CMPA Type R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO R/W1C RO R/W R/W RO R/W1C R/W RO R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description PWM Master Control PWM Time Base Sync PWM Output Enable PWM Output Inversion PWM Output Fault PWM Interrupt Enable PWM Raw Interrupt Status PWM Interrupt Status and Clear PWM Status PWM0 Control PWM0 Interrupt Enable PWM0 Raw Interrupt Status PWM0 Interrupt Status and Clear PWM0 Load PWM0 Counter PWM0 Compare A See page 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367 369 371 372 373 374 375 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 355 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Offset 0x05C 0x060 0x064 0x068 0x06C 0x070 0x080 0x084 0x088 0x08C 0x090 0x094 0x098 0x09C 0x0A0 0x0A4 0x0A8 0x0AC 0x0B0 0x0C0 0x0C4 0x0C8 0x0CC 0x0D0 0x0D4 0x0D8 0x0DC 0x0E0 0x0E4 0x0E8 0x0EC 0x0F0 Name PWM0CMPB PWM0GENA PWM0GENB PWM0DBCTL PWM0DBRISE PWM0DBFALL PWM1CTL PWM1INTEN PWM1RIS PWM1ISC PWM1LOAD PWM1COUNT PWM1CMPA PWM1CMPB PWM1GENA PWM1GENB PWM1DBCTL PWM1DBRISE PWM1DBFALL PWM2CTL PWM2INTEN PWM2RIS PWM2ISC PWM2LOAD PWM2COUNT PWM2CMPA PWM2CMPB PWM2GENA PWM2GENB PWM2DBCTL PWM2DBRISE PWM2DBFALL Type R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO R/W1C R/W RO R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W RO R/W1C R/W RO R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description PWM0 Compare B PWM0 Generator A Control PWM0 Generator B Control PWM0 Dead-Band Control PWM0 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay PWM0 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay PWM1 Control PWM1 Interrupt Enable PWM1 Raw Interrupt Status PWM1 Interrupt Status and Clear PWM1 Load PWM1 Counter PWM1 Compare A PWM1 Compare B PWM1 Generator A Control PWM1 Generator B Control PWM1 Dead-Band Control PWM1 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay PWM1 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay PWM2 Control PWM2 InterruptEnable PWM2 Raw Interrupt Status PWM2 Interrupt Status and Clear PWM2 Load PWM2 Counter PWM2 Compare A PWM2 Compare B PWM2 Generator A Control PWM2 Generator B Control PWM2 Dead-Band Control PWM2 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay PWM2 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay See page 376 377 380 383 384 385 367 369 371 372 373 374 375 376 377 380 383 384 385 367 369 371 372 373 374 375 376 377 380 383 384 385 356 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 15.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the PWM registers, in numerical order by address offset. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 357 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 1: PWM Master Control (PWMCTL), offset 0x000 This register provides master control over the PWM generation blocks. PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 GlobalSync2 GlobalSync1 GlobalSync0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Update PWM Generator 2 Same as GlobalSync0 but for PWM generator 2. 2 GlobalSync2 R/W 0 1 GlobalSync1 R/W 0 Update PWM Generator 1 Same as GlobalSync0 but for PWM generator 1. 0 GlobalSync0 R/W 0 Update PWM Generator 0 Setting this bit causes any queued update to a load or comparator register in PWM generator 0 to be applied the next time the corresponding counter becomes zero. This bit automatically clears when the updates have completed; it cannot be cleared by software. 358 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: PWM Time Base Sync (PWMSYNC), offset 0x004 This register provides a method to perform synchronization of the counters in the PWM generation blocks. Writing a bit in this register to 1 causes the specified counter to reset back to 0; writing multiple bits resets multiple counters simultaneously. The bits auto-clear after the reset has occurred; reading them back as zero indicates that the synchronization has completed. PWM Time Base Sync (PWMSYNC) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 Sync2 R/W 0 RO 0 1 Sync1 R/W 0 RO 0 0 Sync0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:3 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Reset Generator 2 Counter Performs a reset of the PWM generator 2 counter. 2 Sync2 R/W 0 1 Sync1 R/W 0 Reset Generator 1 Counter Performs a reset of the PWM generator 1 counter. 0 Sync0 R/W 0 Reset Generator 0 Counter Performs a reset of the PWM generator 0 counter. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 359 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 3: PWM Output Enable (PWMENABLE), offset 0x008 This register provides a master control of which generated PWM signals are output to device pins. By disabling a PWM output, the generation process can continue (for example, when the time bases are synchronized) without driving PWM signals to the pins. When bits in this register are set, the corresponding PWM signal is passed through to the output stage, which is controlled by the PWMINVERT register. When bits are not set, the PWM signal is replaced by a zero value which is also passed to the output stage. PWM Output Enable (PWMENABLE) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PWM5En PWM4En PWM3En PWM2En PWM1En PWM0En R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM5 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM5 signal to be passed to the device pin. 5 PWM5En R/W 0 4 PWM4En R/W 0 PWM4 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM4 signal to be passed to the device pin. 3 PWM3En R/W 0 PWM3 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM3 signal to be passed to the device pin. 2 PWM2En R/W 0 PWM2 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM2 signal to be passed to the device pin. 1 PWM1En R/W 0 PWM1 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM1 signal to be passed to the device pin. 0 PWM0En R/W 0 PWM0 Output Enable When set, allows the generated PWM0 signal to be passed to the device pin. 360 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: PWM Output Inversion (PWMINVERT), offset 0x00C This register provides a master control of the polarity of the PWM signals on the device pins. The PWM signals generated by the PWM generator are active High; they can optionally be made active Low via this register. Disabled PWM channels are also passed through the output inverter (if so configured) so that inactive channels maintain the correct polarity. PWM Output Inversion (PWMINVERT) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PWM5Inv PWM4Inv PWM3Inv PWM2Inv PWM1Inv PWM0Inv R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Invert PWM5 Signal When set, the generated PWM5 signal is inverted. 5 PWM5Inv R/W 0 4 PWM4Inv R/W 0 Invert PWM4 Signal When set, the generated PWM4 signal is inverted. 3 PWM3Inv R/W 0 Invert PWM3 Signal When set, the generated PWM3 signal is inverted. 2 PWM2Inv R/W 0 Invert PWM2 Signal When set, the generated PWM2 signal is inverted. 1 PWM1Inv R/W 0 Invert PWM1 Signal When set, the generated PWM1 signal is inverted. 0 PWM0Inv R/W 0 Invert PWM0 Signal When set, the generated PWM0 signal is inverted. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 361 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 5: PWM Output Fault (PWMFAULT), offset 0x010 This register controls the behavior of the PWM outputs in the presence of fault conditions. Both the fault input and debug events are considered fault conditions. On a fault condition, each PWM signal can either be passed through unmodified or driven Low. For outputs that are configured for pass-through, the debug event handling on the corresponding PWM generator also determines if the PWM signal continues to be generated. Fault condition control happens before the output inverter, so PWM signals driven Low on fault are inverted if the channel is configured for inversion (therefore, the pin is driven High on a fault condition). PWM Output Fault (PWMFAULT) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 Fault5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 4 Fault4 R/W 0 RO 0 3 Fault3 R/W 0 RO 0 2 Fault2 R/W 0 RO 0 1 Fault1 R/W 0 RO 0 0 Fault0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM5 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM5 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 5 Fault5 R/W 0 4 Fault4 R/W 0 PWM4 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM4 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 3 Fault3 R/W 0 PWM3 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM3 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 2 Fault2 R/W 0 PWM2 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM2 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 1 Fault1 R/W 0 PWM1 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM1 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 0 Fault0 R/W 0 PWM0 Driven Low on Fault When set, the PWM0 output signal is driven Low on a fault condition. 362 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 6: PWM Interrupt Enable (PWMINTEN), offset 0x014 This register controls the global interrupt generation capabilities of the PWM module. The events that can cause an interrupt are the fault input and the individual interrupts from the PWM generators. PWM Interrupt Enable (PWMINTEN) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 IntFault R/W 0 0 IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:17 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fault Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the fault input is asserted. 16 IntFault R/W 0 15:3 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM2 Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the PWM generator 2 block asserts an interrupt. 2 IntPWM2 R/W 0 1 IntPWM1 R/W 0 PWM1 Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the PWM generator 1 block asserts an interrupt. 0 IntPWM0 R/W 0 PWM0 Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the PWM generator 0 block asserts an interrupt. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 363 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 7: PWM Raw Interrupt Status (PWMRIS), offset 0x018 This register provides the current set of interrupt sources that are asserted, regardless of whether they cause an interrupt to be asserted to the controller. The fault interrupt is latched on detection; it must be cleared through the PWM Interrupt Status and Clear (PWMISC) register (see page 365). The PWM generator interrupts simply reflect the status of the PWM generators; they are cleared via the interrupt status register in the PWM generator blocks. Bits set to 1 indicate the events that are active; a zero bit indicates that the event in question is not active. PWM Raw Interrupt Status (PWMRIS) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 IntFault RO 0 0 IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:17 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fault Interrupt Asserted Indicates that the fault input has been asserted. 16 IntFault RO 0 15:3 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM2 Interrupt Asserted Indicates that the PWM generator 2 block is asserting its interrupt. 2 IntPWM2 RO 0 1 IntPWM1 RO 0 PWM1 Interrupt Asserted Indicates that the PWM generator 1 block is asserting its interrupt. 0 IntPWM0 RO 0 PWM0 Interrupt Asserted Indicates that the PWM generator 0 block is asserting its interrupt. 364 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 8: PWM Interrupt Status and Clear (PWMISC), offset 0x01C This register provides a summary of the interrupt status of the individual PWM generator blocks. A bit set to 1 indicates that the corresponding generator block is asserting an interrupt. The individual interrupt status registers in each block must be consulted to determine the reason for the interrupt, and used to clear the interrupt. For the fault interrupt, a write of 1 to that bit position clears the latched interrupt status. PWM Interrupt Status and Clear (PWMISC) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x01C Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 IntFault R/W1C 0 0 IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:17 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fault Interrupt Asserted Indicates if the fault input is asserting an interrupt. 16 IntFault R/W1C 0 15:3 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PWM2 Interrupt Status Indicates if the PWM generator 2 block is asserting an interrupt. 2 IntPWM2 RO 0 1 IntPWM1 RO 0 PWM1 Interrupt Status Indicates if the PWM generator 1 block is asserting an interrupt. 0 IntPWM0 RO 0 PWM0 Interrupt Status Indicates if the PWM generator 0 block is asserting an interrupt. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 365 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 9: PWM Status (PWMSTATUS), offset 0x020 This register provides the status of the Fault input signal. PWM Status (PWMSTATUS) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x020 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Fault RO 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fault Interrupt Status When set to 1, indicates the fault input is asserted. 0 Fault RO 0 366 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 10: PWM0 Control (PWM0CTL), offset 0x040 Register 11: PWM1 Control (PWM1CTL), offset 0x080 Register 12: PWM2 Control (PWM2CTL), offset 0x0C0 These registers configure the PWM signal generation blocks (PWM0CTL controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). The Register Update mode, Debug mode, Counting mode, and Block Enable mode are all controlled via these registers. The blocks produce the PWM signals, which can be either two independent PWM signals (from the same counter), or a paired set of PWM signals with dead-band delays added. The PWM0 block produces the PWM0 and PWM1 outputs, the PWM1 block produces the PWM2 and PWM3 outputs, and the PWM2 block produces the PWM4 and PWM5 outputs. PWM0 Control (PWM0CTL) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x040 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 Debug R/W 0 RO 0 1 Mode R/W 0 RO 0 0 Enable R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CmpBUpd CmpAUpd LoadUpd R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator B Update Mode Same as CmpAUpd but for the comparator B register. 5 CmpBUpd R/W 0 4 CmpAUpd R/W 0 Comparator A Update Mode The Update mode for the comparator A register. If 0, updates to the register are reflected to the comparator the next time the counter is 0. If 1, updates to the register are delayed until the next time the counter is 0 after a synchronous update has been requested through the PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) register (see page 358). 3 LoadUpd R/W 0 Load Register Update Mode The Update mode for the load register. If 0, updates to the register are reflected to the counter the next time the counter is 0. If 1, updates to the register are delayed until the next time the counter is 0 after a synchronous update has been requested through the PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) register. 2 Debug R/W 0 Debug Mode The behavior of the counter in Debug mode. If 0, the counter stops running when it next reaches 0, and continues running again when no longer in Debug mode. If 1, the counter always runs. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 367 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Bit/Field 1 Name Mode Type R/W Reset 0 Description Counter Mode The mode for the counter. If 0, the counter counts down from the load value to 0 and then wraps back to the load value (Count-Down mode). If 1, the counter counts up from 0 to the load value, back down to 0, and then repeats (Count-Up/Down mode). 0 Enable R/W 0 PWM Block Enable Master enable for the PWM generation block. If 0, the entire block is disabled and not clocked. If 1, the block is enabled and produces PWM signals. 368 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 13: PWM0 Interrupt Enable (PWM0INTEN), offset 0x044 Register 14: PWM1 Interrupt Enable (PWM1INTEN), offset 0x084 Register 15: PWM2 InterruptEnable (PWM2INTEN), offset 0x0C4 These registers control the interrupt generation capabilities of the PWM generators (PWM0INTEN controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). The events that can cause an interrupt are: ■ The counter being equal to the load register ■ The counter being equal to zero ■ The counter being equal to the comparator A register while counting up ■ The counter being equal to the comparator A register while counting down ■ The counter being equal to the comparator B register while counting up ■ The counter being equal to the comparator B register while counting down Any combination of these events can generate either an interrupt. PWM0 Interrupt Enable (PWM0INTEN) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x044 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad IntCntZero R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt for Counter=Comparator B Down When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter matches the comparator B value and the counter is counting down. 5 IntCmpBD R/W 0 4 IntCmpBU R/W 0 Interrupt for Counter=Comparator B Up When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter matches the comparator B value and the counter is counting up. 3 IntCmpAD R/W 0 Interrupt for Counter=Comparator A Down When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter matches the comparator A value and the counter is counting down. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 369 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Bit/Field 2 Name IntCmpAU Type R/W Reset 0 Description Interrupt for Counter=Comparator A Up When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter matches the comparator A value and the counter is counting up. 1 IntCntLoad R/W 0 Interrupt for Counter=Load When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter matches the PWMnLOAD register. 0 IntCntZero R/W 0 Interrupt for Counter=0 When 1, an interrupt occurs when the counter is 0. 370 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 16: PWM0 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM0RIS), offset 0x048 Register 17: PWM1 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM1RIS), offset 0x088 Register 18: PWM2 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM2RIS), offset 0x0C8 These registers provide the current set of interrupt sources that are asserted, regardless of whether they cause an interrupt to be asserted to the controller (PWM0RIS controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). Bits set to 1 indicate the latched events that have occurred; a 0 bit indicates that the event in question has not occurred. PWM0 Raw Interrupt Status (PWM0RIS) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x048 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad IntCntZero RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator B Down Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator B value while counting down. 5 IntCmpBD RO 0 4 IntCmpBU RO 0 Comparator B Up Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator B value while counting up. 3 IntCmpAD RO 0 Comparator A Down Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator A value while counting down. 2 IntCmpAU RO 0 Comparator A Up Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator A value while counting up. 1 IntCntLoad RO 0 Counter=Load Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched the PWMnLOAD register. 0 IntCntZero RO 0 Counter=0 Interrupt Status Indicates that the counter has matched 0. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 371 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 19: PWM0 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM0ISC), offset 0x04C Register 20: PWM1 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM1ISC), offset 0x08C Register 21: PWM2 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM2ISC), offset 0x0CC These registers provide the current set of interrupt sources that are asserted to the controller (PWM0ISC controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). Bits set to 1 indicate the latched events that have occurred; a 0 bit indicates that the event in question has not occurred. These are R/W1C registers; writing a 1 to a bit position clears the corresponding interrupt reason. PWM0 Interrupt Status and Clear (PWM0ISC) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x04C Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad IntCntZero R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:6 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator B Down Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator B value while counting down. 5 IntCmpBD R/W1C 0 4 IntCmpBU R/W1C 0 Comparator B Up Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator B value while counting up. 3 IntCmpAD R/W1C 0 Comparator A Down Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator A value while counting down. 2 IntCmpAU R/W1C 0 Comparator A Up Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched the comparator A value while counting up. 1 IntCntLoad R/W1C 0 Counter=Load Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched the PWMnLOAD register. 0 IntCntZero R/W1C 0 Counter=0 Interrupt Indicates that the counter has matched 0. 372 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 22: PWM0 Load (PWM0LOAD), offset 0x050 Register 23: PWM1 Load (PWM1LOAD), offset 0x090 Register 24: PWM2 Load (PWM2LOAD), offset 0x0D0 These registers contain the load value for the PWM counter (PWM0LOAD controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). Based on the counter mode, either this value is loaded into the counter after it reaches zero, or it is the limit of up-counting after which the counter decrements back to zero. If the Load Value Update mode is immediate, this value is used the next time the counter reaches zero; if the mode is synchronous, it is used the next time the counter reaches zero after a synchronous update has been requested through the PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) register (see page 358). If this register is re-written before the actual update occurs, the previous value is never used and is lost. PWM0 Load (PWM0LOAD) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x050 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Load Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Counter Load Value The counter load value. 15:0 Load R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 373 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 25: PWM0 Counter (PWM0COUNT), offset 0x054 Register 26: PWM1 Counter (PWM1COUNT), offset 0x094 Register 27: PWM2 Counter (PWM2COUNT), offset 0x0D4 These registers contain the current value of the PWM counter (PWM0COUNT is the value of the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). When this value matches the load register, a pulse is output; this can drive the generation of a PWM signal (via the PWMnGENA/PWMnGENB registers, see page 377 and page 380) or drive an interrupt (via the PWMnINTEN register, see page 369). A pulse with the same capabilities is generated when this value is zero. PWM0 Counter (PWM0COUNT) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x054 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Count Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Counter Value The current value of the counter. 15:0 Count RO 0x00 374 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 28: PWM0 Compare A (PWM0CMPA), offset 0x058 Register 29: PWM1 Compare A (PWM1CMPA), offset 0x098 Register 30: PWM2 Compare A (PWM2CMPA), offset 0x0D8 These registers contain a value to be compared against the counter (PWM0CMPA controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). When this value matches the counter, a pulse is output; this can drive the generation of a PWM signal (via the PWMnGENA/PWMnGENB registers) or drive an interrupt (via the PWMnINTEN register). If the value of this register is greater than the PWMnLOAD register (see page 373), then no pulse is ever output. If the comparator A update mode is immediate (based on the CmpAUpd bit in the PWMnCTL register), then this 16-bit CompA value is used the next time the counter reaches zero. If the update mode is synchronous, it is used the next time the counter reaches zero after a synchronous update has been requested through the PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) register (see page 358). If this register is rewritten before the actual update occurs, the previous value is never used and is lost. PWM0 Compare A (PWM0CMPA) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x058 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 CompA Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator A Value The value to be compared against the counter. 15:0 CompA R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 375 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 31: PWM0 Compare B (PWM0CMPB), offset 0x05C Register 32: PWM1 Compare B (PWM1CMPB), offset 0x09C Register 33: PWM2 Compare B (PWM2CMPB), offset 0x0DC These registers contain a value to be compared against the counter (PWM0CMPB controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). When this value matches the counter, a pulse is output; this can drive the generation of a PWM signal (via the PWMnGENA/PWMnGENB registers) or drive an interrupt (via the PWMnINTEN register). If the value of this register is greater than the PWMnLOAD register, then no pulse is ever output. IF the comparator B update mode is immediate (based on the CmpBUpd bit in the PWMnCTL register), then this 16-bit CompB value is used the next time the counter reaches zero. If the update mode is synchronous, it is used the next time the counter reaches zero after a synchronous update has been requested through the PWM Master Control (PWMCTL) register (see page 358). If this register is rewritten before the actual update occurs, the previous value is never used and is lost. PWM0 Compare B (PWM0CMPB) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x05C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 CompB Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Bit/Field 31:16 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Comparator B Value The value to be compared against the counter. 15:0 CompB R/W 0x00 376 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 34: PWM0 Generator A Control (PWM0GENA), offset 0x060 Register 35: PWM1 Generator A Control (PWM1GENA), offset 0x0A0 Register 36: PWM2 Generator A Control (PWM2GENA), offset 0x0E0 These registers control the generation of the PWMnA signal based on the load and zero output pulses from the counter, as well as the compare A and compare B pulses from the comparators (PWM0GENA controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). When the counter is running in Count-Down mode, only four of these events occur; when running in Count-Up/Down mode, all six occur. These events provide great flexibility in the positioning and duty cycle of the PWM signal that is produced. The PWM0GENA register controls generation of the PWM0A signal; PWM1GENA, the PWM1A signal; and PWM2GENA, the PWM2A signal. If a zero or load event coincides with a compare A or compare B event, the zero or load action is taken and the compare A or compare B action is ignored. If a compare A event coincides with a compare B event, the compare A action is taken and the compare B action is ignored. PWM0 Generator A Control (PWM0GENA) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x060 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 ActLoad R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 ActZero R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ActCmpBD R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpBU R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpAD R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpAU R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:12 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Action for Comparator B Down The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator B while counting down. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 11:10 ActCmpBD R/W 0x0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 377 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Bit/Field 9:8 Name ActCmpBU Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Action for Comparator B Up The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator B while counting up. Occurs only when the Mode bit in the PWMnCTL register (see page 367) is set to 1. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 7:6 ActCmpAD R/W 0x0 Action for Comparator A Down The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator A while counting down. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 5:4 ActCmpAU R/W 0x0 Action for Comparator A Up The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator A while counting up. Occurs only when the Mode bit in the PWMnCTL register is set to 1. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 3:2 ActLoad R/W 0x0 Action for Counter=Load The action to be taken when the counter matches the load value. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 378 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 1:0 Name ActZero Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Action for Counter=0 The action to be taken when the counter is zero. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 379 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 37: PWM0 Generator B Control (PWM0GENB), offset 0x064 Register 38: PWM1 Generator B Control (PWM1GENB), offset 0x0A4 Register 39: PWM2 Generator B Control (PWM2GENB), offset 0x0E4 These registers control the generation of the PWMnB signal based on the load and zero output pulses from the counter, as well as the compare A and compare B pulses from the comparators (PWM0GENB controls the PWM generator 0 block, and so on). When the counter is running in Down mode, only four of these events occur; when running in Up/Down mode, all six occur. These events provide great flexibility in the positioning and duty cycle of the PWM signal that is produced. The PWM0GENB register controls generation of the PWM0B signal; PWM1GENB, the PWM1B signal; and PWM2GENB, the PWM2B signal. If a zero or load event coincides with a compare A or compare B event, the zero or load action is taken and the compare A or compare B action is ignored. If a compare A event coincides with a compare B event, the compare B action is taken and the compare A action is ignored. PWM0 Generator B Control (PWM0GENB) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x064 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 ActLoad R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 ActZero R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ActCmpBD R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpBU R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpAD R/W 0 R/W 0 ActCmpAU R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:12 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Action for Comparator B Down The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator B while counting down. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 11:10 ActCmpBD R/W 0x0 380 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Bit/Field 9:8 Name ActCmpBU Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Action for Comparator B Up The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator B while counting up. Occurs only when the Mode bit in the PWMnCTL register is set to 1. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 7:6 ActCmpAD R/W 0x0 Action for Comparator A Down The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator A while counting down. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 5:4 ActCmpAU R/W 0x0 Action for Comparator A Up The action to be taken when the counter matches comparator A while counting up. Occurs only when the Mode bit in the PWMnCTL register is set to 1. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 3:2 ActLoad R/W 0x0 Action for Counter=Load The action to be taken when the counter matches the load value. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 381 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Bit/Field 1:0 Name ActZero Type R/W Reset 0x0 Description Action for Counter=0 The action to be taken when the counter is 0. The table below defines the effect of the event on the output signal. Value Description 0x0 Do nothing. 0x1 Invert the output signal. 0x2 Set the output signal to 0. 0x3 Set the output signal to 1. 382 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 40: PWM0 Dead-Band Control (PWM0DBCTL), offset 0x068 Register 41: PWM1 Dead-Band Control (PWM1DBCTL), offset 0x0A8 Register 42: PWM2 Dead-Band Control (PWM2DBCTL), offset 0x0E8 The PWM0DBCTL register controls the dead-band generator, which produces the PWM0 and PWM1 signals based on the PWM0A and PWM0B signals. When disabled, the PWM0A signal passes through to the PWM0 signal and the PWM0B signal passes through to the PWM1 signal. When enabled and inverting the resulting waveform, the PWM0B signal is ignored; the PWM0 signal is generated by delaying the rising edge(s) of the PWM0A signal by the value in the PWM0DBRISE register (see page 384), and the PWM1 signal is generated by delaying the falling edge(s) of the PWM0A signal by the value in the PWM0DBFALL register (see page 385). In a similar manner, PWM2 and PWM3 are produced from the PWM1A and PWM1B signals, and PWM4 and PWM5 are produced from the PWM2A and PWM2B signals. PWM0 Dead-Band Control (PWM0DBCTL) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x068 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 Enable R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:1 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Dead-Band Generator Enable When set, the dead-band generator inserts dead bands into the output signals; when clear, it simply passes the PWM signals through. 0 Enable R/W 0 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 383 Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Register 43: PWM0 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM0DBRISE), offset 0x06C Register 44: PWM1 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM1DBRISE), offset 0x0AC Register 45: PWM2 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM2DBRISE), offset 0x0EC The PWM0DBRISE register contains the number of clock ticks to delay the rising edge of the PWM0A signal when generating the PWM0 signal. If the dead-band generator is disabled through the PWMnDBCTL register, the PWM0DBRISE register is ignored. If the value of this register is larger than the width of a High pulse on the input PWM signal, the rising-edge delay consumes the entire High time of the signal, resulting in no High time on the output. Care must be taken to ensure that the input High time always exceeds the rising-edge delay. In a similar manner, PWM2 is generated from PWM1A with its rising edge delayed and PWM4 is produced from PWM2A with its rising edge delayed. PWM0 Dead-Band Rising-Edge Delay (PWM0DBRISE) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x06C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RiseDelay R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:12 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Dead-Band Rise Delay The number of clock ticks to delay the rising edge. 11:0 RiseDelay R/W 0 384 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 46: PWM0 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM0DBFALL), offset 0x070 Register 47: PWM1 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM1DBFALL), offset 0x0B0 Register 48: PWM2 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM2DBFALL), offset 0x0F0 The PWM0DBFALL register contains the number of clock ticks to delay the falling edge of the PWM0A signal when generating the PWM1 signal. If the dead-band generator is disabled, this register is ignored. If the value of this register is larger than the width of a Low pulse on the input PWM signal, the falling-edge delay consumes the entire Low time of the signal, resulting in no Low time on the output. Care must be taken to ensure that the input Low time always exceeds the falling-edge delay. In a similar manner, PWM3 is generated from PWM1A with its falling edge delayed and PWM5 is produced from PWM2A with its falling edge delayed. PWM0 Dead-Band Falling-Edge-Delay (PWM0DBFALL) Base 0x4002.8000 Offset 0x070 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 FallDelay RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:12 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Dead-Band Fall Delay The number of clock ticks to delay the falling edge. 11:0 FallDelay R/W 0x00 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 385 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) 16 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) A quadrature encoder, also known as a 2-channel incremental encoder, converts linear displacement into a pulse signal. By monitoring both the number of pulses and the relative phase of the two signals, you can track the position, direction of rotation, and speed. In addition, a third channel, or index signal, can be used to reset the position counter. The Stellaris quadrature encoder interface (QEI) module interprets the code produced by a quadrature encoder wheel to integrate position over time and determine direction of rotation. In addition, it can capture a running estimate of the velocity of the encoder wheel. The Stellaris quadrature encoder has the following features: ■ Position integrator that tracks the encoder position ■ Velocity capture using built-in timer ■ Interrupt generation on: – Index pulse – Velocity-timer expiration – Direction change – Quadrature error detection ® ® 16.1 Block Diagram Figure 16-1 on page 386 provides a block diagram of a Stellaris QEI module. Figure 16-1. QEI Block Diagram QEILOAD ® Control & Status QEICTL QEISTAT Velocity Timer QEITIME Velocity Accumulator Velocity Predivider PhA PhB IDX QEIINTEN QEICOUNT QEISPEED clk QEIMAXPOS Quadrature Encoder dir Position Integrator QEIPOS Interrupt Control QEIRIS QEIISC Interrupt 386 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 16.2 Functional Description The QEI module interprets the two-bit gray code produced by a quadrature encoder wheel to integrate position over time and determine direction of rotation. In addition, it can capture a running estimate of the velocity of the encoder wheel. The position integrator and velocity capture can be independently enabled, though the position integrator must be enabled before the velocity capture can be enabled. The two phase signals, PhA and PhB, can be swapped before being interpreted by the QEI module to change the meaning of forward and backward, and to correct for miswiring of the system. Alternatively, the phase signals can be interpreted as a clock and direction signal as output by some encoders. The QEI module supports two modes of signal operation: quadrature phase mode and clock/direction mode. In quadrature phase mode, the encoder produces two clocks that are 90 degrees out of phase; the edge relationship is used to determine the direction of rotation. In clock/direction mode, the encoder produces a clock signal to indicate steps and a direction signal to indicate the direction of rotation. This mode is determined by the SigMode bit of the QEI Control (QEICTL) register (see page 391). When the QEI module is set to use the quadrature phase mode (SigMode bit equals zero), the capture mode for the position integrator can be set to update the position counter on every edge of the PhA signal or to update on every edge of both PhA and PhB. Updating the position counter on every PhA and PhB provides more positional resolution at the cost of less range in the positional counter. When edges on PhA lead edges on PhB , the position counter is incremented. When edges on PhB lead edges on PhA , the position counter is decremented. When a rising and falling edge pair is seen on one of the phases without any edges on the other, the direction of rotation has changed. The positional counter is automatically reset on one of two conditions: sensing the index pulse or reaching the maximum position value. Which mode is determined by the ResMode bit of the QEI Control (QEICTL) register. When ResMode is 0, the positional counter is reset when the index pulse is sensed. This limits the positional counter to the values [0:N-1], where N is the number of phase edges in a full revolution of the encoder wheel. The QEIMAXPOS register must be programmed with N-1 so that the reverse direction from position 0 can move the position counter to N-1. In this mode, the position register contains the absolute position of the encoder relative to the index (or home) position once an index pulse has been seen. When ResMode is 1, the positional counter is constrained to the range [0:M], where M is the programmable maximum value. The index pulse is ignored by the positional counter in this mode. The velocity capture has a configurable timer and a count register. It counts the number of phase edges (using the same configuration as for the position integrator) in a given time period. The edge count from the previous time period is available to the controller via the QEISPEED register, while the edge count for the current time period is being accumulated in the QEICOUNT register. As soon as the current time period is complete, the total number of edges counted in that time period is made available in the QEISPEED register (losing the previous value), the QEICOUNT is reset to 0, and counting commences on a new time period. The number of edges counted in a given time period is directly proportional to the velocity of the encoder. Figure 16-2 on page 388 shows how the Stellaris quadrature encoder converts the phase input signals into clock pulses, the direction signal, and how the velocity predivider operates (in Divide by 4 mode). ® October 01, 2007 Preliminary 387 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Figure 16-2. Quadrature Encoder and Velocity Predivider Operation PhA PhB clk clkdiv dir pos rel -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 +1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 +1 +1 +1 The period of the timer is configurable by specifying the load value for the timer in the QEILOAD register. When the timer reaches zero, an interrupt can be triggered, and the hardware reloads the timer with the QEILOAD value and continues to count down. At lower encoder speeds, a longer timer period is needed to be able to capture enough edges to have a meaningful result. At higher encoder speeds, both a shorter timer period and/or the velocity predivider can be used. The following equation converts the velocity counter value into an rpm value: rpm = (clock * (2 ^ VelDiv) * Speed * 60) ÷ (Load * ppr * edges) where: clock is the controller clock rate ppr is the number of pulses per revolution of the physical encoder edges is 2 or 4, based on the capture mode set in the QEICTL register (2 for CapMode set to 0 and 4 for CapMode set to 1) For example, consider a motor running at 600 rpm. A 2048 pulse per revolution quadrature encoder is attached to the motor, producing 8192 phase edges per revolution. With a velocity predivider of ÷1 (VelDiv set to 0) and clocking on both PhA and PhB edges, this results in 81,920 pulses per second (the motor turns 10 times per second). If the timer were clocked at 10,000 Hz, and the load value was 2,500 (¼ of a second), it would count 20,480 pulses per update. Using the above equation: rpm = (10000 * 1 * 20480 * 60) ÷ (2500 * 2048 * 4) = 600 rpm Now, consider that the motor is sped up to 3000 rpm. This results in 409,600 pulses per second, or 102,400 every ¼ of a second. Again, the above equation gives: rpm = (10000 * 1 * 102400 * 60) ÷ (2500 * 2048 * 4) = 3000 rpm Care must be taken when evaluating this equation since intermediate values may exceed the capacity of a 32-bit integer. In the above examples, the clock is 10,000 and the divider is 2,500; both could be predivided by 100 (at compile time if they are constants) and therefore be 100 and 25. In fact, if they were compile-time constants, they could also be reduced to a simple multiply by 4, cancelled by the ÷4 for the edge-count factor. Important: Reducing constant factors at compile time is the best way to control the intermediate values of this equation, as well as reducing the processing requirement of computing this equation. The division can be avoided by selecting a timer load value such that the divisor is a power of 2; a simple shift can therefore be done in place of the division. For encoders with a power of 2 pulses per revolution, this is a simple matter of selecting a power of 2 load value. For other encoders, a load value must be selected such that the product is very close to a power of two. For example, a 100 pulse per revolution encoder could use a load value of 82, resulting in 32,800 as the divisor, 388 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller which is 0.09% above 214; in this case a shift by 15 would be an adequate approximation of the divide in most cases. If absolute accuracy were required, the controller ’s divide instruction could be used. The QEI module can produce a controller interrupt on several events: phase error, direction change, reception of the index pulse, and expiration of the velocity timer. Standard masking, raw interrupt status, interrupt status, and interrupt clear capabilities are provided. 16.3 Initialization and Configuration The following example shows how to configure the Quadrature Encoder module to read back an absolute position: 1. Enable the QEI clock by writing a value of 0x0000.0100 to the RCGC1 register in the System Control module. 2. In the GPIO module, enable the appropriate pins for their alternate function using the GPIOAFSEL register. 3. Configure the quadrature encoder to capture edges on both signals and maintain an absolute position by resetting on index pulses. Using a 1000-line encoder at four edges per line, there are 4000 pulses per revolution; therefore, set the maximum position to 3999 (0xF9F) since the count is zero-based. ■ Write the QEICTL register with the value of 0x0000.0018. ■ Write the QEIMAXPOS register with the value of 0x0000.0F9F. 4. Enable the quadrature encoder by setting bit 0 of the QEICTL register. 5. Delay for some time. 6. Read the encoder position by reading the QEIPOS register value. 16.4 Register Map Table 16-1 on page 389 lists the QEI registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register ’s address, relative to the module’s base address: ■ QEI0: 0x4002.C000 Table 16-1. QEI Register Map Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 Name QEICTL QEISTAT QEIPOS QEIMAXPOS QEILOAD QEITIME Type R/W RO R/W R/W R/W RO Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description QEI Control QEI Status QEI Position QEI Maximum Position QEI Timer Load QEI Timer See page 391 393 394 395 396 397 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 389 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Offset 0x018 0x01C 0x020 0x024 0x028 Name QEICOUNT QEISPEED QEIINTEN QEIRIS QEIISC Type RO RO R/W RO R/W1C Reset 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 0x0000.0000 Description QEI Velocity Counter QEI Velocity QEI Interrupt Enable QEI Raw Interrupt Status QEI Interrupt Status and Clear See page 398 399 400 401 402 16.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the QEI registers, in numerical order by address offset. 390 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 1: QEI Control (QEICTL), offset 0x000 This register contains the configuration of the QEI module. Separate enables are provided for the quadrature encoder and the velocity capture blocks; the quadrature encoder must be enabled in order to capture the velocity, but the velocity does not need to be captured in applications that do not need it. The phase signal interpretation, phase swap, Position Update mode, Position Reset mode, and velocity predivider are all set via this register. QEI Control (QEICTL) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 STALLEN R/W 0 RO 0 11 INVI R/W 0 RO 0 10 INVB R/W 0 RO 0 9 INVA R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 VelDiv R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 VelEn R/W 0 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 Swap R/W 0 RO 0 0 Enable R/W 0 ResMode CapMode SigMode R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:13 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Stall QEI When set, the QEI stalls when the microcontroller asserts Halt. 12 STALLEN R/W 0 11 INVI R/W 0 Invert Index Pulse When set , the input Index Pulse is inverted. 10 INVB R/W 0 Invert PhB When set, the PhB input is inverted. 9 INVA R/W 0 Invert PhA When set, the PhA input is inverted. 8:6 VelDiv R/W 0x0 Predivide Velocity A predivider of the input quadrature pulses before being applied to the QEICOUNT accumulator. This field can be set to the following values: Value Predivider 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 ÷1 ÷2 ÷4 ÷8 ÷16 ÷32 ÷64 ÷128 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 391 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Bit/Field 5 Name VelEn Type R/W Reset 0 Description Capture Velocity When set, enables capture of the velocity of the quadrature encoder. 4 ResMode R/W 0 Reset Mode The Reset mode for the position counter. When 0, the position counter is reset when it reaches the maximum; when 1, the position counter is reset when the index pulse is captured. 3 CapMode R/W 0 Capture Mode The Capture mode defines the phase edges that are counted in the position. When 0, only the PhA edges are counted; when 1, the PhA and PhB edges are counted, providing twice the positional resolution but half the range. 2 SigMode R/W 0 Signal Mode When 1, the PhA and PhB signals are clock and direction; when 0, they are quadrature phase signals. 1 Swap R/W 0 Swap Signals Swaps the PhA and PhB signals. 0 Enable R/W 0 Enable QEI Enables the quadrature encoder module. 392 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 2: QEI Status (QEISTAT), offset 0x004 This register provides status about the operation of the QEI module. QEI Status (QEISTAT) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 Direction RO 0 0 Error RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field 31:2 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Direction of Rotation Indicates the direction the encoder is rotating. The Direction values are defined as follows: Value Description 0 1 Forward rotation Reverse rotation 1 Direction RO 0 0 Error RO 0 Error Detected Indicates that an error was detected in the gray code sequence (that is, both signals changing at the same time). October 01, 2007 Preliminary 393 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Register 3: QEI Position (QEIPOS), offset 0x008 This register contains the current value of the position integrator. Its value is updated by inputs on the QEI phase inputs, and can be set to a specific value by writing to it. QEI Position (QEIPOS) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Position Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 Position Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name Position Type R/W Reset 0x00 Description Current Position Integrator Value The current value of the position integrator. 394 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 4: QEI Maximum Position (QEIMAXPOS), offset 0x00C This register contains the maximum value of the position integrator. When moving forward, the position register resets to zero when it increments past this value. When moving backward, the position register resets to this value when it decrements from zero. QEI Maximum Position (QEIMAXPOS) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 MaxPos Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 MaxPos Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name MaxPos Type R/W Reset 0x00 Description Maximum Position Integrator Value The maximum value of the position integrator. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 395 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Register 5: QEI Timer Load (QEILOAD), offset 0x010 This register contains the load value for the velocity timer. Since this value is loaded into the timer the clock cycle after the timer is zero, this value should be one less than the number of clocks in the desired period. So, for example, to have 2000 clocks per timer period, this register should contain 1999. QEI Timer Load (QEILOAD) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Load Type Reset R/W 0 15 R/W 0 14 R/W 0 13 R/W 0 12 R/W 0 11 R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 R/W 0 8 Load Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 R/W 0 6 R/W 0 5 R/W 0 4 R/W 0 3 R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 R/W 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name Load Type R/W Reset 0x00 Description Velocity Timer Load Value The load value for the velocity timer. 396 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 6: QEI Timer (QEITIME), offset 0x014 This register contains the current value of the velocity timer. This counter does not increment when VelEn in QEICTL is 0. QEI Timer (QEITIME) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Time Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Time Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name Time Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Velocity Timer Current Value The current value of the velocity timer. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 397 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Register 7: QEI Velocity Counter (QEICOUNT), offset 0x018 This register contains the running count of velocity pulses for the current time period. Since this is a running total, the time period to which it applies cannot be known with precision (that is, a read of this register does not necessarily correspond to the time returned by the QEITIME register since there is a small window of time between the two reads, during which time either value may have changed). The QEISPEED register should be used to determine the actual encoder velocity; this register is provided for information purposes only. This counter does not increment when VelEn in QEICTL is 0. QEI Velocity Counter (QEICOUNT) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Count Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Count Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name Count Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Velocity Pulse Count The running total of encoder pulses during this velocity timer period. 398 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 8: QEI Velocity (QEISPEED), offset 0x01C This register contains the most recently measured velocity of the quadrature encoder. This corresponds to the number of velocity pulses counted in the previous velocity timer period. This register does not update when VelEn in QEICTL is 0. QEI Velocity (QEISPEED) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Speed Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 Speed Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 RO 0 2 RO 0 1 RO 0 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit/Field 31:0 Name Speed Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Velocity The measured speed of the quadrature encoder in pulses per period. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 399 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Register 9: QEI Interrupt Enable (QEIINTEN), offset 0x020 This register contains enables for each of the QEI module’s interrupts. An interrupt is asserted to the controller if its corresponding bit in this register is set to 1. QEI Interrupt Enable (QEIINTEN) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x020 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 IntError R/W 0 RO 0 2 IntDir R/W 0 RO 0 1 IntTimer R/W 0 RO 0 0 IntIndex R/W 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Phase Error Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when a phase error is detected. 3 IntError R/W 0 2 IntDir R/W 0 Direction Change Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the direction changes. 1 IntTimer R/W 0 Timer Expires Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the velocity timer expires. 0 IntIndex R/W 0 Index Pulse Detected Interrupt Enable When 1, an interrupt occurs when the index pulse is detected. 400 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Register 10: QEI Raw Interrupt Status (QEIRIS), offset 0x024 This register provides the current set of interrupt sources that are asserted, regardless of whether they cause an interrupt to be asserted to the controller (this is set through the QEIINTEN register). Bits set to 1 indicate the latched events that have occurred; a zero bit indicates that the event in question has not occurred. QEI Raw Interrupt Status (QEIRIS) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x024 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 IntError RO 0 RO 0 2 IntDir RO 0 RO 0 1 IntTimer RO 0 RO 0 0 IntIndex RO 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Phase Error Detected Indicates that a phase error was detected. 3 IntError RO 0 2 IntDir RO 0 Direction Change Detected Indicates that the direction has changed. 1 IntTimer RO 0 Velocity Timer Expired Indicates that the velocity timer has expired. 0 IntIndex RO 0 Index Pulse Asserted Indicates that the index pulse has occurred. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 401 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Register 11: QEI Interrupt Status and Clear (QEIISC), offset 0x028 This register provides the current set of interrupt sources that are asserted to the controller. Bits set to 1 indicate the latched events that have occurred; a zero bit indicates that the event in question has not occurred. This is a R/W1C register; writing a 1 to a bit position clears the corresponding interrupt reason. QEI Interrupt Status and Clear (QEIISC) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 Offset 0x028 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 14 RO 0 13 RO 0 12 RO 0 11 RO 0 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 RO 0 8 RO 0 7 RO 0 6 RO 0 5 RO 0 4 RO 0 3 IntError R/W1C 0 RO 0 2 IntDir R/W1C 0 RO 0 1 IntTimer R/W1C 0 RO 0 0 IntIndex R/W1C 0 Bit/Field 31:4 Name reserved Type RO Reset 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Phase Error Interrupt Indicates that a phase error was detected. 3 IntError R/W1C 0 2 IntDir R/W1C 0 Direction Change Interrupt Indicates that the direction has changed. 1 IntTimer R/W1C 0 Velocity Timer Expired Interrupt Indicates that the velocity timer has expired. 0 IntIndex R/W1C 0 Index Pulse Interrupt Indicates that the index pulse has occurred. 402 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 17 Pin Diagram Figure 17-1 on page 403 shows the pin diagram and pin-to-signal-name mapping. Figure 17-1. Pin Connection Diagram PB4/C0PB5/C1PB6/C0+ PB7/TRST PC0/TCK/SWCLK PC1/TMS/SWDIO PC2/TDI PC3/TDO/SWO 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 PD7/IDX PD6/Fault PD5/CCP2 PD4/CCP0 PE5/CCP5 PE4/CCP3 PE3/CCP1 PE2/CCP4 RST LDO VDD GND OSC0 OSC1 PC7/C2PC6/C2+/PhB 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 PE1/PWM5 PE0/PWM4 PB3/I2CSDA PB2/I2CSCL VDD GND PB1/PWM3 PB0/PWM2 PD3/U1Tx PD2/U1Rx PD1/PWM1 PD0/PWM0 PC5/C1+/C0o PC4/PhA VDD GND PA0/U0Rx PA1/U0Tx PA2/SSIClk PA3/SSIFss LM3S601 October 01, 2007 Preliminary PA4/SSIRx PA5/SSITx VDD GND 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 403 Signal Tables 18 Signal Tables The following tables list the signals available for each pin. Functionality is enabled by software with the GPIOAFSEL register. Important: All multiplexed pins are GPIOs by default, with the exception of the five JTAG pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]) which default to the JTAG functionality. Table 18-1 on page 404 shows the pin-to-signal-name mapping, including functional characteristics of the signals. Table 18-2 on page 406 lists the signals in alphabetical order by signal name. Table 18-3 on page 409 groups the signals by functionality, except for GPIOs. Table 18-4 on page 410 lists the GPIO pins and their alternate functionality. Table 18-1. Signals by Pin Number Pin Number 1 Pin Name PE5 CCP5 2 PE4 CCP3 3 PE3 CCP1 4 PE2 CCP4 5 6 RST LDO Pin Type I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I Buffer Type Description TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power GPIO port E bit 5 Capture/Compare/PWM 5 GPIO port E bit 4 Capture/Compare/PWM 3 GPIO port E bit 3 Capture/Compare/PWM 1 GPIO port E bit 2 Capture/Compare/PWM 4 System reset input. Low drop-out regulator output voltage. This pin requires an external capacitor between the pin and GND of 1 µF or greater. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Main oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. Main oscillator crystal output. GPIO port C bit 7 Analog comparator 2 negative input GPIO port C bit 6 Analog comparator positive input QEI module 0 Phase B GPIO port C bit 5 Analog comparator positive input Analog comparator 0 output GPIO port C bit 4 QEI module 0 Phase A Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. GPIO port A bit 0 UART module 0 receive 7 8 9 10 11 VDD GND OSC0 OSC1 PC7 C2- I O I/O I I/O I I I/O I O I/O I I/O I Power Power Analog Analog TTL Analog TTL Analog TTL TTL Analog TTL TTL TTL Power Power TTL TTL 12 PC6 C2+ PhB 13 PC5 C1+ C0o 14 PC4 PhA 15 16 17 VDD GND PA0 U0Rx 404 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Pin Number 18 Pin Name PA1 U0Tx Pin Type I/O O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I I/O O I/O O I/O O I/O I I/O O I/O O I/O O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O O I/O O I/O O O I/O I Buffer Type Description TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power Power TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power Power TTL OD TTL OD TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL GPIO port A bit 1 UART module 0 transmit GPIO port A bit 2 SSI clock GPIO port A bit 3 SSI frame GPIO port A bit 4 SSI module 0 receive GPIO port A bit 5 SSI module 0 transmit Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. GPIO port D bit 0 PWM 0 GPIO port D bit 1 PWM 1 GPIO port D bit 2 UART module 1 receive. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. GPIO port D bit 3 UART module 1 transmit. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. GPIO port B bit 0 PWM 2 GPIO port B bit 1 PWM 3 Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. GPIO port B bit 2 I2C module 0 clock GPIO port B bit 3 I2C module 0 data GPIO port E bit 0 PWM 4 GPIO port E bit 1 PWM 5 GPIO port C bit 3 JTAG TDO and SWO JTAG TDO and SWO GPIO port C bit 2 JTAG TDI 19 PA2 SSIClk 20 PA3 SSIFss 21 PA4 SSIRx 22 PA5 SSITx 23 24 25 VDD GND PD0 PWM0 26 PD1 PWM1 27 PD2 U1Rx 28 PD3 U1Tx 29 PB0 PWM2 30 PB1 PWM3 31 32 33 GND VDD PB2 I2CSCL 34 PB3 I2CSDA 35 PE0 PWM4 36 PE1 PWM5 37 PC3 TDO SWO 38 PC2 TDI October 01, 2007 Preliminary 405 Signal Tables Pin Number 39 Pin Name PC1 TMS SWDIO Pin Type I/O I/O I/O I/O I I I/O I I/O I I/O I I/O I I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I I/O I Buffer Type Description TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Analog TTL Analog TTL Analog TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL GPIO port C bit 1 JTAG TMS and SWDIO JTAG TMS and SWDIO GPIO port C bit 0 JTAG/SWD CLK JTAG/SWD CLK GPIO port B bit 7 JTAG TRSTn GPIO port B bit 6 Analog comparator 0 positive input GPIO port B bit 5 Analog comparator 1 negative input GPIO port B bit 4 Analog comparator 0 negative input GPIO port D bit 4 Capture/Compare/PWM 0 GPIO port D bit 5 Capture/Compare/PWM 2 GPIO port D bit 6 PWM Fault GPIO port D bit 7 QEI index 40 PC0 TCK SWCLK 41 PB7 TRST 42 PB6 C0+ 43 PB5 C1- 44 PB4 C0- 45 PD4 CCP0 46 PD5 CCP2 47 PD6 Fault 48 PD7 IDX Table 18-2. Signals by Signal Name Pin Name C0+ C0C0o C1+ C1C2+ C2CCP0 CCP1 CCP2 CCP3 CCP4 CCP5 Fault GND GND GND Pin Number 42 44 13 13 43 12 11 45 3 46 2 4 1 47 8 16 24 Pin Type I I O I I I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I Buffer Type Description Analog Analog TTL Analog Analog Analog Analog TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power Power Power Analog comparator 0 positive input Analog comparator 0 negative input Analog comparator 0 output Analog comparator positive input Analog comparator 1 negative input Analog comparator positive input Analog comparator 2 negative input Capture/Compare/PWM 0 Capture/Compare/PWM 1 Capture/Compare/PWM 2 Capture/Compare/PWM 3 Capture/Compare/PWM 4 Capture/Compare/PWM 5 PWM Fault Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. 406 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Pin Name GND I2CSCL I2CSDA IDX LDO Pin Number 31 33 34 48 6 Pin Type I/O I/O I - Buffer Type Description Power OD OD TTL Power Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. I2C module 0 clock I2C module 0 data QEI index Low drop-out regulator output voltage. This pin requires an external capacitor between the pin and GND of 1 µF or greater. Main oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. Main oscillator crystal output. GPIO port A bit 0 GPIO port A bit 1 GPIO port A bit 2 GPIO port A bit 3 GPIO port A bit 4 GPIO port A bit 5 GPIO port B bit 0 GPIO port B bit 1 GPIO port B bit 2 GPIO port B bit 3 GPIO port B bit 4 GPIO port B bit 5 GPIO port B bit 6 GPIO port B bit 7 GPIO port C bit 0 GPIO port C bit 1 GPIO port C bit 2 GPIO port C bit 3 GPIO port C bit 4 GPIO port C bit 5 GPIO port C bit 6 GPIO port C bit 7 GPIO port D bit 0 GPIO port D bit 1 GPIO port D bit 2 GPIO port D bit 3 GPIO port D bit 4 GPIO port D bit 5 GPIO port D bit 6 GPIO port D bit 7 GPIO port E bit 0 GPIO port E bit 1 GPIO port E bit 2 OSC0 OSC1 PA0 PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 PC4 PC5 PC6 PC7 PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PE0 PE1 PE2 9 10 17 18 19 20 21 22 29 30 33 34 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 14 13 12 11 25 26 27 28 45 46 47 48 35 36 4 I O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Analog Analog TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL October 01, 2007 Preliminary 407 Signal Tables Pin Name PE3 PE4 PE5 PhA PhB PWM0 PWM1 PWM2 PWM3 PWM4 PWM5 RST SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx SSITx SWCLK SWDIO SWO TCK TDI TDO TMS TRST U0Rx U0Tx U1Rx U1Tx VDD VDD VDD VDD Pin Number 3 2 1 14 12 25 26 29 30 35 36 5 19 20 21 22 40 39 37 40 38 37 39 41 17 18 27 28 7 15 23 32 Pin Type I/O I/O I/O I I O O O O O O I I/O I/O I O I I/O O I I O I/O I I O I O - Buffer Type Description TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power Power Power Power GPIO port E bit 3 GPIO port E bit 4 GPIO port E bit 5 QEI module 0 Phase A QEI module 0 Phase B PWM 0 PWM 1 PWM 2 PWM 3 PWM 4 PWM 5 System reset input. SSI clock SSI frame SSI module 0 receive SSI module 0 transmit JTAG/SWD CLK JTAG TMS and SWDIO JTAG TDO and SWO JTAG/SWD CLK JTAG TDI JTAG TDO and SWO JTAG TMS and SWDIO JTAG TRSTn UART module 0 receive UART module 0 transmit UART module 1 receive. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. UART module 1 transmit. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. 408 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Table 18-3. Signals by Function, Except for GPIO Function Analog Comparators Pin Name C0+ C0C0o C1+ C1C2+ C2General-Purpose CCP0 Timers CCP1 CCP2 CCP3 CCP4 CCP5 I2C I2CSCL I2CSDA JTAG/SWD/SWO SWCLK SWDIO SWO TCK TDI TDO TMS PWM Fault PWM0 PWM1 PWM2 PWM3 PWM4 PWM5 Power GND GND GND GND LDO Pin Number 42 44 13 13 43 12 11 45 3 46 2 4 1 33 34 40 39 37 40 38 37 39 47 25 26 29 30 35 36 8 16 24 31 6 Pin Type I I O I I I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I I/O O I I O I/O I O O O O O O Buffer Type Analog Analog TTL Analog Analog Analog Analog TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL OD OD TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Power Power Power Power Power Description Analog comparator 0 positive input Analog comparator 0 negative input Analog comparator 0 output Analog comparator positive input Analog comparator 1 negative input Analog comparator positive input Analog comparator 2 negative input Capture/Compare/PWM 0 Capture/Compare/PWM 1 Capture/Compare/PWM 2 Capture/Compare/PWM 3 Capture/Compare/PWM 4 Capture/Compare/PWM 5 I2C module 0 clock I2C module 0 data JTAG/SWD CLK JTAG TMS and SWDIO JTAG TDO and SWO JTAG/SWD CLK JTAG TDI JTAG TDO and SWO JTAG TMS and SWDIO PWM Fault PWM 0 PWM 1 PWM 2 PWM 3 PWM 4 PWM 5 Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Low drop-out regulator output voltage. This pin requires an external capacitor between the pin and GND of 1 µF or greater. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. Positive supply for I/O and some logic. VDD VDD VDD VDD 7 15 23 32 - Power Power Power Power October 01, 2007 Preliminary 409 Signal Tables Function QEI Pin Name IDX PhA PhB Pin Number 48 14 12 19 20 21 22 9 10 5 41 17 18 27 28 Pin Type I I I I/O I/O I O I O I I I O I O Buffer Type TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL Analog Analog TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL TTL QEI index Description QEI module 0 Phase A QEI module 0 Phase B SSI clock SSI frame SSI module 0 receive SSI module 0 transmit Main oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. Main oscillator crystal output. System reset input. JTAG TRSTn UART module 0 receive UART module 0 transmit UART module 1 receive. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. UART module 1 transmit. When in IrDA mode, this signal has IrDA modulation. SSI SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx SSITx System Control & OSC0 Clocks OSC1 RST TRST UART U0Rx U0Tx U1Rx U1Tx Table 18-4. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions GPIO Pin PA0 PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 PC4 PC5 PC6 PC7 Pin Number 17 18 19 20 21 22 29 30 33 34 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 14 13 12 11 Multiplexed Function U0Rx U0Tx SSIClk SSIFss SSIRx SSITx PWM2 PWM3 I2CSCL I2CSDA C0C1C0+ TRST TCK TMS TDI TDO PhA C1+ C2+ C2C0o PhB SWO SWCLK SWDIO Multiplexed Function 410 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller GPIO Pin PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PE0 PE1 PE2 PE3 PE4 PE5 Pin Number 25 26 27 28 45 46 47 48 35 36 4 3 2 1 Multiplexed Function PWM0 PWM1 U1Rx U1Tx CCP0 CCP2 Fault IDX PWM4 PWM5 CCP4 CCP1 CCP3 CCP5 Multiplexed Function October 01, 2007 Preliminary 411 Operating Characteristics 19 Operating Characteristics Table 19-1. Temperature Characteristics Characteristic a Symbol Value -40 to +85 Unit °C Operating temperature range TA a. Maximum storage temperature is 150°C. Table 19-2. Thermal Characteristics Characteristic a b Symbol Value 76 TA + (PAVG • ΘJA) 115 c Unit °C/W °C °C Thermal resistance (junction to ambient) ΘJA Average junction temperature TJ TJMAX Maximum junction temperature a. Junction to ambient thermal resistance θJA numbers are determined by a package simulator. b. Power dissipation is a function of temperature. c. TJMAX calculation is based on power consumption values and conditions as specified in “Power Specifications” on page 383 of the data sheet. 412 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 20 20.1 20.1.1 Electrical Characteristics DC Characteristics Maximum Ratings The maximum ratings are the limits to which the device can be subjected without permanently damaging the device. Note: The device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum ratings. Table 20-1. Maximum Ratings Characteristic a Symbol VDD VIN I I Value 0.0 to +3.6 -0.3 to 5.5 100 100 Unit V V mA mA Supply voltage range (VDD) Input voltage Maximum current for pins, excluding pins operating as GPIOs Maximum current for GPIO pins a. Voltages are measured with respect to GND. Important: This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due to high-static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for example, either GND or VDD). 20.1.2 Recommended DC Operating Conditions Table 20-2. Recommended DC Operating Conditions Parameter Parameter Name VDD VIH VIL VSIH VSIL VOH VOL IOH Supply voltage High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage Min 3.0 2.0 -0.3 Nom 3.3 Max 3.6 5.0 1.3 VDD 0.2 * VDD 0.4 Unit V V V V V V V High-level input voltage for Schmitt trigger inputs 0.8 * VDD Low-level input voltage for Schmitt trigger inputs High-level output voltage Low-level output voltage High-level source current, VOH=2.4 V 2-mA Drive 4-mA Drive 8-mA Drive 2.0 4.0 8.0 0 2.4 - - - mA mA mA IOL Low-level sink current, VOL=0.4 V 2-mA Drive 4-mA Drive 8-mA Drive 2.0 4.0 8.0 mA mA mA October 01, 2007 Preliminary 413 Electrical Characteristics 20.1.3 On-Chip Low Drop-Out (LDO) Regulator Characteristics Table 20-3. LDO Regulator Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name VLDOOUT tPON tON tOFF VSTEP CLDO Min Nom Max Unit 2.75 2% 50 100 200 100 3.0 V % µs µs µs mV µF Programmable internal (logic) power supply output value 2.25 Output voltage accuracy Power-on time Time on Time off Step programming incremental voltage External filter capacitor size for internal power supply 1.0 20.1.4 Power Specifications The power measurements specified in the tables that follow are run on the core processor using SRAM with the following specifications (except as noted): ■ VDD = 3.3 V ■ Temperature = 25°C Table 20-4. Detailed Power Specifications Parameter IDD_RUN Parameter Name Conditions Nom Max Unit 95 110 mA Run mode 1 (Flash loop) LDO = 2.50 V Code = while(1){} executed in Flash Peripherals = All clock-gated ON System Clock = 50 MHz (with PLL) Run mode 2 (Flash loop) LDO = 2.50 V Code = while(1){} executed in Flash Peripherals = All clock-gated OFF System Clock = 50 MHz (with PLL) Run mode 1 (SRAM loop) LDO = 2.50 V Code = while(1){} executed in SRAM Peripherals = All clock-gated ON System Clock = 50 MHz (with PLL) Run mode 2 (SRAM loop) LDO = 2.50 V Code = while(1){} executed in SRAM Peripherals = All clock-gated OFF System Clock = 50 MHz (with PLL) IDD_SLEEP Sleep mode LDO = 2.50 V Peripherals = All clock-gated OFF System Clock = 50 MHz (with PLL) 19 22 mA 50 60 mA 85 95 mA 60 75 mA 414 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Parameter Parameter Name Conditions LDO = 2.25 V Peripherals = All OFF System Clock = MOSC/16 Nom Max Unit 950 1150 μA IDD_DEEPSLEEP Deep-Sleep mode 20.1.5 Flash Memory Characteristics Table 20-5. Flash Memory Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name PECYC TRET TPROG TERASE TME a Min Nom Max Unit cycles years µs ms ms Number of guaranteed program/erase cycles before failure 10,000 100,000 Data retention at average operating temperature of 85˚C Word program time Page erase time Mass erase time 10 20 20 200 - a. A program/erase cycle is defined as switching the bits from 1-> 0 -> 1. 20.2 20.2.1 AC Characteristics Load Conditions Unless otherwise specified, the following conditions are true for all timing measurements. Timing measurements are for 4-mA drive strength. Figure 20-1. Load Conditions pin CL = 50 pF GND 20.2.2 Clocks Table 20-6. Phase Locked Loop (PLL) Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name fref_crystal fref_ext fpll TREADY Crystal reference External clock PLL frequency PLL lock time b a Min 3.579545 3.579545 - Nom Max Unit 200 8.192 MHz 8.192 MHz 0.5 MHz ms referencea a. The exact value is determined by the crystal value programmed into the XTAL field of the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register. b. PLL frequency is automatically calculated by the hardware based on the XTAL field of the RCC register. Table 20-7. Clock Characteristics Parameter fIOSC Parameter Name Internal oscillator frequency Min Nom Max Unit 7 12 22 MHz October 01, 2007 Preliminary 415 Electrical Characteristics Parameter fMOSC tMOSC_per Parameter Name Main oscillator frequency Main oscillator period Min Nom Max Unit 1 125 1 0 0 8 1000 8 50 50 MHz ns MHz MHz MHz fref_crystal_bypass Crystal reference using the main oscillator (PLL in BYPASS mode) fref_ext_bypass fsystem_clock External clock reference (PLL in BYPASS mode) System clock 20.2.3 Analog Comparator Table 20-8. Analog Comparator Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name VOS VCM CMRR TRT TMC Input offset voltage Input common mode voltage range Common mode rejection ratio Response time Comparator mode change to Output Valid Min Nom 0 50 ±10 Max ±25 VDD-1.5 1 10 Unit mV V dB µs µs Table 20-9. Analog Comparator Voltage Reference Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name RHR RLR AHR ALR Resolution high range Resolution low range Absolute accuracy high range Absolute accuracy low range Min Nom Max Unit VDD/32 VDD/24 LSB LSB ±1/2 LSB ±1/4 LSB 20.2.4 I2C Table 20-10. I2C Characteristics Parameter No. Parameter Parameter Name I1 I2 I3 I4 a a b a c Min Nom 36 36 2 24 18 9 - Max (see note b) 10 - Unit system clocks system clocks ns system clocks ns system clocks system clocks system clocks system clocks tSCH tLP tSRT tDH tSFT tHT tDS tSCSR tSCS Start condition hold time Clock Low period I2CSCL/I2CSDA rise time (VIL =0.5 V to V IH =2.4 V) Data hold time I2CSCL/I2CSDA fall time (VIH =2.4 V to V IL =0.5 V) Clock High time Data setup time I5 I6 I7 I8 I9 a a a Start condition setup time (for repeated start condition 36 only) Stop condition setup time I2C 24 a a. Values depend on the value programmed into the TPR bit in the Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR) register; a TPR programmed for the maximum I2CSCL frequency (TPR=0x2) results in a minimum output timing as shown in the table above. The I 2C interface is designed to scale the actual data transition time to move it to the middle of the I2CSCL Low period. The actual position is affected by the value programmed into the TPR; however, the numbers given in the above values are minimum values. b. Because I2CSCL and I2CSDA are open-drain-type outputs, which the controller can only actively drive Low, the time I2CSCL or I2CSDA takes to reach a high level depends on external signal capacitance and pull-up resistor values. c. Specified at a nominal 50 pF load. 416 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Figure 20-2. I2C Timing I2 I6 I5 I2CSCL I1 I4 I7 I8 I3 I9 I2CSDA 20.2.5 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) Table 20-11. SSI Characteristics Parameter No. Parameter Parameter Name S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 tclk_per tclk_high tclk_low tclkrf tDMd tDMs tDMh tDSs tDSh SSIClk cycle time SSIClk high time SSIClk low time SSIClk rise/fall time Data from master valid delay time Data from master setup time Data from master hold time Data from slave setup time Data from slave hold time Min Nom Max 2 0 20 40 20 40 1/2 1/2 7.4 Unit 65024 system clocks 26 20 t clk_per t clk_per ns ns ns ns ns ns Figure 20-3. SSI Timing for TI Frame Format (FRF=01), Single Transfer Timing Measurement S1 S2 S4 SSIClk S3 SSIFss SSITx SSIRx MSB 4 to 16 bits LSB October 01, 2007 Preliminary 417 Electrical Characteristics Figure 20-4. SSI Timing for MICROWIRE Frame Format (FRF=10), Single Transfer S2 S1 SSIClk S3 SSIFss SSITx MSB 8-bit control LSB SSIRx 0 MSB 4 to 16 bits output data LSB Figure 20-5. SSI Timing for SPI Frame Format (FRF=00), with SPH=1 S1 S4 S2 SSIClk (SPO=0) S3 SSIClk (SPO=1) S6 S7 SSITx (master) S5 MSB S8 S9 LSB SSIRx (slave) MSB LSB SSIFss 20.2.6 JTAG and Boundary Scan Table 20-12. JTAG Characteristics Parameter No. J1 J2 J3 Parameter fTCK tTCK tTCK_LOW Parameter Name TCK operational clock frequency TCK operational clock period TCK clock Low time Min Nom Max Unit 0 100 tTCK 10 MHz ns ns 418 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Parameter No. J4 J5 J6 J7 J8 J9 J10 J11 t TDO_ZDV Parameter tTCK_HIGH tTCK_R tTCK_F tTMS_SU tTMS_HLD tTDI_SU tTDI_HLD TCK fall to Data Valid from High-Z Parameter Name TCK clock High time TCK rise time TCK fall time TMS setup time to TCK rise TMS hold time from TCK rise TDI setup time to TCK rise TDI hold time from TCK rise 2-mA drive 4-mA drive 8-mA drive 8-mA drive with slew rate control Min Nom Max Unit 0 0 20 20 25 25 tTCK 23 15 14 18 21 14 13 18 9 7 6 7 100 10 10 10 35 26 25 29 35 25 24 28 11 9 8 9 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns J12 t TDO_DV TCK fall to Data Valid from Data Valid 2-mA drive 4-mA drive 8-mA drive 8-mA drive with slew rate control J13 t TDO_DVZ TCK fall to High-Z from Data Valid 2-mA drive 4-mA drive 8-mA drive 8-mA drive with slew rate control J14 J15 tTRST tTRST_SU TRST assertion time TRST setup time to TCK rise Figure 20-6. JTAG Test Clock Input Timing J2 J3 J4 TCK J6 J5 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 419 Electrical Characteristics Figure 20-7. JTAG Test Access Port (TAP) Timing TCK J7 J8 J7 J8 TMS TMS Input Valid J9 J10 TMS Input Valid J9 J10 TDI J11 TDI Input Valid J12 TDO Output Valid TDI Input Valid J13 TDO Output Valid TDO Figure 20-8. JTAG TRST Timing TCK J14 J15 TRST 20.2.7 General-Purpose I/O Note: All GPIOs are 5 V-tolerant. Table 20-13. GPIO Characteristics Parameter Parameter Name tGPIOR GPIO Rise Time (from 20% to 80% of VDD) Condition 2-mA drive 4-mA drive 8-mA drive 8-mA drive with slew rate control tGPIOF GPIO Fall Time (from 80% to 20% of VDD) 2-mA drive 4-mA drive 8-mA drive 8-mA drive with slew rate control Min Nom Max Unit 17 9 6 10 17 8 6 11 26 13 9 12 25 12 10 13 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 20.2.8 Reset Table 20-14. Reset Characteristics Parameter No. Parameter Parameter Name R1 VTH Reset threshold Min Nom Max Unit 2.0 V 420 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Parameter No. Parameter Parameter Name R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 a. 20 * t MOSC_per VBTH TPOR TBOR TIRPOR TIRBOR TIRHWR TIRSWR TIRWDR TIRLDOR TVDDRISE Brown-Out threshold Power-On Reset timeout Brown-Out timeout Internal reset timeout after POR Internal reset timeout after BOR a Min Nom Max Unit 2.85 2.9 2.95 15 2.5 15 reset a 2.5 2.5 2.5 10 500 30 20 30 20 20 20 V ms µs ms µs ms µs µs µs Internal reset timeout after hardware reset (RST pin) Internal reset timeout after software-initiated system Internal reset timeout after watchdog reseta Internal reset timeout after LDO reseta Supply voltage (VDD) rise time (0 V-3.3 V) 100 ms Figure 20-9. External Reset Timing (RST) RST R7 /Reset (Internal) Figure 20-10. Power-On Reset Timing R1 VDD R3 /POR (Internal) R5 /Reset (Internal) October 01, 2007 Preliminary 421 Electrical Characteristics Figure 20-11. Brown-Out Reset Timing R2 VDD R4 /BOR (Internal) R6 /Reset (Internal) Figure 20-12. Software Reset Timing SW Reset R8 /Reset (Internal) Figure 20-13. Watchdog Reset Timing WDOG Reset (Internal) R9 /Reset (Internal) Figure 20-14. LDO Reset Timing LDO Reset (Internal) R10 /Reset (Internal) 422 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 21 Package Information Figure 21-1. 48-Pin LQFP Package aaa bbb ccc Note: The following notes apply to the package drawing. 1. All dimensions are in mm. All dimensioning and tolerancing conform to ANSI Y14.5M-1982. 2. The top package body size may be smaller than the bottom package body size by as much as 0.20. 3. Datums A-B and -D- to be determined at datum plane -H-. 4. To be determined at seating plane -C-. 5. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold protrusion. Allowable protrusion is 0.25 per side. D1 and E1 are maximum plastic body size dimensions including mold mismatch. 6. Surface finish of the package is #24-27 Charmille (1.6-2.3μmR0) Pin 1 and ejector pin may be less than 0.1μmR0. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 423 Package Information 7. Dambar removal protrusion does not exceed 0.08. Intrusion does not exceed 0.03. 8. Burr does not exceed 0.08 in any direction. 9. Dimension b does not include Dambar protrusion. Allowable Dambar protrusion shall not cause the lead width to exceed the maximum b dimension by more than 0.08. Dambar cannot be located on the lower radius or the foot. Minimum space between protrusion and adjacent lead is 0.07 for 0.40 and 0.50 pitch package. 10. Corner radius of plastic body does not exceed 0.20. 11. These dimensions apply to the flat section of the lead between 0.10 and 0.25 from the lead tip. 12. A1 is defined as the distance from the seating plane to the lowest point of the package body. 13. Finish of leads is tin plated. 14. All specifications and dimensions are subjected to IPAC’S manufacturing process flow and materials. 15. M5-026A. Where discrepancies between the JEDEC and IPAC documents exist, this drawing will take the precedence. Symbol Package Type 48LD LQFP MIN A A1 A2 D D1 E E1 L e b b1 c c1 0.17 0.17 0.09 0.09 0.45 === 0.05 1.35 NOM === === 1.40 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 0.80 0.50 BSC 0.22 0.20 === === 0.27 0.23 0.20 0.16 0.75 MAX 1.60 0.15 1.45 Note Tolerances of form and position aaa bbb ccc ddd 0.20 0.20 0.08 0.08 424 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller A A.1 Serial Flash Loader Serial Flash Loader The Stellaris serial flash loader is a preprogrammed flash-resident utility used to download code to the flash memory of a device without the use of a debug interface. The serial flash loader uses a simple packet interface to provide synchronous communication with the device. The flash loader runs off the crystal and does not enable the PLL, so its speed is determined by the crystal used. The two serial interfaces that can be used are the UART0 and SSI0 interfaces. For simplicity, both the data format and communication protocol are identical for both serial interfaces. ® A.2 Interfaces Once communication with the flash loader is established via one of the serial interfaces, that interface is used until the flash loader is reset or new code takes over. For example, once you start communicating using the SSI port, communications with the flash loader via the UART are disabled until the device is reset. A.2.1 UART The Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UART) communication uses a fixed serial format of 8 bits of data, no parity, and 1 stop bit. The baud rate used for communication is automatically detected by the flash loader and can be any valid baud rate supported by the host and the device. The auto detection sequence requires that the baud rate should be no more than 1/32 the crystal frequency of the board that is running the serial flash loader. This is actually the ® same as the hardware limitation for the maximum baud rate for any UART on a Stellaris device which is calculated as follows: Max Baud Rate = System Clock Frequency / 16 In order to determine the baud rate, the serial flash loader needs to determine the relationship between its own crystal frequency and the baud rate. This is enough information for the flash loader to configure its UART to the same baud rate as the host. This automatic baud-rate detection allows the host to use any valid baud rate that it wants to communicate with the device. The method used to perform this automatic synchronization relies on the host sending the flash loader two bytes that are both 0x55. This generates a series of pulses to the flash loader that it can use to calculate the ratios needed to program the UART to match the host’s baud rate. After the host sends the pattern, it attempts to read back one byte of data from the UART. The flash loader returns the value of 0xCC to indicate successful detection of the baud rate. If this byte is not received after at least twice the time required to transfer the two bytes, the host can resend another pattern of 0x55, 0x55, and wait for the 0xCC byte again until the flash loader acknowledges that it has received a synchronization pattern correctly. For example, the time to wait for data back from the flash loader should be calculated as at least 2*(20(bits/sync)/baud rate (bits/sec)). For a baud rate of 115200, this time is 2*(20/115200) or 0.35 ms. A.2.2 SSI The Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) port also uses a fixed serial format for communications, with the framing defined as Motorola format with SPH set to 1 and SPO set to 1. See “Frame Formats” on page 267 in the SSI chapter for more information on formats for this transfer protocol. Like the UART, this interface has hardware requirements that limit the maximum speed that the SSI clock can run. This allows the SSI clock to be at most 1/12 the crystal frequency of the board running October 01, 2007 Preliminary 425 Serial Flash Loader the flash loader. Since the host device is the master, the SSI on the flash loader device does not need to determine the clock as it is provided directly by the host. A.3 Packet Handling All communications, with the exception of the UART auto-baud, are done via defined packets that are acknowledged (ACK) or not acknowledged (NAK) by the devices. The packets use the same format for receiving and sending packets, including the method used to acknowledge successful or unsuccessful reception of a packet. A.3.1 Packet Format All packets sent and received from the device use the following byte-packed format. struct { unsigned char ucSize; unsigned char ucCheckSum; unsigned char Data[]; }; ucSize ucChecksum Data The first byte received holds the total size of the transfer including the size and checksum bytes. This holds a simple checksum of the bytes in the data buffer only. The algorithm is Data[0]+Data[1]+…+ Data[ucSize-3]. This is the raw data intended for the device, which is formatted in some form of command interface. There should be ucSize–2 bytes of data provided in this buffer to or from the device. A.3.2 Sending Packets The actual bytes of the packet can be sent individually or all at once; the only limitation is that commands that cause flash memory access should limit the download sizes to prevent losing bytes during flash programming. This limitation is discussed further in the section that describes the serial flash loader command, COMMAND_SEND_DATA (see “COMMAND_SEND_DATA (0x24)” on page 428). Once the packet has been formatted correctly by the host, it should be sent out over the UART or SSI interface. Then the host should poll the UART or SSI interface for the first non-zero data returned from the device. The first non-zero byte will either be an ACK (0xCC) or a NAK (0x33) byte from the device indicating the packet was received successfully (ACK) or unsuccessfully (NAK). This does not indicate that the actual contents of the command issued in the data portion of the packet were valid, just that the packet was received correctly. A.3.3 Receiving Packets The flash loader sends a packet of data in the same format that it receives a packet. The flash loader may transfer leading zero data before the first actual byte of data is sent out. The first non-zero byte is the size of the packet followed by a checksum byte, and finally followed by the data itself. There is no break in the data after the first non-zero byte is sent from the flash loader. Once the device communicating with the flash loader receives all the bytes, it must either ACK or NAK the packet to indicate that the transmission was successful. The appropriate response after sending a NAK to the flash loader is to resend the command that failed and request the data again. If needed, the host may send leading zeros before sending down the ACK/NAK signal to the flash loader, as the 426 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller flash loader only accepts the first non-zero data as a valid response. This zero padding is needed by the SSI interface in order to receive data to or from the flash loader. A.4 Commands The next section defines the list of commands that can be sent to the flash loader. The first byte of the data should always be one of the defined commands, followed by data or parameters as determined by the command that is sent. A.4.1 COMMAND_PING (0X20) This command simply accepts the command and sets the global status to success. The format of the packet is as follows: Byte[0] = 0x03; Byte[1] = checksum(Byte[2]); Byte[2] = COMMAND_PING; The ping command has 3 bytes and the value for COMMAND_PING is 0x20 and the checksum of one byte is that same byte, making Byte[1] also 0x20. Since the ping command has no real return status, the receipt of an ACK can be interpreted as a successful ping to the flash loader. A.4.2 COMMAND_GET_STATUS (0x23) This command returns the status of the last command that was issued. Typically, this command should be sent after every command to ensure that the previous command was successful or to properly respond to a failure. The command requires one byte in the data of the packet and should be followed by reading a packet with one byte of data that contains a status code. The last step is to ACK or NAK the received data so the flash loader knows that the data has been read. Byte[0] = 0x03 Byte[1] = checksum(Byte[2]) Byte[2] = COMMAND_GET_STATUS A.4.3 COMMAND_DOWNLOAD (0x21) This command is sent to the flash loader to indicate where to store data and how many bytes will be sent by the COMMAND_SEND_DATA commands that follow. The command consists of two 32-bit values that are both transferred MSB first. The first 32-bit value is the address to start programming data into, while the second is the 32-bit size of the data that will be sent. This command also triggers an erase of the full area to be programmed so this command takes longer than other commands. This results in a longer time to receive the ACK/NAK back from the board. This command should be followed by a COMMAND_GET_STATUS to ensure that the Program Address and Program size are valid for the device running the flash loader. The format of the packet to send this command is a follows: Byte[0] Byte[1] Byte[2] Byte[3] Byte[4] Byte[5] Byte[6] Byte[7] = = = = = = = = 11 checksum(Bytes[2:10]) COMMAND_DOWNLOAD Program Address [31:24] Program Address [23:16] Program Address [15:8] Program Address [7:0] Program Size [31:24] October 01, 2007 Preliminary 427 Serial Flash Loader Byte[8] = Program Size [23:16] Byte[9] = Program Size [15:8] Byte[10] = Program Size [7:0] A.4.4 COMMAND_SEND_DATA (0x24) This command should only follow a COMMAND_DOWNLOAD command or another COMMAND_SEND_DATA command if more data is needed. Consecutive send data commands automatically increment address and continue programming from the previous location. The caller should limit transfers of data to a maximum 8 bytes of packet data to allow the flash to program successfully and not overflow input buffers of the serial interfaces. The command terminates programming once the number of bytes indicated by the COMMAND_DOWNLOAD command has been received. Each time this function is called it should be followed by a COMMAND_GET_STATUS to ensure that the data was successfully programmed into the flash. If the flash loader sends a NAK to this command, the flash loader does not increment the current address to allow retransmission of the previous data. Byte[0] = 11 Byte[1] = checksum(Bytes[2:10]) Byte[2] = COMMAND_SEND_DATA Byte[3] = Data[0] Byte[4] = Data[1] Byte[5] = Data[2] Byte[6] = Data[3] Byte[7] = Data[4] Byte[8] = Data[5] Byte[9] = Data[6] Byte[10] = Data[7] A.4.5 COMMAND_RUN (0x22) This command is used to tell the flash loader to execute from the address passed as the parameter in this command. This command consists of a single 32-bit value that is interpreted as the address to execute. The 32-bit value is transmitted MSB first and the flash loader responds with an ACK signal back to the host device before actually executing the code at the given address. This allows the host to know that the command was received successfully and the code is now running. Byte[0] Byte[1] Byte[2] Byte[3] Byte[4] Byte[5] Byte[6] = = = = = = = 7 checksum(Bytes[2:6]) COMMAND_RUN Execute Address[31:24] Execute Address[23:16] Execute Address[15:8] Execute Address[7:0] A.4.6 COMMAND_RESET (0x25) This command is used to tell the flash loader device to reset. This is useful when downloading a new image that overwrote the flash loader and wants to start from a full reset. Unlike the COMMAND_RUN command, this allows the initial stack pointer to be read by the hardware and set up for the new code. It can also be used to reset the flash loader if a critical error occurs and the host device wants to restart communication with the flash loader. 428 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller Byte[0] = 3 Byte[1] = checksum(Byte[2]) Byte[2] = COMMAND_RESET The flash loader responds with an ACK signal back to the host device before actually executing the software reset to the device running the flash loader. This allows the host to know that the command was received successfully and the part will be reset. October 01, 2007 Preliminary 429 Register Quick Reference B 31 15 30 14 Register Quick Reference 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 System Control Base 0x400F.E000 DID0, type RO, offset 0x000, reset VER MAJOR PBORCTL, type R/W, offset 0x030, reset 0x0000.7FFD MINOR BORTIM LDOPCTL, type R/W, offset 0x034, reset 0x0000.0000 BORIOR BORWT VADJ RIS, type RO, offset 0x050, reset 0x0000.0000 PLLLRIS IMC, type R/W, offset 0x054, reset 0x0000.0000 CLRIS IOFRIS MOFRIS LDORIS BORRIS PLLFRIS PLLLIM MISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x058, reset 0x0000.0000 CLIM IOFIM MOFIM LDOIM BORIM PLLFIM PLLLMIS RESC, type R/W, offset 0x05C, reset - CLMIS IOFMIS MOFMIS LDOMIS BORMIS LDO RCC, type R/W, offset 0x060, reset 0x07AE.3AD1 ACG PWRDN OEN BYPASS PLLVER SYSDIV XTAL USESYSDIV SW WDT BOR POR EXT USEPWMDIV PWMDIV IOSCVER MOSCVER IOSCDIS MOSCDIS OSCSRC PLLCFG, type RO, offset 0x064, reset - OD DSLPCLKCFG, type R/W, offset 0x144, reset 0x0780.0000 F R IOSC CLKVCLR, type R/W, offset 0x150, reset 0x0000.0000 VERCLR LDOARST, type R/W, offset 0x160, reset 0x0000.0000 LDOARST DID1, type RO, offset 0x004, reset VER FAM TEMP DC0, type RO, offset 0x008, reset 0x001F.000F SRAMSZ FLASHSZ DC1, type RO, offset 0x010, reset 0x0010.309F PWM MINSYSDIV DC2, type RO, offset 0x014, reset 0x0707.1113 COMP2 I2C0 COMP1 COMP0 QEI0 SSI0 TIMER2 TIMER1 UART1 TIMER0 UART0 MPU PLL WDT SWO SWD JTAG PARTNO PKG ROHS QUAL 430 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 DC3, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x3F00.37FF CCP5 CCP4 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP0 C0O C0PLUS C0MINUS PWM5 PWM4 PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PWM0 C2PLUS C2MINUS DC4, type RO, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.001F C1PLUS C1MINUS GPIOE RCGC0, type R/W, offset 0x100, reset 0x00000040 PWM GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA WDT SCGC0, type R/W, offset 0x110, reset 0x00000040 PWM WDT DCGC0, type R/W, offset 0x120, reset 0x00000040 PWM WDT RCGC1, type R/W, offset 0x104, reset 0x00000000 COMP2 I2C0 SCGC1, type R/W, offset 0x114, reset 0x00000000 COMP2 I2C0 DCGC1, type R/W, offset 0x124, reset 0x00000000 COMP2 I2C0 RCGC2, type R/W, offset 0x108, reset 0x00000000 COMP1 COMP0 QEI0 SSI0 TIMER2 TIMER1 UART1 TIMER0 UART0 COMP1 COMP0 QEI0 SSI0 TIMER2 TIMER1 UART1 TIMER0 UART0 COMP1 COMP0 QEI0 SSI0 TIMER2 TIMER1 UART1 TIMER0 UART0 GPIOE SCGC2, type R/W, offset 0x118, reset 0x00000000 GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA GPIOE DCGC2, type R/W, offset 0x128, reset 0x00000000 GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA GPIOE SRCR0, type R/W, offset 0x040, reset 0x00000000 PWM GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA WDT SRCR1, type R/W, offset 0x044, reset 0x00000000 COMP2 I2C0 SRCR2, type R/W, offset 0x048, reset 0x00000000 COMP1 COMP0 QEI0 SSI0 TIMER2 TIMER1 UART1 TIMER0 UART0 GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA Internal Memory Flash Control Offset Base 0x400F.D000 FMA, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 OFFSET FMD, type R/W, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 DATA DATA October 01, 2007 Preliminary 431 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 FMC, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 WRKEY COMT FCRIS, type RO, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0000 MERASE ERASE WRITE PRIS FCIM, type R/W, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 ARIS PMASK FCMISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 AMASK PMISC AMISC Internal Memory System Control Offset Base 0x400F.E000 USECRL, type R/W, offset 0x140, reset 0x31 USEC FMPRE, type R/W, offset 0x130, reset 0x8000.FFFF READ_ENABLE READ_ENABLE FMPPE, type R/W, offset 0x134, reset 0x0000.FFFF PROG_ENABLE PROG_ENABLE General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) GPIO Port A base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port B base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port C base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port D base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port E base: 0x4002.4000 GPIODATA, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 DATA GPIODIR, type R/W, offset 0x400, reset 0x0000.0000 DIR GPIOIS, type R/W, offset 0x404, reset 0x0000.0000 IS GPIOIBE, type R/W, offset 0x408, reset 0x0000.0000 IBE GPIOIEV, type R/W, offset 0x40C, reset 0x0000.0000 IEV GPIOIM, type R/W, offset 0x410, reset 0x0000.0000 IME GPIORIS, type RO, offset 0x414, reset 0x0000.0000 RIS GPIOMIS, type RO, offset 0x418, reset 0x0000.0000 MIS 432 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 GPIOICR, type W1C, offset 0x41C, reset 0x0000.0000 IC GPIOAFSEL, type R/W, offset 0x420, reset - AFSEL GPIODR2R, type R/W, offset 0x500, reset 0x0000.00FF DRV2 GPIODR4R, type R/W, offset 0x504, reset 0x0000.0000 DRV4 GPIODR8R, type R/W, offset 0x508, reset 0x0000.0000 DRV8 GPIOODR, type R/W, offset 0x50C, reset 0x0000.0000 ODE GPIOPUR, type R/W, offset 0x510, reset 0x0000.00FF PUE GPIOPDR, type R/W, offset 0x514, reset 0x0000.0000 PDE GPIOSLR, type R/W, offset 0x518, reset 0x0000.0000 SRL GPIODEN, type R/W, offset 0x51C, reset 0x0000.00FF DEN GPIOPeriphID4, type RO, offset 0xFD0, reset 0x0000.0000 PID4 GPIOPeriphID5, type RO, offset 0xFD4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID5 GPIOPeriphID6, type RO, offset 0xFD8, reset 0x0000.0000 PID6 GPIOPeriphID7, type RO, offset 0xFDC, reset 0x0000.0000 PID7 GPIOPeriphID0, type RO, offset 0xFE0, reset 0x0000.0061 PID0 GPIOPeriphID1, type RO, offset 0xFE4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID1 GPIOPeriphID2, type RO, offset 0xFE8, reset 0x0000.0018 PID2 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 433 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 GPIOPeriphID3, type RO, offset 0xFEC, reset 0x0000.0001 PID3 GPIOPCellID0, type RO, offset 0xFF0, reset 0x0000.000D CID0 GPIOPCellID1, type RO, offset 0xFF4, reset 0x0000.00F0 CID1 GPIOPCellID2, type RO, offset 0xFF8, reset 0x0000.0005 CID2 GPIOPCellID3, type RO, offset 0xFFC, reset 0x0000.00B1 CID3 General-Purpose Timers Timer0 base: 0x4003.0000 Timer1 base: 0x4003.1000 Timer2 base: 0x4003.2000 GPTMCFG, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 GPTMCFG GPTMTAMR, type R/W, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 TAAMS GPTMTBMR, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 TACMR TAMR TBAMS GPTMCTL, type R/W, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0000 TBCMR TBMR TBPWML TBOTE TBEVENT TBSTALL TBEN TAPWML TAOTE RTCEN TAEVENT TASTALL TAEN GPTMIMR, type R/W, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0000 CBEIM GPTMRIS, type RO, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.0000 CBMIM TBTOIM RTCIM CAEIM CAMIM TATOIM CBERIS GPTMMIS, type RO, offset 0x020, reset 0x0000.0000 CBMRIS TBTORIS RTCRIS CAERIS CAMRIS TATORIS CBEMIS GPTMICR, type W1C, offset 0x024, reset 0x0000.0000 CBMMIS TBTOMIS RTCMIS CAEMIS CAMMIS TATOMIS CBECINT CBMCINT TBTOCINT GPTMTAILR, type R/W, offset 0x028, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) TAILRH TAILRL GPTMTBILR, type R/W, offset 0x02C, reset 0x0000.FFFF RTCCINT CAECINT CAMCINT TATOCINT TBILRL GPTMTAMATCHR, type R/W, offset 0x030, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) TAMRH TAMRL 434 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 GPTMTBMATCHR, type R/W, offset 0x034, reset 0x0000.FFFF TBMRL GPTMTAPR, type R/W, offset 0x038, reset 0x0000.0000 TAPSR GPTMTBPR, type R/W, offset 0x03C, reset 0x0000.0000 TBPSR GPTMTAPMR, type R/W, offset 0x040, reset 0x0000.0000 TAPSMR GPTMTBPMR, type R/W, offset 0x044, reset 0x0000.0000 TBPSMR GPTMTAR, type RO, offset 0x048, reset 0x0000.FFFF (16-bit mode) and 0xFFFF.FFFF (32-bit mode) TARH TARL GPTMTBR, type RO, offset 0x04C, reset 0x0000.FFFF TBRL Watchdog Timer Base 0x4000.0000 WDTLOAD, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF WDTLoad WDTLoad WDTVALUE, type RO, offset 0x004, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF WDTValue WDTValue WDTCTL, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 RESEN WDTICR, type WO, offset 0x00C, reset WDTIntClr WDTIntClr WDTRIS, type RO, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 INTEN WDTRIS WDTMIS, type RO, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 WDTMIS WDTTEST, type R/W, offset 0x418, reset 0x0000.0000 STALL WDTLOCK, type R/W, offset 0xC00, reset 0x0000.0000 WDTLock WDTLock WDTPeriphID4, type RO, offset 0xFD0, reset 0x0000.0000 PID4 WDTPeriphID5, type RO, offset 0xFD4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID5 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 435 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 WDTPeriphID6, type RO, offset 0xFD8, reset 0x0000.0000 PID6 WDTPeriphID7, type RO, offset 0xFDC, reset 0x0000.0000 PID7 WDTPeriphID0, type RO, offset 0xFE0, reset 0x0000.0005 PID0 WDTPeriphID1, type RO, offset 0xFE4, reset 0x0000.0018 PID1 WDTPeriphID2, type RO, offset 0xFE8, reset 0x0000.0018 PID2 WDTPeriphID3, type RO, offset 0xFEC, reset 0x0000.0001 PID3 WDTPCellID0, type RO, offset 0xFF0, reset 0x0000.000D CID0 WDTPCellID1, type RO, offset 0xFF4, reset 0x0000.00F0 CID1 WDTPCellID2, type RO, offset 0xFF8, reset 0x0000.0005 CID2 WDTPCellID3, type RO, offset 0xFFC, reset 0x0000.00B1 CID3 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) UART0 base: 0x4000.C000 UART1 base: 0x4000.D000 UARTDR, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 OE BE PE FE DATA UARTRSR/UARTECR, type RO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 OE UARTRSR/UARTECR, type WO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 BE PE FE DATA UARTFR, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0090 TXFE UARTIBRD, type R/W, offset 0x024, reset 0x0000.0000 RXFF TXFF RXFE BUSY DIVINT UARTFBRD, type R/W, offset 0x028, reset 0x0000.0000 DIVFRAC 436 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 UARTLCRH, type R/W, offset 0x02C, reset 0x0000.0000 SPS UARTCTL, type R/W, offset 0x030, reset 0x0000.0300 WLEN FEN STP2 EPS PEN BRK RXE UARTIFLS, type R/W, offset 0x034, reset 0x0000.0012 TXE LBE UARTEN RXIFLSEL UARTIM, type R/W, offset 0x038, reset 0x0000.0000 TXIFLSEL OEIM UARTRIS, type RO, offset 0x03C, reset 0x0000.000F BEIM PEIM FEIM RTIM TXIM RXIM OERIS UARTMIS, type RO, offset 0x040, reset 0x0000.0000 BERIS PERIS FERIS RTRIS TXRIS RXRIS OEMIS UARTICR, type W1C, offset 0x044, reset 0x0000.0000 BEMIS PEMIS FEMIS RTMIS TXMIS RXMIS OEIC UARTPeriphID4, type RO, offset 0xFD0, reset 0x0000.0000 BEIC PEIC FEIC RTIC TXIC RXIC PID4 UARTPeriphID5, type RO, offset 0xFD4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID5 UARTPeriphID6, type RO, offset 0xFD8, reset 0x0000.0000 PID6 UARTPeriphID7, type RO, offset 0xFDC, reset 0x0000.0000 PID7 UARTPeriphID0, type RO, offset 0xFE0, reset 0x0000.0011 PID0 UARTPeriphID1, type RO, offset 0xFE4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID1 UARTPeriphID2, type RO, offset 0xFE8, reset 0x0000.0018 PID2 UARTPeriphID3, type RO, offset 0xFEC, reset 0x0000.0001 PID3 UARTPCellID0, type RO, offset 0xFF0, reset 0x0000.000D CID0 UARTPCellID1, type RO, offset 0xFF4, reset 0x0000.00F0 CID1 October 01, 2007 Preliminary 437 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 UARTPCellID2, type RO, offset 0xFF8, reset 0x0000.0005 CID2 UARTPCellID3, type RO, offset 0xFFC, reset 0x0000.00B1 CID3 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) SSI0 base: 0x4000.8000 SSICR0, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 SCR SSICR1, type R/W, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 SPH SPO FRF DSS SOD SSIDR, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 MS SSE LBM DATA SSISR, type RO, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0003 BSY SSICPSR, type R/W, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 RFF RNE TNF TFE CPSDVSR SSIIM, type R/W, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 TXIM SSIRIS, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0008 RXIM RTIM RORIM TXRIS SSIMIS, type RO, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.0000 RXRIS RTRIS RORRIS TXMIS SSIICR, type W1C, offset 0x020, reset 0x0000.0000 RXMIS RTMIS RORMIS RTIC SSIPeriphID4, type RO, offset 0xFD0, reset 0x0000.0000 RORIC PID4 SSIPeriphID5, type RO, offset 0xFD4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID5 SSIPeriphID6, type RO, offset 0xFD8, reset 0x0000.0000 PID6 SSIPeriphID7, type RO, offset 0xFDC, reset 0x0000.0000 PID7 SSIPeriphID0, type RO, offset 0xFE0, reset 0x0000.0022 PID0 SSIPeriphID1, type RO, offset 0xFE4, reset 0x0000.0000 PID1 438 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 SSIPeriphID2, type RO, offset 0xFE8, reset 0x0000.0018 PID2 SSIPeriphID3, type RO, offset 0xFEC, reset 0x0000.0001 PID3 SSIPCellID0, type RO, offset 0xFF0, reset 0x0000.000D CID0 SSIPCellID1, type RO, offset 0xFF4, reset 0x0000.00F0 CID1 SSIPCellID2, type RO, offset 0xFF8, reset 0x0000.0005 CID2 SSIPCellID3, type RO, offset 0xFFC, reset 0x0000.00B1 CID3 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface I2C Master I2C Master 0 base: 0x4002.0000 I2CMSA, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 SA I2CMCS, type RO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 R/S BUSBSY I2CMCS, type WO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 IDLE ARBLST DATACK ADRACK ERROR BUSY ACK I2CMDR, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 STOP START RUN DATA I2CMTPR, type R/W, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0001 TPR I2CMIMR, type R/W, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 IM I2CMRIS, type RO, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 RIS I2CMMIS, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0000 MIS I2CMICR, type WO, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.0000 IC I2CMCR, type R/W, offset 0x020, reset 0x0000.0000 SFE MFE LPBK Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface October 01, 2007 Preliminary 439 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 I2C Slave I2C Slave 0 base: 0x4002.0800 I2CSOAR, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 OAR I2CSCSR, type RO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 FBR I2CSCSR, type WO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 TREQ RREQ DA I2CSDR, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 DATA I2CSIMR, type R/W, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0000 IM I2CSRIS, type RO, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 RIS I2CSMIS, type RO, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 MIS I2CSICR, type WO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0000 IC Analog Comparators Base 0x4003.C000 ACMIS, type R/W1C, offset 0x00, reset 0x0000.0000 IN2 ACRIS, type RO, offset 0x04, reset 0x0000.0000 IN1 IN0 IN2 ACINTEN, type R/W, offset 0x08, reset 0x0000.0000 IN1 IN0 IN2 ACREFCTL, type R/W, offset 0x10, reset 0x0000.0000 IN1 IN0 EN ACSTAT0, type RO, offset 0x20, reset 0x0000.0000 RNG VREF OVAL ACSTAT1, type RO, offset 0x40, reset 0x0000.0000 OVAL ACSTAT2, type RO, offset 0x60, reset 0x0000.0000 OVAL ACCTL0, type R/W, offset 0x24, reset 0x0000.0000 ASRCP ISLVAL ISEN CINV 440 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 ACCTL1, type R/W, offset 0x44, reset 0x0000.0000 ASRCP ACCTL2, type R/W, offset 0x64, reset 0x0000.0000 ISLVAL ISEN CINV ASRCP ISLVAL ISEN CINV Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) Base 0x4002.8000 PWMCTL, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 GlobalSync2 GlobalSync1 GlobalSync0 PWMSYNC, type R/W, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 Sync2 PWMENABLE, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 Sync1 Sync0 PWM5En PWM4En PWM3En PWM2En PWM1En PWM0En PWMINVERT, type R/W, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0000 PWM5Inv PWM4Inv PWM3Inv PWM2Inv PWM1Inv PWM0Inv PWMFAULT, type R/W, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 Fault5 PWMINTEN, type R/W, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 Fault4 Fault3 Fault2 Fault1 Fault0 IntFault IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 PWMRIS, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0000 IntFault IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 PWMISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.0000 IntFault IntPWM2 IntPWM1 IntPWM0 PWMSTATUS, type RO, offset 0x020, reset 0x0000.0000 Fault PWM0CTL, type R/W, offset 0x040, reset 0x0000.0000 CmpBUpd CmpAUpd LoadUpd PWM1CTL, type R/W, offset 0x080, reset 0x0000.0000 Debug Mode Enable CmpBUpd CmpAUpd LoadUpd PWM2CTL, type R/W, offset 0x0C0, reset 0x0000.0000 Debug Mode Enable CmpBUpd CmpAUpd LoadUpd PWM0INTEN, type R/W, offset 0x044, reset 0x0000.0000 Debug Mode Enable IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM1INTEN, type R/W, offset 0x084, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM2INTEN, type R/W, offset 0x0C4, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad IntCntZero October 01, 2007 Preliminary 441 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 PWM0RIS, type RO, offset 0x048, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM1RIS, type RO, offset 0x088, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM2RIS, type RO, offset 0x0C8, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM0ISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x04C, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM1ISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x08C, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM2ISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x0CC, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero IntCmpBD IntCmpBU IntCmpAD IntCmpAU IntCntLoad PWM0LOAD, type R/W, offset 0x050, reset 0x0000.0000 IntCntZero Load PWM1LOAD, type R/W, offset 0x090, reset 0x0000.0000 Load PWM2LOAD, type R/W, offset 0x0D0, reset 0x0000.0000 Load PWM0COUNT, type RO, offset 0x054, reset 0x0000.0000 Count PWM1COUNT, type RO, offset 0x094, reset 0x0000.0000 Count PWM2COUNT, type RO, offset 0x0D4, reset 0x0000.0000 Count PWM0CMPA, type R/W, offset 0x058, reset 0x0000.0000 CompA PWM1CMPA, type R/W, offset 0x098, reset 0x0000.0000 CompA PWM2CMPA, type R/W, offset 0x0D8, reset 0x0000.0000 CompA PWM0CMPB, type R/W, offset 0x05C, reset 0x0000.0000 CompB PWM1CMPB, type R/W, offset 0x09C, reset 0x0000.0000 CompB 442 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 PWM2CMPB, type R/W, offset 0x0DC, reset 0x0000.0000 CompB PWM0GENA, type R/W, offset 0x060, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBD PWM1GENA, type R/W, offset 0x0A0, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero ActCmpBD PWM2GENA, type R/W, offset 0x0E0, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero ActCmpBD PWM0GENB, type R/W, offset 0x064, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero ActCmpBD PWM1GENB, type R/W, offset 0x0A4, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero ActCmpBD PWM2GENB, type R/W, offset 0x0E4, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero ActCmpBD PWM0DBCTL, type R/W, offset 0x068, reset 0x0000.0000 ActCmpBU ActCmpAD ActCmpAU ActLoad ActZero Enable PWM1DBCTL, type R/W, offset 0x0A8, reset 0x0000.0000 Enable PWM2DBCTL, type R/W, offset 0x0E8, reset 0x0000.0000 Enable PWM0DBRISE, type R/W, offset 0x06C, reset 0x0000.0000 RiseDelay PWM1DBRISE, type R/W, offset 0x0AC, reset 0x0000.0000 RiseDelay PWM2DBRISE, type R/W, offset 0x0EC, reset 0x0000.0000 RiseDelay PWM0DBFALL, type R/W, offset 0x070, reset 0x0000.0000 FallDelay PWM1DBFALL, type R/W, offset 0x0B0, reset 0x0000.0000 FallDelay PWM2DBFALL, type R/W, offset 0x0F0, reset 0x0000.0000 FallDelay Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) QEI0 base: 0x4002.C000 QEICTL, type R/W, offset 0x000, reset 0x0000.0000 STALLEN INVI INVB INVA VelDiv VelEn ResMode CapMode SigMode Swap Enable October 01, 2007 Preliminary 443 Register Quick Reference 31 15 30 14 29 13 28 12 27 11 26 10 25 9 24 8 23 7 22 6 21 5 20 4 19 3 18 2 17 1 16 0 QEISTAT, type RO, offset 0x004, reset 0x0000.0000 Direction Error QEIPOS, type R/W, offset 0x008, reset 0x0000.0000 Position Position QEIMAXPOS, type R/W, offset 0x00C, reset 0x0000.0000 MaxPos MaxPos QEILOAD, type R/W, offset 0x010, reset 0x0000.0000 Load Load QEITIME, type RO, offset 0x014, reset 0x0000.0000 Time Time QEICOUNT, type RO, offset 0x018, reset 0x0000.0000 Count Count QEISPEED, type RO, offset 0x01C, reset 0x0000.0000 Speed Speed QEIINTEN, type R/W, offset 0x020, reset 0x0000.0000 IntError QEIRIS, type RO, offset 0x024, reset 0x0000.0000 IntDir IntTimer IntIndex IntError QEIISC, type R/W1C, offset 0x028, reset 0x0000.0000 IntDir IntTimer IntIndex IntError IntDir IntTimer IntIndex 444 Preliminary October 01, 2007 LM3S601 Microcontroller C C.1 Ordering and Contact Information Ordering Information LM3Snnnn–gppss–rrm Part Number Temperature I = -40 C to 85 C Package RN = 28-pin SOIC QN = 48-pin LQFP QC = 100-pin LQFP Speed 20 = 20 MHz 25 = 25 MHz 50 = 50 MHz Shipping Medium T = Tape-and-reel Omitted = Default shipping (tray or tube) Revision Omitted = Default to current shipping revision A0 = First all-layer mask A1 = Metal layers update to A0 A2 = Metal layers update to A1 B0 = Second all-layer mask revision Table C-1. Part Ordering Information Orderable Part Number Description LM3S601-IQN50 LM3S601-IQN50(T) Stellaris LM3S601 Microcontroller Stellaris LM3S601 Microcontroller ® ® C.2 Kits The Luminary Micro Stellaris Family provides the hardware and software tools that engineers need to begin development quickly. ■ Reference Design Kits accelerate product development by providing ready-to-run hardware, and comprehensive documentation including hardware design files: http://www.luminarymicro.com/products/reference_design_kits/ ■ Evaluation Kits provide a low-cost and effective means of evaluating Stellaris microcontrollers before purchase: http://www.luminarymicro.com/products/evaluation_kits/ ■ Development Kits provide you with all the tools you need to develop and prototype embedded applications right out of the box: http://www.luminarymicro.com/products/boards.html See the Luminary Micro website for the latest tools available or ask your Luminary Micro distributor. ® ® C.3 Company Information Luminary Micro, Inc. designs, markets, and sells ARM Cortex-M3-based microcontrollers (MCUs). Austin, Texas-based Luminary Micro is the lead partner for the Cortex-M3 processor, delivering the world's first silicon implementation of the Cortex-M3 processor. Luminary Micro's introduction of the October 01, 2007 Preliminary 445 Ordering and Contact Information Stellaris® family of products provides 32-bit performance for the same price as current 8- and 16-bit microcontroller designs. With entry-level pricing at $1.00 for an ARM technology-based MCU, Luminary Micro's Stellaris product line allows for standardization that eliminates future architectural upgrades or software tool changes. Luminary Micro, Inc. 108 Wild Basin, Suite 350 Austin, TX 78746 Main: +1-512-279-8800 Fax: +1-512-279-8879 http://www.luminarymicro.com sales@luminarymicro.com C.4 Support Information For support on Luminary Micro products, contact: support@luminarymicro.com +1-512-279-8800, ext. 3 446 Preliminary October 01, 2007
LM3S601 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“LM3S601”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货